BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES INC
424B3, 1998-07-28
ASSET-BACKED SECURITIES
Previous: MIDWAY AIRLINES CORP, 10-Q, 1998-07-28
Next: BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES INC, 424B3, 1998-07-28




<PAGE>
                                                      Rule No. 424(b)(3)
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT                                 Registration No. 333-02180
(TO PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 17, 1996)

                                  $100,000,000
                     CHAMPION HOME EQUITY LOAN TRUST 1996-2
 
                       CHAMPION MORTGAGE SERVICING CORP.
                                    SERVICER
 
                   BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES, INC.
                                   DEPOSITOR
 
    The Champion Home Equity Loan Asset-Backed Certificates, Series 1996-2
(collectively, the 'Certificates'), consist of five Classes of Certificates, the
Class A-1 Certificates, the Class A-2 Certificates, the Class A-3 Certificates,
the Class A-4 Certificates and the Class A-5 Certificates (the 'Offered
Certificates'), as well as an additional Class of Certificates which is not
being offered for sale hereunder. The Certificates evidence in the aggregate the
entire beneficial interest in Champion Home Equity Loan Trust 1996-2 (the
'Trust') formed pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the 'Agreement')
among Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc., as depositor (the
'Depositor'), Champion Mortgage Servicing Corp., as Servicer (the 'Servicer'),
and The Bank of New York, as Trustee and Back-Up Servicer (the 'Trustee' and the
'Back-Up Servicer,' respectively).
 
    The property of the Trust includes two pools (each, a 'Loan Group') of
non-conforming closed-end home equity loans (the 'Home Equity Loans'). The Home
Equity Loans are secured by first and second deeds of trust or mortgages
primarily on one- to four-family residential properties. Loan Group One consists
of fixed rate, simple interest Home Equity Loans, and Loan Group Two consists of
adjustable rate, actuarial Home Equity Loans. The Trust also includes
approximately $24,706,702 on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account which will be
used to purchase additional Home Equity Loans for each Loan Group from time to
time as described herein, funds on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account
and funds on deposit in the Yield Supplement Account.
 
    Distributions of principal and interest on the Offered Certificates will be
made on the 25th day of each month or, if such day is not a Business Day, then
on the succeeding Business Day (each, a 'Distribution Date'), commencing in June
1996. On each Distribution Date, holders of the Offered Certificates are
entitled to receive, from and to the extent of funds available in the related
Distribution Account (as defined herein), distributions with respect to interest
and principal calculated as set forth herein. The Offered Certificates have the
benefit of an irrevocable and unconditional surety bond (the 'Policy') issued by
Capital Markets Assurance Corporation (the 'Certificate Insurer') pursuant to
which the Certificate Insurer guarantees payments to the holders of the Offered
Certificates as described herein. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES' herein.
The Certificate Insurer has entered into a reinsurance agreement with MBIA
Insurance Corporation. See 'THE POLICY AND THE CERTIFICATE INSURER' herein.
 
                                                  (cover continued on next page)
 
                    ---------------------------------------
 
          SEE 'RISK FACTORS' HEREIN ON PAGE S-15 AND IN THE PROSPECTUS
                ON PAGE 15 FOR CERTAIN FACTORS TO BE CONSIDERED
                    IN PURCHASING THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES.
 
                    ---------------------------------------
 
THE CERTIFICATES DO NOT REPRESENT AN OBLIGATION OF OR INTEREST IN THE DEPOSITOR,
THE SELLER, THE SERVICER, THE TRUSTEE OR ANY OF THEIR RESPECTIVE AFFILIATES.
   NEITHER THE CERTIFICATES NOR THE UNDERLYING HOME EQUITY LOANS ARE
     INSURED OR GUARANTEED BY ANY GOVERNMENTAL ENTITY, THE DEPOSITOR, THE
               SELLER, THE SERVICER OR ANY OF THEIR AFFILIATES.
 
                    ---------------------------------------
 
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
   EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
   COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY
     OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT OR THE PROSPECTUS. ANY
             REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

                    ---------------------------------------
 
BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.                               KEY CAPITAL MARKETS, INC.
 
July 21, 1998

<PAGE>
(cover page continued)
 
     THE YIELD TO INVESTORS IN EACH CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES WILL BE
SENSITIVE IN VARYING DEGREES TO THE RATE AND TIMING OF PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS
(INCLUDING PREPAYMENTS) ON THE HOME EQUITY LOANS IN THE RELATED LOAN GROUP,
WHICH GENERALLY MAY BE PREPAID IN FULL OR IN PART AT ANY TIME WITHOUT PENALTY.
THE YIELD TO MATURITY OF A CLASS OF OFFERED CERTIFICATES PURCHASED AT A DISCOUNT
OR PREMIUM WILL BE MORE SENSITIVE TO THE RATE AND TIMING OF PAYMENTS THEREON.
HOLDERS OF THE OFFERED CERTIFICATES SHOULD CONSIDER, IN THE CASE OF ANY SUCH
CERTIFICATES PURCHASED AT A DISCOUNT, THE RISK THAT A SLOWER THAN ANTICIPATED
RATE OF PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS COULD RESULT IN AN ACTUAL YIELD THAT IS LOWER THAN
THE ANTICIPATED YIELD AND, IN THE CASE OF ANY OFFERED CERTIFICATES PURCHASED AT
A PREMIUM, THE RISK THAT A FASTER THAN ANTICIPATED RATE OF PRINCIPAL PAYMENTS
COULD RESULT IN AN ACTUAL YIELD THAT IS LOWER THAN THE ANTICIPATED YIELD. NO
REPRESENTATION IS MADE AS TO THE ANTICIPATED RATE OF PREPAYMENTS ON THE HOME
EQUITY LOANS OR AS TO THE RESULTING YIELD TO MATURITY OF ANY CLASS OF OFFERED
CERTIFICATES.
 
     An election will be made to treat certain assets of the Trust as a real
estate mortgage investment conduit (a 'REMIC') for federal income tax purposes.
As described more fully herein and in the Prospectus, the Offered Certificates
will be designated as 'regular interests' in a REMIC. See 'CERTAIN FEDERAL
INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES' in the Prospectus.
 
     After the initial distribution of the Offered Certificates by the
Underwriter, the Prospectus and Prospectus Supplement may be used by Key Capital
Markets, Inc., an affiliate of the Seller and the Servicer, in connection with
market making transactions in the Offered Certificates. Key Capital Markets,
Inc. may act as principal or agent in such transactions, but has no obligation
to do so. Such transactions will be at prices related to prevailing market
prices at the time of sale. Certain information in this Prospectus Supplement
will be updated from time to time as described in the Prospectus under
'INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE.'
                    ---------------------------------------
 
     THE ATTORNEY GENERAL OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK HAS NOT PASSED ON OR ENDORSED
THE MERITS OF THIS OFFERING. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS UNLAWFUL.
                    ---------------------------------------
 
     THE CERTIFICATES OFFERED BY THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT CONSTITUTE A
SEPARATE SERIES OF SECURITIES BEING OFFERED BY THE DEPOSITOR PURSUANT TO ITS
PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 17, 1996, OF WHICH THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT IS A PART AND
WHICH ACCOMPANIES THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT. THE PROSPECTUS CONTAINS IMPORTANT
INFORMATION REGARDING THIS OFFERING WHICH IS NOT CONTAINED HEREIN AND
PROSPECTIVE INVESTORS ARE URGED TO READ THE PROSPECTUS AND THIS PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT IN FULL.
 
                                      S-2

<PAGE>
                                SUMMARY OF TERMS
 
     The following summary of certain pertinent information is qualified in its
entirety by reference to the detailed information appearing elsewhere in this
Prospectus Supplement and in the accompanying Prospectus. Capitalized terms used
but not defined herein or in the accompanying Prospectus are defined in the
'GLOSSARY OF TERMS' in the Prospectus.
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
Trust.....................................  Champion Home Equity Loan Trust 1996-2 (the 'Trust') will be formed
                                            pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement (the 'Agreement'), to
                                            be dated as of May 1, 1996 (the 'Cut-Off Date'), among Bear Stearns
                                            Asset Backed Securities, Inc., as depositor (the 'Depositor'),
                                            Champion Mortgage Servicing Corp., as servicer (together with any
                                            successor in such capacity, the 'Servicer'), and The Bank of New
                                            York, as trustee (the 'Trustee') and back-up servicer (the 'Back-Up
                                            Servicer'). The property of the Trust will include: two pools (each,
                                            a 'Loan Group') of non- conforming closed-end home equity loans (the
                                            'Home Equity Loans'), secured by first and second mortgages primarily
                                            on one- to four- family residential properties (the 'Mortgaged
                                            Properties'); payments in respect of the Home Equity Loans received
                                            on and after the Cut-Off Date; property that secured a Home Equity
                                            Loan which has been acquired by foreclosure or deed in lieu of
                                            foreclosure; rights under certain hazard insurance policies covering
                                            the Mortgaged Properties; funds on deposit in the Pre-Funding
                                            Account, the Capitalized Interest Account, the Yield Supplement
                                            Account and the Spread Account (each as defined below); the
                                            Depositor's rights under the Purchase Agreement (as defined herein);
                                            and certain other property, as described more fully herein. In
                                            addition, the Depositor will cause the Certificate Insurer (as
                                            defined below) to issue an irrevocable and unconditional surety bond
                                            (the 'Policy') for the benefit of the Holders of the Offered
                                            Certificates pursuant to which it will guarantee payments to such
                                            Holders as described herein. The Trust is one of the Trust Funds
                                            referred to in the Prospectus.
 
Securities Offered........................  The Champion Home Equity Loan Asset-Backed Certificates, Series
                                            1996-2 (the 'Certificates') will consist of the Class A-1, Class A-2,
                                            Class A-3, Class A-4 and Class A-5 Certificates (collectively, the
                                            'Offered Certificates') and the Class R Certificates. Only the
                                            Offered Certificates are offered hereby. Any information contained
                                            herein regarding the Class R Certificates is included solely to
                                            permit a better understanding of the Offered Certificates.
 
                                            The Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and Class A-4 Certificates
                                            (collectively, the 'Fixed Rate Certificates') are related to Loan
                                            Group One (defined below) and the Class A-5 Certificates (the
                                            'Variable Rate Certificates') are related to Loan Group Two (defined
                                            below). Each Class of Offered Certificates represents the right to
                                            receive payments of interest at the per annum rate (the 'Certificate
                                            Rate') described below and payable monthly, and payments of principal
                                            to the extent provided below. The Offered Certificates will be
                                            offered for purchase in minimum dollar denominations of $25,000 and
                                            integral multiples of $1,000 in excess thereof, provided, however,
                                            that one Certificate of each Class of Offered Certificates may be
                                            issued in an amount representing the remainder, if any, of such
                                            Class. The 'Percentage Interest'
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-3
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            evidenced by an Offered Certificate will be equal to the percentage
                                            derived by dividing the denomination of such Certificate by the
                                            aggregate denomination of all Certificates of the same Class as such
                                            Certificate.
 
Registration of the Offered
  Certificates............................  The Offered Certificates initially will be represented by one or more
                                            certificates registered in the name of Cede & Co., the nominee of The
                                            Depository Trust Company ('DTC'), and will be available only in the
                                            form of book-entries on the records of DTC, participating members
                                            thereof ('Participants') and other entities, such as banks, brokers,
                                            dealers and trust companies that clear through or maintain custodial
                                            relationships with a Participant, either directly or indirectly
                                            ('Indirect Participants'). References herein to 'Holders' reflect the
                                            rights of owners of the Offered Certificates only as they may
                                            indirectly exercise such rights through DTC and Participants, except
                                            as otherwise specified herein. See 'RISK FACTORS--Book-Entry
                                            Registration May Affect Liquidity' and 'DESCRIPTION OF THE
                                            CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Registration' herein.
 
Distribution and Record Dates.............  Distributions will be made on the 25th day of each month or, if such
                                            25th day is not a Business Day, on the succeeding Business Day (each,
                                            a 'Distribution Date'), commencing in June 1996. Distributions on a
                                            Distribution Date will be made to Holders of record as of the last
                                            Business Day of the month preceding the month in which such
                                            Distribution Date occurs (each, a 'Record Date').
 
Depositor.................................  Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc. (the 'Depositor'), a
                                            wholly-owned, special purpose subsidiary of The Bear Stearns
                                            Companies Inc. None of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc., any other
                                            affiliate of the Depositor, the Servicer, the Trustee or the Seller
                                            has guaranteed or is otherwise obligated with respect to the
                                            Certificates. See 'THE DEPOSITOR' in the Prospectus.
 
Seller....................................  Champion Mortgage Co., Inc., a New Jersey corporation. All of the
                                            Home Equity Loans originally delivered to the Trust (the 'Initial
                                            Home Equity Loans') were, and any Subsequent Home Equity Loans (as
                                            defined below) will be, originated by the Seller or by an affiliate
                                            and acquired by the Seller in the ordinary course of its business.
                                            The Home Equity Loans will be acquired by the Depositor in a
                                            privately negotiated transaction concurrently with the delivery of
                                            such Home Equity Loans to the Trust. The Seller's corporate
                                            headquarters are located at 20 Waterview Blvd., Parsippany, New
                                            Jersey 07054, and its telephone number is (973) 402-7700. See 'THE
                                            SELLER AND THE SERVICER' herein.
 
Servicer..................................  Champion Mortgage Servicing Corp., a Delaware corporation and an
                                            affiliate of the Seller. See 'THE SELLER AND THE SERVICER' herein.
 
Trustee and Back-Up Servicer..............  The Bank of New York, a banking corporation organized under the laws
                                            of the State of New York, will act as trustee and back-up servicer
                                            (the 'Trustee' and the 'Back-Up Servicer,' respectively).
 
Cut-Off Date..............................  May 1, 1996.
 
Closing Date..............................  On or about May 24, 1996.
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-4
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
The Home Equity Loans.....................  The Home Equity Loans consist of promissory notes or other evidences
                                            of indebtedness (the 'Mortgage Notes') secured by mortgages, deeds of
                                            trust or other instruments (the 'Mortgages') creating first or second
                                            liens primarily on one- to four-family residential properties (the
                                            'Mortgaged Properties'). The Home Equity Loans are the Mortgage Loans
                                            referred to in the Prospectus. The Home Equity Loans bear fixed or
                                            adjustable rates (each, a 'Loan Rate'). Interest on each fixed rate
                                            Home Equity Loan is calculated on the 'simple interest' method
                                            ('Simple Interest Loans'), and interest on each adjustable rate Home
                                            Equity Loan is calculated on the 'actuarial' method ('Actuarial
                                            Loans'). Monthly payments are due on the date of the month specified
                                            in the related Mortgage Note (each, a 'Due Date'). The Due Dates for
                                            the Home Equity Loans occur throughout the month. Except for the
                                            Balloon Loans (defined herein) in Loan Group One, the Home Equity
                                            Loans are fully amortizing.
 
                                            The Home Equity Loans will be divided into two Loan Groups. Loan
                                            Group One will consist of fixed rate Home Equity Loans, and Loan
                                            Group Two will consist of adjustable rate Home Equity Loans ('ARMs').
                                            The Loan Rate borne by each ARM is subject to adjustment annually on
                                            the date set forth in the related Mortgage Note (each, a 'Change
                                            Date') to equal the sum of (i) the weekly average yield on U.S.
                                            Treasury securities adjusted to a constant maturity of one year, as
                                            made available by the Federal Reserve Board as of the date 45 days
                                            before the applicable Change Date (the 'Index') and (ii) the number
                                            of basis points set forth in such Mortgage Note (the 'Gross Margin'),
                                            subject to rounding and to the effects of the Periodic Cap, the
                                            applicable Lifetime Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor. The
                                            'Periodic Cap' limits changes in the Loan Rate for each ARM on each
                                            Change Date to 200 basis points. The 'Lifetime Cap' is the maximum
                                            Loan Rate that may be borne by an ARM over its life and is equal to
                                            the sum of (i) the initial Loan Rate for such ARM and (ii) 600 basis
                                            points. The 'Lifetime Floor' is the minimum Loan Rate that may be
                                            borne by an ARM over its life and is equal to the initial Loan Rate
                                            for such ARM. The ARMs do not provide for negative amortization. None
                                            of the ARMs has reached its initial Change Date.
 
                                            The 'Principal Balance' of a Home Equity Loan (other than a
                                            Liquidated Home Equity Loan (as defined herein)) on any day is equal
                                            to its principal balance as of the Cut-Off Date (or, with respect to
                                            a Subsequent Home Equity Loan, its principal balance as of the
                                            applicable Subsequent Cut-Off Date), minus all collections credited
                                            against the Principal Balance of such Home Equity Loan. The Principal
                                            Balance of a Liquidated Home Equity Loan after final recovery of
                                            related Liquidation Proceeds (as defined herein) will be zero. With
                                            respect to any Distribution Date and Loan Group, the 'Loan Group
                                            Balance' will be equal to the aggregate of the Principal Balances of
                                            all Home Equity Loans in such Loan Group as of the first day of the
                                            related Due Period. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE HOME EQUITY LOANS' herein
                                            and Appendix A attached hereto.
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-5
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
Pre-Funding Account.......................  On the Closing Date, an aggregate cash amount (the 'Pre-Funded
                                            Amount') not to exceed approximately $24,706,702 will be deposited in
                                            the Pre-Funding Account. Of such amount, approximately $19,865,767
                                            will be used to purchase additional home equity loans secured by
                                            first or second liens on Mortgaged Properties ('Subsequent Home
                                            Equity Loans') for deposit into Loan Group One and, if required, to
                                            make accelerated payments of principal on the Fixed Rate Certificates
                                            and approximately $4,840,935 will be used to purchase Subsequent Home
                                            Equity Loans for deposit into Loan Group Two and, if required, to
                                            make accelerated payments of principal on the Variable Rate
                                            Certificates. During the period (the 'Pre-Funding Period') from the
                                            Closing Date to the earliest to occur of (i) the date on which the
                                            aggregate amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account is less than
                                            $100,000, (ii) an Event of Default under the Agreement and (iii) July
                                            31, 1996, amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account may be
                                            withdrawn from time to time to acquire Subsequent Home Equity Loans
                                            in accordance with the Agreement. Any net investment earnings on the
                                            Pre-Funded Amount will be transferred to the Capitalized Interest
                                            Account on each Distribution Date during the Pre-Funding Period. Any
                                            Pre-Funded Amount remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of
                                            the Pre-Funding Period will be distributed on the Distribution Date
                                            occurring at or immediately following the end of the Pre-Funding
                                            Period. If the Pre-Funded Amount so distributed and allocated to a
                                            Loan Group is less than $100,000, it will be treated as a principal
                                            prepayment and allocated to the applicable Class or Classes of
                                            Offered Certificates related to Loan Group One or Loan Group Two, as
                                            applicable, as provided herein; otherwise such amount will be
                                            distributed as principal of the outstanding Class or Classes of
                                            Offered Certificates related to Loan Group One or Loan Group Two, as
                                            applicable, pro rata on the basis of their respective Class
                                            Certificate Balances. Only fixed-rate Subsequent Home Equity Loans
                                            may be added to Loan Group One, and only adjustable-rate Subsequent
                                            Home Equity Loans may be added to Loan Group Two.
 
Capitalized Interest Account..............  On the Closing Date, funds will be deposited in an account (the
                                            'Capitalized Interest Account') created and maintained with the
                                            Trustee. The amount so deposited will be used by the Trustee on the
                                            Distribution Dates during the Pre-Funding Period to fund the excess,
                                            if any, of the Interest Remittance Amounts for the Offered
                                            Certificates (as defined below) and the premium due on the Policy
                                            over the funds available therefor on such Distribution Dates. Any
                                            funds remaining in the Capitalized Interest Account at the end of the
                                            Pre-Funding Period will be distributed to the Holders of the Class R
                                            Certificates.
 
Yield Supplement Account..................  On the Closing Date, funds will be deposited in an account (the
                                            'Yield Supplement Account') created and maintained with the Trustee.
                                            The amount so deposited will be used by the Trustee on each
                                            Distribution Date to the extent that the interest collected or
                                            advanced with respect to Home Equity Loans with Loan Rates below
                                            8.73% per annum ('Low Coupon Loans') is insufficient to pay the
                                            Expense Fees (defined below) and the Interest Remittance Amounts for
                                            the Fixed Rate Certificates. Funds on deposit in the
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-6
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Yield Supplement Account will not be available to make payments of
                                            principal or Additional Principal (as defined below). Excess amounts
                                            on deposit in the Yield Supplement Account may be released from time
                                            to time to the Holder of the Class R Certificates as provided in the
                                            Agreement. The Yield Supplement Account is an asset of the Trust but
                                            will not be included in the REMIC.
 
Final Scheduled Distribution Dates........  The Final Scheduled Distribution Dates for each of the respective
                                            Classes of Offered Certificates are set forth below. However, it is
                                            anticipated that the actual final Distribution Date for each Class of
                                            Offered Certificates will occur earlier, and could occur
                                            significantly earlier, than the related Final Scheduled Distribution
                                            Date. See 'PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS' herein.
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                  FINAL SCHEDULED
                                                                                 DISTRIBUTION DATE
                                                                               ---------------------
<S>                                         <C>                                <C>                    
                                            Class A-1 Certificates             August 25, 2006
                                            Class A-2 Certificates             April 25, 2011
                                            Class A-3 Certificates             May 25, 2012
                                            Class A-4 Certificates             September 25, 2028
                                            Class A-5 Certificates             September 25, 2028
</TABLE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
Interest..................................  The Certificate Rate for each Class of Offered Certificates will be
                                            as set forth or described on the cover page hereof. The 'Remittance
                                            Rate' for each Home Equity Loan in Loan Group Two will be calculated
                                            monthly, and for any Distribution Date will equal the Loan Rate for
                                            such Home Equity Loan at the beginning of the related Due Period
                                            (defined below) minus the sum of (a) the Expense Fee Rate (defined
                                            herein) and (b) the related Excess Spread Rate. The 'Excess Spread
                                            Rate' for any Home Equity Loan in Loan Group Two will equal the
                                            excess of (x) the Gross Margin for such Home Equity Loan less the
                                            Expense Fee Rate over (y) 2.40%. Holders of the Offered Certificates
                                            will be entitled to receive on each Distribution Date, to the extent
                                            funds are available therefor, interest at the applicable Certificate
                                            Rate accrued during the related Interest Period on the related Class
                                            Certificate Balance (as described below under the caption
                                            'Principal').
 
                                            The amount of interest (as described above) payable with respect to a
                                            Class of Offered Certificates constitutes the 'Interest Remittance
                                            Amount' for such Class. The 'Interest Period' for each Distribution
                                            Date will be the calendar month preceding the month in which such
                                            Distribution Date occurs. Interest on the Certificates will be
                                            calculated on the basis of a 360-day year consisting of twelve 30-day
                                            months. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES' herein.
 
Principal.................................  As to any Loan Group and Distribution Date, the 'Basic Principal
                                            Amount' will equal the sum of (i) each payment of principal on a Home
                                            Equity Loan received by the Servicer (exclusive of amounts described
                                            in clauses (ii) and (iii) below) during the calendar month preceding
                                            the calendar month in which such Distribution Date occurs (with
                                            respect to any Distribution Date, the 'Due Period'); (ii)
                                            curtailments (i.e., partial prepayments) and prepayments in full
                                            received during the related Due Period; (iii) all Insurance Proceeds
                                            and Net Liquidation Proceeds allocable to recoveries of principal of
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-7
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Home Equity Loans received during the related Due Period; (iv) an
                                            amount equal to the excess, if any, of the Principal Balance
                                            (immediately prior to liquidation) of each Home Equity Loan
                                            liquidated during the related Due Period over the principal portion
                                            of Net Liquidation Proceeds received during such Due Period (the
                                            'Unrecovered Class A Portion'); and (v) (a) the outstanding Principal
                                            Balance of any Home Equity Loan repurchased by the Seller or
                                            purchased by the Servicer as required or permitted by the Purchase
                                            Agreement or the Agreement as of the related Determination Date and
                                            (b) with respect to any Defective Home Equity Loan for which the
                                            Seller substitutes an Eligible Substitute Home Equity Loan as of the
                                            related Determination Date, any excess of the Principal Balance of
                                            such Defective Home Equity Loan over the Principal Balance of such
                                            Eligible Substitute Home Equity Loan, plus the amount of any
                                            unreimbursed Servicing Advances (defined herein) made by the Servicer
                                            with respect to the Home Equity Loan to the extent received.
 
                                            Distributions of principal of a Class of Offered Certificates will be
                                            measured by the Basic Principal Amount for the related Loan Group. As
                                            to any Distribution Date and Class of Offered Certificates, the
                                            'Principal Remittance Amount' will equal the sum of (i) the lesser of
                                            (x) the Basic Principal Amount for the related Loan Group and (y) the
                                            portion of such Basic Principal Amount required to be distributed to
                                            increase the Overcollateralization Amount (defined below) for the
                                            related Loan Group to the Required Overcollateralization Amount
                                            (defined below) for such Loan Group, (ii) the related Carry-Forward
                                            Amount (defined below), and (iii) on the Distribution Date at or
                                            immediately following the end of the Pre-Funding Period, the amount,
                                            if any, allocable to the related Loan Group remaining in the
                                            Pre-Funding Account (exclusive of any investment earnings included
                                            therein). Distributions of principal will be allocated among the
                                            Classes of Offered Certificates as described herein under
                                            'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Priority of Distributions.' As
                                            described below, Holders of a Class of Offered Certificates also may
                                            receive distributions of Additional Principal (defined below) on a
                                            Distribution Date.
 
                                            The Interest Remittance Amount, the Principal Remittance Amount and
                                            the Additional Principal, if any, for a Class of Offered Certificates
                                            together constitute the 'Class Remittance Amount' for such Class and
                                            each Distribution Date. An amount to cover any loss on a Liquidated
                                            Home Equity Loan (i.e., the Unrecovered Class A Portion) may or may
                                            not be distributed to the Holders of the related Class of Offered
                                            Certificates on the Distribution Date which immediately follows the
                                            event of loss. However, the Holders of such Certificates are entitled
                                            to receive ultimate recovery of 100% of the original Class
                                            Certificate Balance of the applicable Class of Certificates.
 
                                            The 'Class Certificate Balance' of a Class of Offered Certificates on
                                            any date is equal to the Class Certificate Balance of such Class on
                                            the Closing Date (the 'Original Class Certificate Balance') minus the
                                            aggregate of amounts actually distributed as principal to the Holders
                                            of such Class of Offered Certificates.
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-8
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            The 'Carry-Forward Amount' of a Class of Offered Certificates on any
                                            Distribution Date will equal the sum of (a) the excess of the
                                            aggregate of the Class Remittance Amounts as of each preceding
                                            Distribution Date over the amount of the actual distributions to the
                                            Holders of such Class of Offered Certificates made on any such
                                            Distribution Date and not subsequently distributed, and (b) interest
                                            on the amount, if any, of the interest component of the amount
                                            described in clause (a) at one-twelfth of the applicable Certificate
                                            Rate. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES' herein.
 
Overcollateralization and
  Crosscollateralization..................  On any Distribution Date on which the Overcollateralization Amount
                                            for a Loan Group is less than the Required Overcollateralization
                                            Amount for such Loan Group, the Remaining Net Excess Spread for such
                                            Loan Group plus the Available Transfer Cashflow and the Net Excess
                                            Principal, if any, will be used to make additional distributions of
                                            principal of the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates
                                            ('Additional Principal') until such Overcollateralization Amount
                                            equals the related Required Overcollateralization Amount.
 
                                            As to any Loan Group and Distribution Date, the
                                            'Overcollateralization Amount' will equal the sum of (a) the excess,
                                            if any, of (i) the sum of the Loan Group Balance and the amount on
                                            deposit in the Pre-Funding Account allocated to such Loan Group
                                            (exclusive of any investment earnings included therein) as of the
                                            close of business on the last day of the related Due Period, over
                                            (ii) the Class Certificate Balance of the related Class or Classes of
                                            Offered Certificates, after giving effect to the distributions of the
                                            related Principal Remittance Amount on such Distribution Date, and
                                            (b) the amount, if any, on deposit in the Spread Account allocated to
                                            the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates.
 
                                            The Agreement provides that, subject to certain floors, caps and
                                            triggers, the required level of overcollateralization (the 'Required
                                            Overcollateralization Amount') may (i) increase or decrease over time
                                            based on the delinquency and default experience on the Home Equity
                                            Loans in the Trust, (ii) be increased by the Certificate Insurer at
                                            the end of the Pre-Funding Period, (iii) step down based on the
                                            passage of time and the amortization of the Home Equity Loans in the
                                            Trust or (iv) be reduced or eliminated by the Certificate Insurer so
                                            long as a Certificate Insurer Default (as defined herein) does not
                                            exist and is not continuing.
 
                                            As to any Distribution Date and Loan Group: (a) the 'Excess Spread'
                                            will equal interest collected or advanced on the Home Equity Loans in
                                            such Loan Group (including amounts allocated to the related Class or
                                            Classes of Offered Certificates in the Capitalized Interest Account)
                                            minus the sum of (i) the Interest Remittance Amount for the related
                                            Class or Classes of Offered Certificates, (ii) the Servicing Fee,
                                            (iii) the Back-Up Servicing Fee, (iv) the Trustee Fee and (v) the
                                            Premium Fee (the sum of clauses (ii) through (v), the 'Expense
                                            Fees'); (b) the 'Net Excess Spread' will equal the Excess Spread
                                            remaining after the application thereof to cover an Available Funds
                                            Shortfall with respect to the related Loan Group; (c) 'Remaining Net
                                            Excess Spread' will equal the
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-9
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Net Excess Spread remaining after the application thereof to cover an
                                            Available Funds Shortfall with respect to the other Loan Group and
                                            will be used to make payments of Additional Principal to the Class or
                                            Classes of Offered Certificates related to such original Loan Group;
                                            (d) the 'Available Transfer Cashflow' will equal the Remaining Net
                                            Excess Spread for the other Loan Group after the application thereof
                                            to the payment of Additional Principal to the Class or Classes of
                                            Offered Certificates related to such other Loan Group; (e) the
                                            'Excess Principal' will equal the lesser of (i) the portion of the
                                            Basic Principal Amount for such Loan Group which is not required to
                                            be included in the Principal Remittance Amount for the related Class
                                            or Classes of Offered Certificates on such Distribution Date and (ii)
                                            the amount of such portion remaining after the application of the
                                            related Available Remittance Amount to the Required Payments for such
                                            Loan Group; (f) the 'Net Excess Principal' will equal the Excess
                                            Principal remaining after the application thereof to cover an
                                            Available Funds Shortfall in the other Loan Group; (g) an 'Available
                                            Funds Shortfall' is the amount by which the Available Remittance
                                            Amount for a Loan Group is less than the related Required Payments;
                                            and (h) the 'Required Payments' equal the sum of the related Expense
                                            Fees (other than the Servicing Fee), the Interest Remittance
                                            Amount(s), the Principal Remittance Amount and reimbursement of
                                            amounts due the Certificate Insurer with respect to such Loan Group.
 
Spread Account............................  On the Closing Date the Trustee will establish and thereafter
                                            maintain an account (the 'Spread Account'). If required by the
                                            Certificate Insurer, the holder of the Class R Certificates will
                                            deliver to the Trustee for deposit in the Spread Account the amount
                                            required by the Certificate Insurer. Funds on deposit in the Spread
                                            Account, if any, will be available for withdrawal to fund any
                                            shortfalls between the available funds for distribution to Holders of
                                            the Offered Certificates and the related Interest Remittance Amounts
                                            or Principal Remittance Amounts.
 
The Certificate Insurer...................  Capital Markets Assurance Corporation (the 'Certificate Insurer') is
                                            a New York domiciled insurance company. The Certificate Insurer has
                                            entered into a reinsurance agreement with MBIA Insurance Corporation.
                                            See 'THE POLICY AND THE CERTIFICATE INSURER' herein.
 
                                            Pursuant to the Insurance and Reimbursement Agreement, dated as of
                                            the Cut-Off Date (the 'Insurance Agreement'), among the Certificate
                                            Insurer, the Depositor, the Seller and the Servicer, the Certificate
                                            Insurer will issue a financial guaranty insurance policy (the
                                            'Policy') pursuant to which it will irrevocably and unconditionally
                                            guaranty, among other things, payment on each Distribution Date to
                                            the Trustee for the benefit of the Holders of each Class of Offered
                                            Certificates of the Guaranteed Interest Payment Amount and the
                                            Guaranteed Principal Payment Amount. The terms of the Offered
                                            Certificates and the Agreement may not be amended unless the
                                            Certificate Insurer has given its prior written consent.
 
                                            So long as there does not exist a failure by the Certificate Insurer
                                            to make a required payment under the Policy (such event, a
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-10
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            'Certificate Insurer Default'), the Certificate Insurer will have the
                                            right to exercise all rights of the Holders of the Offered
                                            Certificates under the Agreement without any consent of such Holders,
                                            and such Holders may exercise such rights only with the prior written
                                            consent of the Certificate Insurer except as provided in the
                                            Agreement.
 
Servicing.................................  The Servicer will be responsible for servicing, managing and making
                                            collections on the Home Equity Loans. The Servicer will deposit all
                                            collections in respect of the Home Equity Loans in a Loan Group into
                                            the related Collection Account as described herein. Not later than
                                            the 18th day of the month (or if such 18th day is not a Business Day,
                                            the preceding Business Day) (the 'Determination Date'), the Trustee
                                            will calculate the amounts to be paid, as described herein, to the
                                            Certificateholders on such Distribution Date. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE
                                            CERTIFICATES--Priority of Distributions' herein. With respect to each
                                            Due Period, the Servicer will receive from payments in respect of
                                            interest on the Home Equity Loans actually received, a portion of
                                            such payments as a monthly servicing fee (the 'Servicing Fee') in the
                                            amount of 0.50% per annum (the 'Servicing Fee Rate') on the Principal
                                            Balance of each Home Equity Loan as of the first day of each such Due
                                            Period. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES-- Servicing Compensation
                                            and Payment of Expenses' herein. In certain limited circumstances,
                                            the Servicer may resign or be removed, in which event either the
                                            Back-Up Servicer or a third-party servicer will be appointed as a
                                            successor Servicer. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Certain
                                            Matters Regarding the Servicer' herein.
 
Monthly Advances..........................  The Servicer is required to remit to the Trustee no later than the
                                            close of business on the second Business Day preceding a Distribution
                                            Date for deposit in the applicable Collection Account an amount equal
                                            to the sum of (a) interest accrued on each Home Equity Loan through
                                            the date on which the related monthly payment was due (the 'Due
                                            Date') but not received by the Servicer as of the close of business
                                            on the related Determination Date, net of the Servicing Fee and (b)
                                            with respect to each REO Property which was acquired during or prior
                                            to the related Due Period and as to which a final disposition thereof
                                            did not occur during the related Due Period, an amount equal to the
                                            excess, if any, of interest for the most recently ended Due Period on
                                            the Principal Balance of the Home Equity Loan related to such REO
                                            Property at the related Loan Rate, net of the Servicing Fee, over the
                                            net income from the REO Property transferred to such Collection
                                            Account for such Distribution Date pursuant to the Agreement (the
                                            'Monthly Advance'). The Servicer is not required to make any Monthly
                                            Advances which it determines would be nonrecoverable. Such Monthly
                                            Advances by the Servicer are reimbursable to the Servicer subject to
                                            certain conditions and restrictions. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE
                                            CERTIFICATES-- Advances' herein.
 
Prepayment Interest Shortfalls............  Not later than the second Business Day prior to the related
                                            Distribution Date, the Servicer is required to remit to the Trustee,
                                            up to the amount otherwise payable to the Servicer as its aggregate
                                            Servicing Fee for the related Due Period, without any right of
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-11
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            reimbursement, an amount equal to, with respect to each Home Equity
                                            Loan as to which a principal prepayment in full was received from the
                                            Mortgagor during the related Due Period, the excess, if any, of 30
                                            days' interest on the Principal Balance of such Home Equity Loan at
                                            the Loan Rate (or at such lower rate as may be in effect for such
                                            Home Equity Loan because of application of the Soldiers' and Sailors'
                                            Civil Relief Act of 1940, as amended (the 'Civil Relief Act'), or as
                                            a result of any reduction of the monthly payment due on such Home
                                            Equity Loan as a result of a bankruptcy proceeding (a 'Debt Service
                                            Reduction')) minus the Servicing Fee for such Home Equity Loan over
                                            the amount of interest actually paid by the related Mortgagor in
                                            connection with such principal prepayment (with respect to all such
                                            Home Equity Loans, the 'Prepayment Interest Shortfall').
 
Optional Termination by the Servicer......  On any Distribution Date on which the aggregate of the Loan Group
                                            Balances (the 'Pool Balance') is less than 10% of the sum of (i) the
                                            Pool Balance as of the Cut-Off Date and (ii) the Principal Balance of
                                            the Subsequent Home Equity Loans as of their respective Subsequent
                                            Cut-Off Dates, the Servicer will have the option to purchase, in
                                            whole, the Home Equity Loans and the REO Property, if any, remaining
                                            in the Trust. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Termination;
                                            Retirement of the Certificates' herein.
 
Optional Purchase of Defaulted Home Equity
  Loans...................................  The Servicer has the option, but is not obligated, to purchase from
                                            the Trust any Home Equity Loan 90 days or more delinquent at a
                                            purchase price equal to the outstanding Principal Balance as of the
                                            date of purchase, plus the greater of (i) all accrued and unpaid
                                            interest on such Principal Balance and (ii) 30 days' interest on such
                                            Principal Balance, computed at the Loan Rate, plus all unreimbursed
                                            amounts owing to the Certificate Insurer with interest thereon at the
                                            rate referred to in the Insurance Agreement. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE
                                            CERTIFICATES--Optional Purchase of Defaulted Home Equity Loans'
                                            herein.
 
Certain Federal Tax Considerations........  For federal income tax purposes, each holder of a Fixed Rate
                                            Certificate will be treated as purchasing (1) a REMIC regular
                                            interest with an interest rate equal to the lesser of (a) the
                                            weighted average of the Net Loan Rates of the Home Equity Loans in
                                            Loan Group One and (b) the corresponding fixed Certificate Rate (such
                                            REMIC regular interest, the 'REMIC Regular Interest') and (2) the
                                            rights to receive payments from the Yield Supplement Account. Holders
                                            of Fixed Rate Certificates must allocate their purchase price for
                                            such Certificates between the REMIC Regular Interest and the right to
                                            receive payments from the Yield Supplement Account based on the fair
                                            market value of the REMIC Regular Interest and the rights to receive
                                            payments from the Yield Supplement Account as of the purchase date of
                                            the Fixed Rate Certificate. Holders of Fixed Rate Certificates are
                                            urged to consult their own tax advisers regarding the taxation of the
                                            right to receive payments from the Yield Supplement Account.
 
                                            For federal income tax purposes, an election will be made to treat
                                            certain assets of the Trust as a 'real estate mortgage investment
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-12
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            conduit' (a 'REMIC'). The REMIC Regular Interests and the Variable
                                            Rate Certificates (collectively, the 'REMIC Certificates') will
                                            constitute 'regular interests' in a REMIC and will be treated as debt
                                            instruments of the REMIC and as interests of the Trust for federal
                                            income tax purposes with payment terms equivalent to the terms of
                                            such REMIC Certificates.
 
                                            The Holders of the REMIC Certificates will be required to include in
                                            income interest on such Certificates in accordance with the accrual
                                            method of accounting, and the REMIC Certificates may, depending in
                                            part on their issue price, be treated as having been issued with
                                            original issue discount for federal income tax purposes. The rate at
                                            which original issue discount, if any, will be calculated is the
                                            Prepayment Ramp (as defined herein), in the case of the REMIC Regular
                                            Interests, and 20% CPR (as defined herein), in the case of the
                                            Variable Rate Certificates. No representation is made that the Home
                                            Equity Loans will prepay at that rate or at any other rate. For
                                            further information regarding the federal income tax consequences of
                                            investing in the REMIC Certificates, see 'CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX
                                            CONSIDERATIONS' in the Prospectus.
 
ERISA Considerations......................  Fiduciaries of employee benefit plans subject to Title I of the
                                            Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
                                            ('ERISA'), should consider the ERISA fiduciary investment standards
                                            before authorizing an investment by a plan in the Offered
                                            Certificates. In addition, fiduciaries of: (i) employee benefit plans
                                            subject to Title I of ERISA, (ii) employee benefit plans or other
                                            retirement arrangements (including individual retirement accounts and
                                            certain Keogh plans) which are not subject to ERISA, but which are
                                            subject to Section 4975 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as
                                            amended (the 'Code'), or (iii) any entity whose underlying assets are
                                            deemed to include plan assets by reason of a plan or account
                                            investing in such entity (each, a 'Plan'), should consult with their
                                            legal counsel to determine whether an investment in the Offered
                                            Certificates will cause the assets of the Trust ('Trust Assets') to
                                            be considered plan assets pursuant to the plan asset regulations set
                                            forth in 29 C.F.R. Section2510.3-101, thereby subjecting the Plan to
                                            the prohibited transaction rules with respect to the Trust Assets and
                                            the Trustee and Servicer to the fiduciary investment standards of
                                            ERISA, or cause the excise tax provisions of Section 4975 of the Code
                                            to apply to the Trust Assets, unless some exemption granted by the
                                            Department of Labor applies to the purchase, sale, transfer or
                                            holding of the Offered Certificates.
 
                                            The United States Department of Labor has issued to Bear, Stearns &
                                            Co. Inc. an individual prohibited transaction exemption (the
                                            'Exemption') from certain of the prohibited transaction rules of
                                            ERISA. It is believed that the Exemption will apply to the Offered
                                            Certificates. Prospective Plan investors should consult with their
                                            legal advisors concerning the impact of ERISA and the Code, the
                                            applicability of the Exemption, and the potential consequences in
                                            their specific instances, prior to making an investment in the
                                            Offered Certificates. See 'ERISA CONSIDERATIONS' in the Prospectus.
 
Legal Investment Considerations...........  The Offered Certificates will not constitute 'mortgage related
                                            securities' for purposes of the Secondary Mortgage Market
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-13
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Enhancement Act of 1984 ('SMMEA'). Accordingly, many institutions
                                            with legal authority to invest in comparably rated securities may not
                                            be legally authorized to invest in the Offered Certificates. See
                                            'LEGAL INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS' in the Prospectus.
 
Certificate Ratings.......................  It is a condition to the issuance of each Class of Offered
                                            Certificates that they be rated in the highest rating category by
                                            Standard & Poor's Ratings Group, a division of The McGraw Hill
                                            Companies ('S&P') and Moody's (each a 'Rating Agency'). A security
                                            rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities and
                                            may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the assigning
                                            rating agency. In addition, a security rating does not address or
                                            assess the frequency or likelihood of prepayments on the Home Equity
                                            Loans or the degree to which such prepayments might differ from those
                                            originally anticipated. A rating also does not address the
                                            possibility that holders of the Offered Certificates might suffer a
                                            lower than anticipated yield. See 'RATINGS' and 'RISK
                                            FACTORS--Certificate Rating Is Not A Recommendation' herein.
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-14
<PAGE>
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     Investors should consider, among other things, the following factors in
connection with the purchase of the Offered Certificates.
 
     Trust Is Only Source of Payment.  The Offered Certificates do not represent
an interest in, or the obligation of, the Depositor, the Seller, the Servicer,
the Trustee or any of their respective affiliates. The Offered Certificates will
be payable solely from the Trust. There will be no recourse to the Depositor,
the Seller, the Servicer, the Trustee or any other person for any failure to
receive distributions on the Offered Certificates. Consequently, Holders of the
Offered Certificates must rely solely upon payments with respect to the Home
Equity Loans and the other assets constituting the Trust, including any amounts
available pursuant to the Policy, for the payment of principal of and interest
on such Certificates. Neither the Offered Certificates nor the Home Equity Loans
are insured or guaranteed by any government agency or instrumentality.
 
     Second Mortgages Include Additional Risks.  Approximately 26.49% and 14.68%
(by aggregate Principal Balance as of the Cut-Off Date) of the Initial Home
Equity Loans in Loan Group One and Loan Group Two, respectively, are secured by
second mortgages, which are subordinate to the rights of the mortgagee under the
senior mortgage or mortgages encumbering the related Mortgaged Property ('First
Liens'). The proceeds from any foreclosure, liquidation, insurance or
condemnation proceedings will be available to satisfy the outstanding balance of
such junior mortgage only to the extent that the claims of the mortgagees under
such First Liens have been satisfied in full, including any related foreclosure
costs. In addition, a junior mortgagee may not foreclose on the Mortgaged
Property securing a junior mortgage unless it forecloses subject to the First
Liens, in which case it must either pay the entire amount due on the First Liens
to the mortgagees thereof at or prior to the foreclosure sale or undertake the
obligation to make payments on the First Liens in the event the mortgagor is in
default thereunder. The Trust will not have any source of funds to satisfy the
First Liens or make payments due to the mortgagees thereof.
 
     Liquidation expenses with respect to defaulted home equity loans do not
vary directly with the outstanding principal balance of the loan at the time of
default. Therefore, assuming that a servicer took the same steps in realizing
upon a defaulted home equity loan having a small remaining principal balance as
it would in the case of a defaulted home equity loan having a larger principal
balance, the amount realized after expenses of liquidation would be smaller as a
percentage of the outstanding principal balance of the smaller home equity loan
than would be the case with a larger loan. Because the average outstanding
principal balances of the Home Equity Loans are small relative to the size of
the loans in a typical pool of conventional first mortgages, realizations net of
liquidation expenses on defaulted Home Equity Loans may also be smaller as a
percentage of the principal amount of the Home Equity Loans than would be the
case with respect to a typical pool of conventional first mortgage loans.
 
     There are several factors that could adversely affect the value of
Mortgaged Properties such that the outstanding balance of the related Home
Equity Loan, together with any senior financing on the Mortgaged Properties,
would equal or exceed the value of the Mortgaged Properties. Among the factors
that could adversely affect the value of the Mortgaged Properties are an overall
decline in the residential real estate market in the areas in which the
Mortgaged Properties are located or a decline in the general condition of the
Mortgaged Properties as a result of failure of borrowers to maintain adequately
the Mortgaged Properties or of natural disasters that are not necessarily
covered by insurance, such as earthquakes and floods. Any such decline could
extinguish the value of a junior interest in Mortgaged Property before having
any effect on the related senior interest therein. If such a decline occurs, the
actual rates of delinquencies, foreclosure and losses on the junior Home Equity
Loans could be higher than those currently experienced in the mortgage lending
industry in general.
 
     Prepayments May Fluctuate.  All of the Home Equity Loans may be prepaid in
whole or in part at any time without penalty. Home equity loans, such as the
Home Equity Loans, have been originated in significant volume only during the
past few years and the Depositor is not aware of any publicly available studies
or statistics on the rate of prepayment of such loans. Generally, home equity
loans are not viewed by borrowers as permanent financing. Accordingly, the Home
Equity Loans may experience a higher rate of prepayment than traditional loans.
The prepayment experience of the Trust may be affected by a wide variety of
factors, including general economic conditions, interest rates, the availability
of alternative financing and homeowner mobility. In addition,
 
                                      S-15
<PAGE>
all of the Home Equity Loans contain due-on-sale provisions and the Servicer is
obligated to enforce such provisions unless such enforcement is not permitted by
applicable law.
 
     The rate of prepayments of conventional housing loans and other receivables
has fluctuated significantly in recent years. In general, however, if prevailing
interest rates fall significantly below the interest rates on the Home Equity
Loans, such loans are likely to prepay at rates higher than if prevailing
interest rates remain at or above the interest rates borne by such loans.
 
     Payments on the Home Equity Loans May Vary.  When a principal prepayment in
full is made on a Home Equity Loan, the Mortgagor is charged interest only up to
the date of such prepayment, instead of for a full month. In addition, all of
the fixed rate Home Equity Loans are Simple Interest Loans pursuant to which
interest is computed and charged to the Mortgagor on the outstanding principal
balance of the related Home Equity Loan based on the number of days elapsed
between the date through which interest was last paid on the Home Equity Loan to
receipt of the Mortgagor's most current payment, and the portions of each
monthly payment that are allocated to interest and principal are adjusted based
on the actual amount of interest charged on such basis. Consequently, if less
than a full month has elapsed between the interest paid to date and the next
payment on a Simple Interest Loan, the amount of interest actually paid by the
Mortgagor will be less than a full month's interest on the principal balance of
such Home Equity Loan. Conversely, if more than a full month has elapsed between
payments on a Simple Interest Loan, the amount of interest actually paid by the
Mortgagor will be greater than a full month's interest on the principal balance
of such Home Equity Loan.
 
     Each ARM will be serviced as an Actuarial Loan. Actuarial Loans provide
that interest is charged to each related Mortgagor, and payments are due
therefrom, as of a scheduled day in each month that is fixed at the time of
origination. Scheduled monthly payments by a Mortgagor on an Actuarial Loan
either earlier or later than the scheduled due date therefor will not affect the
amortization schedule or the relative application of such payment to principal
and interest.
 
     Balloon Loans May Affect Distributions.  Approximately 29.08% (by aggregate
Principal Balance as of the Cut-Off Date) of the Initial Home Equity Loans in
Loan Group One have original terms to stated maturity of up to 15 years and
amortization schedules of up to 30 years ('Balloon Loans'), leaving a
substantial payment due at the stated maturity (each, a 'Balloon Payment'). The
ability of a Mortgagor to repay a Balloon Loan at maturity frequently will
depend on such Mortgagor's ability to refinance the Balloon Loan. The ability of
a Mortgagor to refinance such a Balloon Loan will be affected by a number of
factors, including the level of available mortgage rates at the time, the value
of the related Mortgaged Property, the Mortgagor's equity in the related
Mortgaged Property, the financial condition of the Mortgagor, the tax laws and
general economic conditions at the time.
 
     Although a low interest rate environment may facilitate the refinancing of
a Balloon Payment, the receipt and reinvestment by Certificateholders of the
proceeds in such an environment may produce a lower return than that previously
received in respect of the related Home Equity Loan. Conversely, a high interest
rate environment may make it more difficult for the Mortgagor to accomplish a
refinancing and may result in delinquencies or defaults. None of the Depositor,
the Seller, the Servicer or the Trustee will be obligated to provide funds to
refinance any Home Equity Loan.
 
     Pre-Funding May Adversely Affect Investment.  If the principal amount of
eligible Home Equity Loans available during the Pre-Funding Period is less than
100% of the original Pre-Funded Amount, the Depositor will have insufficient
Home Equity Loans to sell to the Trust on the Subsequent Transfer Dates, thereby
resulting in prepayments of principal to Holders of one or more Classes of
Offered Certificates as described herein. Any such principal prepayment may
adversely affect the yield to maturity of the applicable Class or Classes of
Offered Certificates. Since prevailing interest rates are subject to
fluctuation, there can be no assurance that investors will be able to reinvest
such a prepayment at yields equaling or exceeding the yields on the related
Offered Certificates. It is possible that the yield on any such reinvestment
will be lower, and may be significantly lower, than the yield on the related
Offered Certificates.
 
     Each Subsequent Home Equity Loan must satisfy the eligibility criteria set
forth in the Agreement. However, Subsequent Home Equity Loans may be originated
or purchased by the Seller using credit criteria different from those which were
applied to the Initial Home Equity Loans and may be of a lesser credit quality.
 
                                      S-16
<PAGE>
Therefore, following the transfer of Subsequent Home Equity Loans to a Loan
Group, the aggregate characteristics of the Home Equity Loans then held by the
Trust as part of such Loan Group may vary from those of the Initial Home Equity
Loans in such Loan Group.
 
     The ability of the Trust to invest in Subsequent Home Equity Loans is
largely dependent upon whether the Seller is able to originate or purchase home
equity loans which meet the requirements for transfer to the Trust under the
Purchase Agreement and the Agreement. The ability of the Seller to originate or
purchase such mortgage loans is affected by a variety of social and economic
factors. Economic factors include interest rates, unemployment levels, the rate
of inflation and consumer perception of economic conditions generally.
 
     Underwriting Standards May Affect Performance.  As described herein,
Champion's underwriting standards generally are less stringent than those of
FNMA or FHLMC with respect to a borrower's credit history and in certain other
respects. A borrower's past credit history may not preclude Champion from making
a loan; however, it will reduce the size (and consequently the Combined
Loan-to-Value Ratio) of the loan that Champion is willing to make. As a result
of this approach to underwriting, the Home Equity Loans in the Trust may
experience higher rates of delinquencies, defaults and foreclosures than
mortgage loans underwritten in a more traditional manner.
 
     The Servicer Has Limited History.  Prior to June 1993, Champion conducted
its servicing operations through its loan servicing department. These operations
primarily involved servicing home equity loans funded by Champion pending sale
to third parties on a servicing-released basis and servicing home equity loans
retained by Champion. In June 1993, these operations were incorporated into a
separate corporation and, as of March 31, 1996, the Servicer's servicing
portfolio was approximately $348,825,000. The lack of a significant servicing
portfolio may make it more difficult to assess the likely delinquency and loss
experience on the Home Equity Loans. The Back-Up Servicer will be obligated
pursuant to the Agreement to maintain current servicing records for the Home
Equity Loans and to recalculate certain servicing information furnished by the
Servicer to the Trustee on a monthly basis. See 'THE SELLER AND THE SERVICER,'
'CHAMPION'S HOME EQUITY LOAN PROGRAM' and 'DESCRIPTION OF THE
CERTIFICATES--Back-Up Servicer' herein.
 
     Geographic Concentration May Affect Performance.  Approximately 79.04% and
74.58% (by aggregate Principal Balance as of the Cut-Off Date) of the Initial
Home Equity Loans in Loan Group One and Loan Group Two, respectively, are
secured by Mortgaged Properties located in New Jersey and New York. To the
extent that the Northeast region has experienced or may experience in the future
weaker economic conditions or greater rates of decline in real estate values
than the United States generally, such a concentration of the Home Equity Loans
may be expected to exacerbate the foregoing risks. The Depositor can neither
quantify the impact of any recent property value declines on the Home Equity
Loans nor predict whether, to what extent or for how long such declines may
continue.
 
     Book-Entry Registration May Affect Liquidity.  Issuance of the Offered
Certificates in book-entry form may reduce the liquidity of such Certificates in
the secondary trading market since investors may be unwilling to purchase
Offered Certificates for which they cannot obtain physical certificates.
 
     Since transactions in the Offered Certificates will, in most cases, be able
to be effected only through Participants, Indirect Participants and certain
banks, the ability of a Certificate Owner (defined herein under 'DESCRIPTION OF
THE CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Registration') to pledge an Offered Certificate to
persons or entities that do not participate in the DTC system, or otherwise to
take actions in respect of such certificate, may be limited due to lack of a
physical certificate representing the Certificates.
 
     Certificate Owners may experience some delay in their receipt of
distributions of interest on and principal of the Offered Certificates since
distributions will be required to be forwarded by the Trustee to DTC and DTC
will be required to credit such distributions to the accounts of its
Participants which thereafter will be required to credit them to the accounts of
the applicable Certificate Owners either directly or indirectly through Indirect
Participants. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Book-Entry Registration'
herein.
 
     Certificate Rating Is Not A Recommendation.  The rating of the Offered
Certificates will depend primarily on an assessment by the Rating Agencies of
the Home Equity Loans and upon the claims-paying ability of the Certificate
Insurer. Any reduction in a rating assigned to the claims-paying ability of the
Certificate Insurer below the rating initially given to the Offered Certificates
may result in a reduction in the rating of such Certificates.
 
                                      S-17
<PAGE>
The rating by the Rating Agencies of the Offered Certificates is not a
recommendation to purchase, hold or sell the Offered Certificates, inasmuch as
such rating does not comment as to the market price or suitability for a
particular investor. There is no assurance that the ratings will remain in place
for any given period of time or that the ratings will not be lowered or
withdrawn by the Rating Agencies.
 
                      DESCRIPTION OF THE HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
GENERAL
 
     The Initial Home Equity Loans were, and any Subsequent Home Equity Loans
will be, originated by the Seller or an affiliate in accordance with the
policies set forth under 'CHAMPION'S HOME EQUITY LOAN PROGRAM.' All of the
Initial Home Equity Loans are, and all Subsequent Home Equity Loans will be,
home equity loans bearing fixed or adjustable interest rates (the 'Loan Rates')
and evidenced by promissory notes (the 'Mortgage Notes') secured by deeds of
trust, security deeds or mortgages on Mortgaged Properties.
 
     The Home Equity Loans are secured by either first or second mortgages or
deeds of trust on Mortgaged Properties located in seven states and the District
of Columbia. The Mortgaged Properties securing the Home Equity Loans consist
primarily of one- to four-family residential properties. The Mortgaged
Properties may be owner-occupied and non-owner occupied (which includes second
and vacation homes). The Home Equity Loans will be divided into two groups
(each, a 'Loan Group'): 'Loan Group One' and 'Loan Group Two.'
 
     Each Home Equity Loan (including Subsequent Home Equity Loans, if any) in
Loan Group One will be a Simple Interest Loan bearing interest at a fixed rate.
Certain of the Home Equity Loans in Loan Group One will have original terms to
stated maturity of up to 15 years and amortization schedules of up to 30 years
('Balloon Loans'), leaving a substantial payment due at the stated maturity
(each, a 'Balloon Payment').
 
     Each Home Equity Loan (including Subsequent Home Equity Loans, if any) in
Loan Group Two will bear interest at an adjustable rate and will be serviced as
an Actuarial Loan. The Loan Rate borne by each ARM is subject to adjustment
annually on the date set forth in the related Mortgage Note (each, a 'Change
Date') to equal the sum of (i) the weekly average yield on U.S. Treasury
securities adjusted to a constant maturity of one year, as made available by the
Federal Reserve Board as of the date 45 days before the applicable Change Date
(the 'Index') and (ii) the number of basis points set forth in such Mortgage
Note (the 'Gross Margin'), subject to rounding and to the effects of the
Periodic Cap, the applicable Lifetime Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor. The
'Periodic Cap' limits changes in the Loan Rate for each ARM on each Change Date
to 200 basis points. The 'Lifetime Cap' is the maximum Loan Rate that may be
borne by an ARM over its life and is equal to the sum of (i) the initial Loan
Rate for such ARM and (ii) 600 basis points. The 'Lifetime Floor' is the minimum
Loan Rate that may be borne by an ARM over its life and is equal to the initial
Loan Rate for such ARM. The ARMs do not provide for negative amortization.
 
STATISTICAL INFORMATION
 
     Set forth below is certain summary statistical information regarding the
Initial Home Equity Loans expected to be included in each Loan Group as of the
Closing Date. All such information is approximate and is given as of the Cut-Off
Date. More detailed statistical information is set forth in Appendix A. Prior to
the Closing Date, Home Equity Loans may be removed from either Loan Group and
other Home Equity Loans may be substituted therefor. In addition, Home Equity
Loans may be prepaid at any time. As a result, certain characteristics of the
Home Equity Loans in one or both Loan Groups may vary from the characteristics
set forth below and in Appendix A as of the Cut-Off Date.
 
     Loan Group One.  With respect to the Initial Home Equity Loans in Loan
Group One as of the Cut-Off Date: the Principal Balances ranged from $9,728 to
$455,000; the average Principal Balance was $63,855; the Loan Rates ranged from
7.250% to 16.990%; the weighted average Loan Rate was 10.186%; the original
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios ranged from 5.75% to 100.00%; the weighted average
original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio was 65.17%; the remaining terms to stated
maturity of the Balloon Loans ranged from 173 months to 180 months; the weighted
average remaining term to stated maturity of the Balloon Loans was 179 months;
the remaining terms to stated maturity of the non-Balloon Loans ranged from 59
months to
 
                                      S-18
<PAGE>
360 months; the weighted average remaining term to stated maturity of the
non-Balloon Loans was 215 months; approximately 29.08% of the Home Equity Loans
are Balloon Loans; the number of months since funding ranged from 0 months to 7
months; the weighted average number of months since funding was 1 month; and no
more than 2.05% of the Home Equity Loans will be secured by Mortgaged Properties
located in any one postal zip code area.
 
     Loan Group Two.  With respect to the Initial Home Equity Loans in Loan
Group Two as of the Cut-Off Date: the Principal Balances ranged from $9,954 to
$414,676; the average Principal Balance was $71,807; the current Loan Rates
ranged from 7.125% to 11.990%; the weighted average current Loan Rate was
8.654%; the original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios ranged from 6.03% to 80.00%;
the weighted average original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio was 67.83%; the
remaining terms to stated maturity ranged from 119 months to 360 months; the
weighted average remaining term to stated maturity was 301 months; the number of
months since funding ranged from 0 months to 2 months; the weighted average
number of months since funding was 1 month; the Gross Margins ranged from 4.350%
to 8.625%; the weighted average Gross Margin was 5.541%; the Lifetime Floors
ranged from 7.125% to 11.990%; the weighted average Lifetime Floor was 8.654%;
the Lifetime Caps ranged from 13.125% to 17.990%; the weighted average Lifetime
Cap was 14.654%; the weighted average number of months to the next Change Date
was 11 months; and no more than 1.46% of the Home Equity Loans are secured by
Mortgaged Properties located in any one postal zip code area.
 
SUBSEQUENT HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
     The Depositor expects to sell Subsequent Home Equity Loans to the Trust
during the Pre-Funding Period for inclusion in the applicable Loan Group. The
purchase price for each Subsequent Home Equity Loan will equal the outstanding
principal balance thereof as of the opening of business on the first day of the
month in which such Subsequent Home Equity Loan is transferred to the Trust
(each, a 'Subsequent Cut-Off Date') and will be paid by withdrawal of funds on
deposit in the Pre-Funding Account allocated to the applicable Loan Group. The
Subsequent Home Equity Loans may have been originated more recently than, and
may have other characteristics which differ from, the Initial Home Equity Loans
in each Loan Group. As a result, following any sale of Subsequent Home Equity
Loans to the Trust, the description of the Loan Groups set forth above and in
Appendix A may not accurately reflect the characteristics of all of the Initial
Home Equity Loans and Subsequent Home Equity Loans in such Loan Groups. However,
the Subsequent Home Equity Loans must conform to the representations and
warranties set forth in the Purchase Agreement and the Agreement. Following the
end of the Pre-Funding Period, the Depositor expects that the Home Equity Loans
(including Subsequent Home Equity Loans) in Loan Group One and Loan Group Two
will have the following approximate characteristics:
 
LOAN GROUP ONE
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                        <C>
Average Unpaid Principal Balance........................................   no more than $70,000
Weighted Average Loan Rate..............................................   at least 10.000%
Weighted Average Remaining Term to Stated Maturity
  Balloon...............................................................   no more than 180 months
  Non-Balloon...........................................................   no more than 215 months
Weighted Average Original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio..................   no more than 70.00%
Weighted Average Loan Age...............................................   0 months--1 month
Loans Secured by Primary Residences.....................................   at least 90.00%
Single Family Detached..................................................   at least 70.00%
</TABLE>
 
LOAN GROUP TWO
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                                                        <C>
Average Unpaid Principal Balance........................................   no more than $90,000
Weighted Average Initial Loan Rate......................................   at least 8.500%
Weighted Average Remaining Term to Stated Maturity......................   no more than 310 months
Weighted Average Original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio..................   no more than 70.00%
Weighted Average Loan Age...............................................   0 months--1 month
Weighted Average Gross Margin...........................................   at least 5.00%
Loans Secured by Primary Residences.....................................   at least 90.00%
Single Family Detached..................................................   at least 70.00%
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-19
<PAGE>
                          THE SELLER AND THE SERVICER
 
     Champion Mortgage Co., Inc. ('Champion' or 'Seller', as the context
requires) is a wholly owned subsidiary of Key Bank USA, National Association, a
national banking association ('Key Bank USA'). Key Bank USA is engaged in
banking and related activities. Key Bank USA is a wholly owned subsidiary of
KeyCorp, an Ohio financial services holding company headquartered in Cleveland,
Ohio ('KeyCorp'). KeyCorp completed the acquisition of Champion effective August
29, 1997 in a transaction structured as a tax-free exchange and accounted for as
a purchase.
 
     Prior to the acquisition of Champion by KeyCorp, Champion conducted its
various business activities directly and through a number of affiliated
companies. Immediately prior to the acquisition of Champion, all affiliated
companies, including the Servicer, were consolidated into Champion Mortgage Co.,
Inc. Champion is a mortgage banking company which originates non-conforming home
equity loans secured by first or second liens primarily on one to four-family
residential properties.
 
     Champion expanded its operations in 1988. From October 1, 1988 to March 31,
1998, Champion has funded approximately $2.59 billion of mortgage loans. For the
fiscal years ended September 30, 1997, September 30, 1996 and September 30, 1995
Champion funded $580.5 million, $501.6 million and $296.7 million, respectively,
of mortgage loans. For the six months ended March 31, 1998, Champion funded
approximately $423.2 million of mortgage loans. Champion discontinued its
origination of conforming first mortgage loans as of May, 1994. During the
fiscal year ended September 30, 1997, approximately 67% and 33% of Champion's
originations were secured by first liens and second liens, respectively. During
the six months ended March 31, 1998, approximately 74% and 26% of Champion's
originations were secured by first liens and second liens, respectively.
 
     Substantially all of Champion's mortgage loans have been originated
directly by Champion through its own employees located at its corporate
headquarters or at any of its sixteen branch offices located in New Jersey, New
York, Pennsylvania, Rhode Island and Maryland. Champion makes extensive use of
advertising, including direct mailing, to locate potential customers and
generally conducts the application and loan approval process in person. As of
March 31, 1998, Champion was originating mortgage loans secured by residential
properties in New Jersey, New York, Connecticut, Pennsylvania, Delaware,
Maryland, Virginia, Rhode Island, the District of Columbia, Colorado and
Illinois.
 
     Until June 1993, Champion sold the majority of its loan production to
institutional investors pursuant to bulk purchase or flow-purchase agreements.
The mortgage loans were sold at a premium, on a rate participation basis or
based on a combination of both methods. All mortgage loans were sold on a
servicing released, non-recourse basis. In June 1993, Champion began to sell
mortgage loans on a servicing retained basis. In September 1994, Champion began
securitizing and servicing mortgage loans in various trusts established in
connection with such securitizations. As of March 31, 1998, Champion was
servicing approximately $1.1 billion of mortgage loans for itself and others.
 
     As of the end of March 1998, Champion had approximately 533 employees.
Champion occupies 70,101 square feet in a four story building located at 20
Waterview Boulevard, Parsippany, New Jersey 07054. Its telephone number is (973)
402-7700.
 
                      CHAMPION'S HOME EQUITY LOAN PROGRAM
 
GENERAL
 
     Champion's principal product is a closed end, fixed rate, fully amortizing
mortgage loan with an original term to maturity of 15 years. Champion also
offers fixed rate fully-amortizing mortgage loans with original terms to
maturity of 5, 7, 10, 20 and 30 years and fixed rate mortgage loans with
original terms to maturity of 5 or 7 years and an amortization schedule of up to
15 years or an original term to maturity of up to 15 years and an amortization
schedule of up to 30 years. Champion also offers closed end, adjustable rate,
fully-amortizing mortgage loans with original terms to maturity of either 15 or
30 years. Each adjustable rate mortgage loan provides for annual adjustments
based on changes in the level of the Index, subject to rounding, the Periodic
Cap and the applicable Lifetime Cap and the applicable Lifetime Floor.
 
                                      S-20
<PAGE>
     In most instances, Champion's mortgage loans are non-purchase money
mortgages secured by first or second liens on owner-occupied one- to four-family
residential properties, including townhouses and individual units in
condominiums and planned unit developments. In the fiscal year ended September
30, 1995 and the six months ended March 31, 1996, approximately 95.4% and 95.2%,
respectively, of the mortgage loans originated by Champion were secured by owner
occupied residences. Champion also makes mortgage loans secured by first or
second liens on residential rental properties or vacation properties.
 
     All of Champion's fixed rate mortgage loans are Simple Interest Loans. A
Simple Interest Loan provides for a series of substantially equal monthly
payments which, if paid when due, will fully amortize the amount financed by the
scheduled maturity date. Each monthly payment includes an installment of
interest which is calculated on the basis of the outstanding principal balance
of the mortgage loan multiplied by the stated Loan Rate and further multiplied
by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of days in the period
elapsed since the preceding payment of interest was made and the denominator of
which is the number of days in the annual period for which interest accrues on
such loan. As payments are received under a Simple Interest Loan, the amount
received is applied first to interest accrued to the date of payment and the
balance is applied to reduce the unpaid principal balance. Accordingly, if a
borrower pays a fixed monthly installment on a Simple Interest Loan before its
scheduled due date, the portion of the payment allocable to interest for the
period since the preceding payment was made will be less than it would have been
had the payment been made as scheduled, and the portion of the payment applied
to reduce the unpaid principal balance will be correspondingly greater.
Conversely, if a borrower pays the fixed monthly installment after the scheduled
due date, the portion of the payment allocable to interest will be greater, and
the amortization of the unpaid principal balance will be correspondingly less.
 
     All of Champion's mortgage loans may be prepaid by the borrowers in whole
or in part at any time without penalty. Late charges are assessed on loans for
which payments are made after applicable grace periods established by federal
and state laws. None of Champion's mortgage loans are insured or guaranteed by
any governmental agency or instrumentality, and none are covered by primary
mortgage guaranty insurance policies.
 
UNDERWRITING PROCEDURES
 
     The following is a description of the underwriting procedures customarily
employed by Champion with respect to fixed rate and adjustable rate mortgage
loans secured by first or second liens primarily on one- to four-family
residential properties. Champion's underwriting process, which is centralized at
its corporate headquarters, is intended to assess the applicant's credit
standing and repayment ability and the value and adequacy of the real property
security as collateral for the proposed loan. Champion considers itself to be a
credit lender as opposed to an equity lender, focusing primarily on the
borrower's ability and willingness to repay, and only secondarily on the
potential value of the collateral upon foreclosure, in determining whether or
not to make a mortgage loan. As of March 31, 1996, Champion employed 72 loan
officers and 11 underwriters. Underwriters are primarily promoted from within
Champion on a selective basis in order to maintain the quality and integrity of
Champion's business philosophy. All underwriters receive fixed annual salaries
which are not based on underwriting volume.
 
     The application process generally is conducted by telephone. Each applicant
for a mortgage loan is required to supply the information necessary to complete
an application which lists the applicant's liabilities, income, credit and
employment history and other demographic and personal information. If the
information in the loan application demonstrates that the applicant has
sufficient income and that there is sufficient equity in the real property to
justify making a mortgage loan, the loan officer will conduct a further credit
investigation of the applicant. This investigation includes obtaining and
reviewing an independent credit bureau report on the credit history of the
applicant in order to evaluate the applicant's ability to repay. The credit
report typically contains information relating to such matters as credit history
with local merchants and lenders, installment debt payments and any record of
defaults, bankruptcy, collateral repossessions, suits or judgments. Any adverse
information contained in the credit report must be acceptable (and if requested,
explained) to the loan officer.
 
     Based on the information obtained from the applicant, the loan officer
advises the applicant of the loan program for which the applicant qualifies.
Upon gaining the agreement of the applicant, the loan officer submits the
application to the underwriting department for further review. An underwriter
will then evaluate the
 
                                      S-21
<PAGE>
submission in accordance with certain established guidelines. The underwriter
will either approve, reject, or amend the loan request based on the information
submitted in the application. If the applicant accepts the amendment, the
underwriter will approve the amended loan application.
 
     The application is then further processed to verify the accuracy of the
information therein. Verification may take the form of written or verbal
communication with the applicant's employer or recent pay stubs and current W-2
forms supplied by the applicant. Income tax returns also may be obtained and
reviewed. Self-employed borrowers generally are required to have been in
business for at least two years and must provide signed federal income tax
returns, including all schedules thereto, for the past two tax years, and may be
required to furnish personal and business financial statements if deemed
necessary by the underwriter.
 
     In certain circumstances, Champion may not be able to verify the income
claimed on the application but is able to document adequate cashflow to support
the loan for which the application was made. In such circumstances, the
permitted combined loan-to-value ratio will be less than otherwise would be the
case. Approximately 32.58% (by aggregate Principal Balance as of the Cut-Off
Date) of the Initial Home Equity Loans in Loan Group One were underwritten using
such alternative approach to income verification. None of the Initial Home
Equity Loans in Loan Group Two were so underwritten.
 
     If there is a senior mortgage on the property to be used as security for
the mortgage loan, the loan officer also evaluates the type and outstanding
balance of the senior mortgage loan and its payment history. Champion obtains a
credit reference on the senior mortgage by using either credit bureau
information, telephone verification, the year-end senior mortgage statement,
canceled checks or written verification from the senior mortgagee.
 
     In every instance, the property securing a loan made by Champion is
appraised and title insurance acquired before the loan is closed. Champion
requires appraisals on all properties that will secure its mortgage loans. Such
appraisals are conducted by approved, independent third-party appraisers who are
paid a fee by the applicant, regardless of whether the application for a
mortgage loan is approved. All appraisals are required to be on forms approved
by FNMA or FHLMC. Champion obtains a lender's title insurance policy or binder,
or other assurance of title customary in the relevant jurisdiction. Homeowners
insurance coverage is required on every property securing a home equity loan
originated by Champion. Necessary coverage and mortgagee clause endorsements are
acquired and monitored by the loan servicing department. Forced-placed policies
are acquired for properties in which the borrower has allowed coverage to lapse.
 
     After obtaining all applicable employment, credit and property information,
Champion determines whether sufficient unencumbered equity in the property
exists and whether the prospective borrower has sufficient monthly income
available to support the payments of principal and interest on the mortgage loan
in addition to any senior mortgage loan payments (including any escrows for
property taxes and hazard insurance premiums) and other monthly credit
obligations. Champion applies the 'debt-to-gross income ratio' which is the
ratio of the borrower's total monthly payments on all outstanding debt
(including the new loan) to the borrower's gross verifiable monthly income. The
debt-to-gross income ratio generally may not exceed 45%. For ARMs, such ratios
generally are calculated using the 'fully indexed' rate (i.e., the sum of the
applicable Index and the related Gross Margin). In addition, the maximum
Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of any mortgage loan may not exceed 100% and may be
reduced depending on a number of factors, including the applicant's credit
history and employment status.
 
     Any exceptions to the underwriting policies may be approved by the manager
of the underwriting department or a member of the Goryeb family. The factors
considered when determining if an exception to the general underwriting
standards should be made include: the quality of the property, how long the
borrower has owned the property, the amount of disposable income, the type and
length of employment, the credit history, the current and pending debt
obligations, the payment habits and the status of past and currently existing
mortgages.
 
     When an application is approved, a mortgage loan is completed by signing
the applicable loan documents, including a promissory note and mortgage. All
mortgage loans are closed by approved attorneys. Following the three business
day rescission period required by the federal Truth-in-Lending Act, a mortgage
loan is fully funded. Scheduled repayment of principal and interest on such loan
generally begins one month from the date
 
                                      S-22
<PAGE>
interest starts to accrue. After a mortgage loan is underwritten, approved and
funded, the loan package is reviewed by an employee.
 
REFINANCING POLICY
 
     Where Champion believes that borrowers having existing loans with Champion
are likely to refinance such loans due to interest rate changes or other
reasons, Champion actively attempts to retain such borrowers through
solicitations of such borrowers to refinance with Champion. Such refinancings
generate fee and servicing income for Champion. Since the solicited borrowers
may refinance their existing loans in any case, Champion believes that this
practice will be unlikely to affect the prepayment experience of the mortgage
loans in a material respect. Champion also has solicited its borrowers who are
in good standing to apply for additional loans, consistent with its origination
standards where deemed appropriate.
 
SERVICING OF HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
     The Servicer has established standard policies for the servicing and
collection of the mortgage loans. Servicing includes, but is not limited to,
post-origination loan processing, customer service, collections, remittance
processing and liquidations.
 
     The Servicer sends a monthly statement to each of its borrowers. Collection
procedures vary somewhat depending on whether a late payment is the first
payment due under the mortgage loan. If the first payment is not received on or
prior to the due date, an initial phone call is made on the first business day
after the due date. Phone calls continue on a daily basis until contact is made.
A 'Friendly Reminder Letter' is sent on the second business day after the due
date. If no contact is made with the borrower by the 10th day after the due
date, a 'Pre-foreclosure Letter' is sent, and a qualified outside agency is used
to inspect the property. On the 20th day after a first payment default a Notice
of Default is sent to the borrower. This letter indicates an intent to
accelerate the mortgage loan if satisfactory arrangements are not made within
ten days.
 
     If the delinquency relates to a due date other than the first due date, a
Friendly Reminder Letter is sent on the second business day after the due date.
On the fifth day after the due date, telephone calls to the borrower begin and
telephone calls continue on a daily basis until payment is received or contact
is made. In addition, a series of mailings is made depending on the customer's
payment history. On the 20th day of delinquency a Notice of Default is sent. A
qualified outside agency is used to conduct an interview with the borrower and
the property is inspected.
 
     Accounts which are 32 days past due without a specific arrangement for
repayment will be sent a Notice of Intent to Foreclosure which gives the
customer five days in which to respond. On the 37th day of delinquency, a
determination whether to foreclose is made. If the Servicer decides to
foreclose, the necessary documentation is sent to an approved attorney who then
sends the borrower an acceleration letter allowing the borrower 30 days to
reinstate the mortgage. When foreclosure proceedings are initiated, a third
party appraiser completes a drive-by evaluation of the property and obtains
comparable sales prices and listings in the area. In addition, homeowner's
insurance is verified and the status of senior mortgages and property taxes is
checked. Subject to applicable state law, all legal expenses are assessed to the
account and become the responsibility of the borrower.
 
     Regulations and practices regarding the liquidation of properties (e.g.,
foreclosure) and the rights of the borrower in default vary greatly from state
to state. The Servicer will decide that liquidation is the appropriate course of
action only if a delinquency cannot otherwise be cured. If the Servicer
determines that purchasing a property securing a mortgage loan will minimize the
loss associated with such defaulted loan, the Servicer may bid at the
foreclosure sale for such property or accept a deed in lieu of foreclosure.
 
     Servicing and collection practices may change over time in accordance with,
among other things, the Servicer's business judgment, changes in the portfolio
and applicable laws and regulations. Any realization from the sale of foreclosed
property is taken as a recovery. After the Servicer acquires title to a
mortgaged property by foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure, an approved
realtor is selected to list and advertise the property.
 
     The Servicer may not foreclose on the property securing a junior mortgage
loan unless it forecloses subject to all senior mortgages. If any senior
mortgage loan is in default after the Servicer has initiated its foreclosure
actions, the Servicer may advance funds to keep such senior mortgage loan
current until such time as the Servicer
 
                                      S-23
<PAGE>
satisfies such senior mortgage loan. Such amounts are added to the balance of
the mortgage loan. In the event that foreclosure proceedings have been
instituted on any senior mortgage prior to the initiation of the Servicer's
foreclosure action, the Servicer will either satisfy the senior mortgage loan at
the time of the foreclosure sale or take other action to protect its interest in
the related property.
 
DELINQUENCY AND LOSS EXPERIENCE
 
     As described above under 'THE SELLER AND SERVICER,' Champion historically
has sold the majority of its loan production on a servicing-released basis. Such
mortgage loans typically are sold within 30 to 60 days after funding and are
serviced by the Servicer pending completion of the sale. In addition, the
Servicer services mortgage loans retained by Champion. Champion has no reliable
delinquency or loss information with respect to the mortgage loans it has sold.
Set forth below is the delinquency and loss experience on the mortgage loans
serviced by the Servicer (and prior to formation of the Servicer, by the Seller)
for the periods and at the dates indicated.
 
                             DELINQUENCY EXPERIENCE
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                             SIX MONTHS ENDING
                                                            YEAR ENDING SEPTEMBER 30,            MARCH 31,
                                                          ------------------------------    --------------------
                                                           1993       1994        1995        1995        1996
                                                          -------    -------    --------    --------    --------
<S>                                                       <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>         <C>
Number of loans........................................       745      1,588       4,416       2,806       6,419
Dollar amount of loans.................................   $36,214    $75,916    $214,860    $133,193    $348,825
Delinquency Period
  30-59 days
  % of number of loans(1)..............................      1.07%      0.12%       1.18%       0.52%       1.08%
  % of dollar amount of loans(2).......................      0.42%      0.07%       1.12%       0.62%       1.08%
  60-89 days
  % of number of loans(1)..............................      0.13%      0.06%       0.25%       0.14%       0.06%
  % of dollar amount of loans(2)                             0.08%      0.05%       0.16%       0.21%       0.07%
  90 days and over(3)
  % of number of loans(1)..............................      0.94%      0.00%       0.38%       0.10%       0.63%
  % of dollar amount of loans(2).......................      0.76%      0.00%       0.46%       0.09%       0.67%
Foreclosed Properties
  % of number of loans(1)..............................      0.67%      0.00%       0.21%       0.07%       0.41%
  % of dollar amount of loans(2).......................      0.56%      0.00%       0.30%       0.06%       0.56%
Total(3)
  % of number of loans(1)..............................      2.14%      0.18%       1.81%       0.76%       1.77%
  % of dollar amount of loans(2).......................      1.26%      0.12%       1.74%       0.92%       1.82%
</TABLE>
 
- ------------------
 
(1) The number of delinquent loans as a percentage of the total 'Number of
    loans' as of the date indicated.
 
(2) The dollar amount of delinquent loans as a percentage of the total 'Dollar
    amount of loans' as of date indicated.
 
(3) Includes foreclosures and REO.
 
                                      S-24
<PAGE>
                                LOSS EXPERIENCE
                             (DOLLARS IN THOUSANDS)
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            YEAR ENDING SEPTEMBER 30,             SIX MONTHS ENDING MARCH 31,
                                          ------------------------------    -------------------------------------
                                           1993       1994        1995            1995           1996 
                                          -------    -------    --------    -------------------------------------
<S>                                       <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>
Average dollar amount of loans
  outstanding during period............   $25,765    $43,374    $144,7         $ 108,717       $ 283,761
Net Losses (Gains) (1).................   $   199    $   146    $    145       $     (21)      $      25
Net Losses (Gains) as a percentage of                                                                 
  average amount outstanding...........      0.77%      0.34%       0.10%          (0.04%)(2)       0.02%(2)
 
 
- ------------------
(1) 'Net Losses' means Gross Losses minus Recoveries.
(2) Annualized.
 
     The delinquency and loss experience set forth above represents the
experience with respect to only a portion of Champion's loan production for the
periods indicated. In addition, because the majority of Champion's loan
production typically is sold within 30 to 60 days after funding, many of the
mortgage loans serviced by the Servicer are not serviced long enough for such
mortgage loans to give rise to some or all of the periods of delinquency or loss
reflected in the tables above. In the absence of such sales, the delinquency and
loss experience reflected in the above tables could be substantially different.
In addition, Champion only began originating ARMs in September, 1994. Champion
has no meaningful basis on which to assess the possible delinquency and loss
experience of the ARMs. The delinquencies and losses on the ARMs could be
significantly higher than those on Champion's fixed rate Home Equity Loans.
Until such time as Champion develops a meaningful servicing portfolio, the
reported delinquency and loss experience is unlikely to have any predictive
value with respect to the delinquency and loss experience of the Home Equity
Loans. As a result, it is unlikely that the delinquency and loss experience on
the Home Equity Loans will be comparable to that reported above.
 
                      PREPAYMENT AND YIELD CONSIDERATIONS
 
GENERAL
 
     The rate of principal payments on a Class of Offered Certificates, the
aggregate amount of distributions on such Certificates and the yield to maturity
of such Certificates will be related to the rate and timing of payments of
principal on the Home Equity Loans in the related Loan Group. The rate of
principal payments on the Home Equity Loans will in turn be affected by the
amortization schedules of the Home Equity Loans (including, in the case of ARMs,
changes thereto to accommodate changes in the Loan Rate) and by the rate of
principal prepayments (including for this purpose prepayments resulting from
refinancing, liquidations of the Home Equity Loans due to defaults, casualties,
condemnations and repurchases by the Seller or purchases by the Servicer). The
Home Equity Loans may be prepaid by the Mortgagors at any time without a
prepayment penalty.
 
     Prepayments, liquidations and purchases of the Home Equity Loans (including
any optional purchase by the Servicer of a defaulted Home Equity Loan and any
optional purchase of the remaining Home Equity Loans in connection with the
termination of the Trust, in each case as described herein) will result in
distributions on the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates of
principal amounts which would otherwise be distributed over the remaining terms
of the Home Equity Loans. In addition, any Pre-Funded Amount allocated to a Loan
Group remaining at the end of the Pre-Funding Period will be distributed as a
prepayment of the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates. Since the
rate of payment of principal of the Home Equity Loans will depend on future
events and a variety of factors, no assurance can be given as to such rate or
the rate of principal prepayments. The extent to which the yield to maturity of
an Offered Certificate may vary from the anticipated yield will depend upon the
degree to which such Certificate is purchased at a discount or premium.
 
     The prepayment experience on non-conventional home equity loans may differ
from that on conventional first mortgage loans, primarily due to the credit
quality of the typical borrower. Because the credit histories of many home
equity borrowers may preclude them from other traditional sources of financing,
such borrowers may be less likely to refinance due to a decline in market
interest rates. Non-conventional home equity loans may experience more
prepayments in a rising interest rate environment as the borrowers' finances are
stressed to the point of default.
 
                                      S-25
<PAGE>
     The rate of prepayments on the Home Equity Loans cannot be predicted. Home
equity loans such as the Home Equity Loans have been originated in significant
volume only during the past few years and the Depositor is not aware of any
publicly available studies or statistics on the rate of prepayment of such home
equity loans. Generally, home equity loans are not viewed by borrowers as
permanent financing. Accordingly, the Home Equity Loans may experience a higher
rate of prepayment than traditional first mortgage loans. The prepayment
experience of the Trust with respect to the Home Equity Loans may be affected by
a wide variety of factors, including economic conditions, prevailing interest
rate levels, the availability of alternative financing and homeowner mobility
and changes affecting the deductibility for federal income tax purposes of
interest payments on home equity loans. All of the Home Equity Loans contain
'due-on-sale' provisions, and the Servicer is required by the Agreement to
enforce such provisions, unless such enforcement is not permitted by applicable
law. The enforcement of a 'due-on-sale' provision will have the same effect as a
prepayment of the related Home Equity Loan. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF
LOANS--Due-on-Sale Clauses in Home Equity Loans' in the Prospectus. No assurance
can be given as to the level of prepayments that will be experienced by the
Trust and it can be expected that a portion of borrowers will not prepay their
Home Equity Loans to any significant degree.
 
OVERCOLLATERALIZATION
 
     The overcollateralization and cross collateralization features described
herein will affect the rate and timing of principal distributions on the Offered
Certificates, and consequently the average life and yield to maturity. On any
Distribution Date on which the Overcollateralization Amount for a Loan Group is
less than the related Required Overcollateralization Amount, the Remaining Net
Excess Spread for such Loan Group, the Available Transfer Cashflow and the Net
Excess Principal will be used to reduce the Class Certificate Balance of the
related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates through the distribution of
Additional Principal. Until such time, if any, that the Overcollateralization
Amount for a Loan Group equals the related Required Overcollateralization
Amount, there will be no Available Transfer Cashflow or Net Excess Principal to
accelerate the amortization of the other Class or Classes of Offered
Certificates. Home Equity Loans with higher Loan Rates contribute more interest
to the Excess Spread than do Home Equity Loans with relatively lower Loan Rates.
If Home Equity Loans with higher Loan Rates were to prepay, the amount of Net
Excess Spread could be reduced thereby slowing the amortization of the Class
Certificate Balance of the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates from
the distribution of Additional Principal.
 
     Because the Excess Spread for a Loan Group is available to cover an
Available Funds Shortfall with respect to both the related Loan Group and the
other Loan Group, there may be no Remaining Net Excess Spread with which to make
payments of Additional Principal. Similarly, any Excess Principal for a Loan
Group will be applied to cover an Available Funds Shortfall in the other Loan
Group prior to being applied to the payment of Additional Principal for the
Class or Classes of Offered Certificates related to such other Loan Group. Thus,
the amount and timing of any distributions in respect of Additional Principal on
a Class of Offered Certificates will depend, in part, on the prepayment and loss
experience of the Home Equity Loans in the Loan Group related to the other Class
or Classes of Offered Certificates.
 
     The application of Remaining Net Excess Spread, Available Transfer Cashflow
and Net Excess Principal to payments of Additional Principal is intended to
create overcollateralization to provide a source of additional cashflow to cover
losses on the Home Equity Loans in each Loan Group. If the amount of losses in a
particular Due Period exceeds the amount of Excess Spread for the related Loan
Group and the Net Excess Spread and Excess Principal for the other Loan Group
for the related Distribution Date, the amount in respect of principal
distributed to the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates will be
reduced. A draw on the Policy in respect of principal will not be made until the
Loan Group Balance and the amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account
allocated to such Loan Group (exclusive of any investment earnings included
therein) is less than the aggregate Class Certificate Balance of the related
Class or Classes of Offered Certificates, i.e., the related Class or Classes of
Offered Certificates are undercollateralized.
 
     If a Required Overcollateralization Amount is allowed to step down, the
amount of Remaining Net Excess Spread and Net Excess Principal available to the
other Loan Group may be increased, and the amount of principal distributed to
the Class or Classes of Offered Certificates for which the step down occurred
will be decreased.
 
                                      S-26
<PAGE>
     As a result of the interaction of the foregoing features, there may be
Distribution Dates on which Holders of the Offered Certificates receive little
or no distributions in respect of principal. Either Overcollateralization Amount
may or may not equal the related Required Overcollateralization Amount on any
Distribution Date. There can be no assurance as to whether or when either
Overcollateralization Amount may equal the related Required
Overcollateralization Amount.
 
ARMS
 
     All of the Home Equity Loans in Loan Group Two are ARMs. As is the case
with fixed rate Home Equity Loans, the ARMs may be subject to a greater rate of
principal prepayments in a low interest rate environment. For example, if
prevailing interest rates were to fall, Mortgagors with ARMs may be inclined to
refinance their ARMs with a fixed rate loan to 'lock in' a lower interest rate.
The existence of the Periodic Cap, Lifetime Cap and Lifetime Floor also may
affect the likelihood of prepayments resulting from refinancings. In addition,
the delinquency and loss experience on the ARMs may differ from that on the
fixed rate Home Equity Loans because the amount of the monthly payments on the
ARMs is subject to adjustment on each Change Date. If such different experience
were to occur, the prepayment experience on the Variable Rate Certificates may
differ from that on the Fixed Rate Certificates.
 
     Certain of the ARMs were originated with initial Loan Rates that were based
on competitive conditions and did not equal the sum of the applicable Index and
the related Gross Margin. In addition, none of the ARMs has reached its initial
Change Date. As a result, the Loan Rates on such ARMs are more likely to adjust
on their first, and possibly subsequent Change Dates, subject to the effects of
the applicable Periodic Cap and Lifetime Cap. Because the Certificate Rate for
the Variable Rate Certificates is a function of the weighted average Remittance
Rate of the ARMs, limits on changes in the Loan Rates of the ARMs may limit
changes in the Certificate Rate for the Variable Rate Certificates.
 
     Disproportionate principal payments on ARMs having Loan Rates higher than
the current Certificate Rate will also affect the yield on the Variable Rate
Certificates. The yield to maturity of the Variable Rate Certificates will be
lower than otherwise would be the case if disproportionate principal payments
(including prepayments) are made on ARMs having Loan Rates that exceed the
related Certificate Rate.
 
FINAL SCHEDULED DISTRIBUTION DATES
 
     The Final Scheduled Distribution Date for each Class of Offered
Certificates is set forth in 'SUMMARY OF TERMS--Final Scheduled Distribution
Dates.' The Final Scheduled Distribution Dates for the Class A-1, Class A-2 and
Class A-3 Certificates were determined based on the Structuring Assumptions
(defined below) and the assumption that there are no prepayments. The Final
Scheduled Distribution Dates for the Class A-4 and Class A-5 Certificates were
set to equal the Distribution Date in the 25th month following the month of the
latest possible scheduled maturity date for any of the Home Equity Loans in the
related Loan Group. Since the rate of distributions in reduction of the Class
Certificate Balance of each Class of Offered Certificates will depend on the
rate of payment (including prepayments) of the Home Equity Loans, the Class
Certificate Balance of any such Class could be reduced to zero significantly
earlier or later than the applicable Final Scheduled Distribution Date. The rate
of payments on the Home Equity Loans will depend on their particular
characteristics, as well as on prevailing interest rates from time to time and
other economic factors, and no assurance can be given as to the actual payment
experience of the Home Equity Loans.
 
STRUCTURING ASSUMPTIONS
 
     The information in the decrement tables has been prepared on the basis of
the following assumed characteristics of the Home Equity Loans and the following
additional assumptions (collectively, the 'Structuring Assumptions'): (i) the
Home Equity Loans prepay at the specified percentages of the Prepayment Ramp or
CPR (each as defined below), (ii) no defaults or delinquencies in the payment by
Mortgagors of principal of and interest on the Home Equity Loans are
experienced, (iii) the initial Class Certificate Balance of each Class of
Offered Certificates is as set forth on the cover page hereof, (iv) interest
accrues on each Class of Offered Certificates in each period at the applicable
Certificate Rate or initial Certificate Rate described herein, (v) distributions
in respect of the Offered Certificates are received in cash on the 25th day of
each month commencing in June 1996, (vi) the Servicer does not exercise its
option to purchase the Home Equity Loans
 
                                      S-27
<PAGE>
described herein under 'DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES--Termination; Retirement
of Certificates' and '--Optional Purchase of Defaulted Home Equity Loans,' (vii)
the Offered Certificates are purchased on May 24, 1996, (viii) scheduled
payments on the Home Equity Loans are received on the first day of each month
commencing in the calendar month following the Closing Date and are computed
prior to giving effect to prepayments received on the last day of the prior
month, (ix) prepayments represent prepayments in full of individual Home Equity
Loans and are received on the last day of each month and include 30 days'
interest thereon, commencing in the calendar month of the Closing Date, (x) the
scheduled monthly payment for each Home Equity Loan has been calculated based on
the assumed Home Equity Loan characteristics set forth in the following table
such that each Home Equity Loan will amortize in amounts sufficient to repay the
balance of such Home Equity Loan by its indicated remaining term to maturity,
(xi) all of the indicated Subsequent Home Equity Loans purchased with funds from
the Pre-Funding Account have a first Due Date in June 1996, (xii) the Trust
consists of 11 Home Equity Loans with the characteristics set forth in the
following table, (xiii) the level of the Index remains constant at 5.55% and
(xiv) the Loan Rate for each Home Equity Loan in Loan Group Two is adjusted on
its next Change Date (and on subsequent Change Dates, if necessary) to equal the
sum of (a) the assumed level of the Index and (b) the Gross Margin (such sum
being subject to the Periodic Rate Cap). While it is assumed that each of the
Home Equity Loans prepays at the specified percentages of the Prepayment Ramp or
CPR, as applicable, this is not likely to be the case. Moreover, discrepancies
will exist between the characteristics of the actual Home Equity Loans which
will be delivered to the Trustee (including Subsequent Home Equity Loans) and
characteristics of the Home Equity Loans assumed in preparing the tables herein.
 
     Prepayments of home equity loans are commonly measured relative to a
prepayment standard or model. The model used with respect to the Fixed Rate
Certificates (the 'Prepayment Ramp') assumes that the Home Equity Loans in Loan
Group One prepay at a rate of 4% CPR in the first month after origination, and
an additional 1.286% (precisely 18/14ths) each month thereafter until the 14th
month. Beginning in the 15th month and each month thereafter, the Prepayment
Ramp assumes a prepayment rate of 22% CPR. For the Variable Rate Certificates,
it was assumed that the Home Equity Loans in Loan Group Two prepay at a rate of
20% CPR. The Constant Prepayment Rate ('CPR') represents an assumed constant
rate of prepayment each month, expressed as an annual rate, relative to the then
outstanding principal balance of a pool of home equity loans for the life of
such home equity loans. Neither model purports to be either an historical
description of the prepayment experience of any pool of home equity loans or a
prediction of the anticipated rate of prepayment of any home equity loans,
including the Home Equity Loans to be included in the Loan Groups.
 
                                 LOAN GROUP ONE
                           INITIAL HOME EQUITY LOANS
 

</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                            INITIAL       INITIAL       REMAINING        REMAINING          ORIGINAL
                            MORTGAGE        NET           TERM             TERM               TERM
 POOL       PRINCIPAL       INTEREST     MORTGAGE      TO MATURITY    OF AMORTIZATION    OF AMORTIZATION    AMORTIZATION
NUMBER       BALANCE          RATE         RATE        (IN MONTHS)      (IN MONTHS)        (IN MONTHS)         METHOD
- ------    --------------    --------    -----------    -----------    ---------------    ---------------    ------------
<S>       <C>               <C>         <C>            <C>            <C>                <C>                <C>
  1       $ 3,835,864.81     10.466%        9.966%         112              112                113            Level
  2       $13,481,093.47     10.692%       10.192%         179              179                180            Level
  3       $10,661,824.40      9.804%        9.304%         239              239                240            Level
  4       $ 4,354,677.16      9.382%        8.882%         359              359                360            Level
  5       $13,258,980.70     10.162%        9.662%         179              359                360           Balloon
</TABLE>
 
                                 LOAN GROUP ONE
                          SUBSEQUENT HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                            INITIAL     INITIAL      REMAINING        REMAINING          ORIGINAL
                            MORTGAGE      NET          TERM             TERM               TERM
 POOL       PRINCIPAL       INTEREST    MORTGAGE    TO MATURITY    OF AMORTIZATION    OF AMORTIZATION    AMORTIZATION
NUMBER       BALANCE          RATE        RATE      (IN MONTHS)      (IN MONTHS)        (IN MONTHS)         METHOD
- ------    --------------    --------    --------    -----------    ---------------    ---------------    ------------
<S>       <C>               <C>         <C>         <C>            <C>                <C>                <C>
  6       $14,088,497.32     10.196%      9.696%        216              216                216            Level
  7       $ 5,777,269.59     10.162%      9.662%        180              360                360           Balloon
</TABLE>
 
                                      S-28
<PAGE>
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                           INITIAL HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               MONTHS TO
                         INITIAL    INITIAL      NEXT                                    ORIGINAL      REMAINING
                         MORTGAGE     NET      MORTGAGE             MAXIMUM   MINIMUM      TERM         TERM OF
 POOL      PRINCIPAL     INTEREST   MORTGAGE     RATE      GROSS    INTEREST  INTEREST  TO MATURITY   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION
NUMBER      BALANCE        RATE       RATE      CHANGE     MARGIN    RATE      RATE     (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)       METHOD
- ------   -------------   --------   --------   ---------   ------   -------   -------   -----------   ------------   ------------
<S>      <C>             <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>      <C>       <C>       <C>           <C>            <C>
  8      $3,484,124.82     8.112%     7.612%       10      5.151 %  14.112 %   8.112%       305            303         Level
  9      $14,463,204.15    8.558%     8.058%       11      5.573 %  14.558 %   8.558%       307            306         Level
  10     $12,211,736.31    8.923%     8.423%       12      5.614 %  14.923 %   8.923%       295            295         Level
</TABLE>
 
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                          SUBSEQUENT HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               MONTHS TO
                         INITIAL    INITIAL      NEXT                                    ORIGINAL      REMAINING
                         MORTGAGE     NET      MORTGAGE             MAXIMUM   MINIMUM      TERM         TERM OF
 POOL      PRINCIPAL     INTEREST   MORTGAGE     RATE      GROSS    INTEREST  INTEREST  TO MATURITY   AMORTIZATION   AMORTIZATION
NUMBER      BALANCE        RATE       RATE      CHANGE     MARGIN    RATE      RATE     (IN MONTHS)   (IN MONTHS)       METHOD
- ------   -------------   --------   --------   ---------   ------   -------   -------   -----------   ------------   ------------
<S>      <C>             <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>      <C>       <C>       <C>           <C>            <C>
  11     $4,840,934.72     8.654%     8.154%       12      5.541 %  14.654 %   8.654%       302            302         Level
</TABLE>
 
DECREMENT TABLES
 
     The following tables indicate, based on the Structuring Assumptions, the
percentages of the initial Class Certificate Balances of the Classes of Offered
Certificates that would be outstanding after each of the dates shown at various
percentages of the Prepayment Ramp or CPR and the corresponding weighted average
lives of such Classes. It is not likely that (i) all of the Home Equity Loans
will have the characteristics assumed, (ii) the Home Equity Loans will prepay at
the specified percentages of the Prepayment Ramp or CPR or at any other constant
percentage or (iii) the level of the Index will remain constant at the level
assumed or at any other level. Moreover, the diverse remaining terms to maturity
of the Home Equity Loans could produce slower or faster principal distributions
than indicated in the tables at the specified percentages of the Prepayment Ramp
or CPR, even if the weighted average remaining term to maturity of the Home
Equity Loans is consistent with the remaining terms to maturity of the Home
Equity Loans specified in the Structuring Assumptions.
 
                                      S-29
<PAGE>
                      PERCENT OF INITIAL CLASS CERTIFICATE
                             BALANCES OUTSTANDING**
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                                            CLASS A-3
                                       CLASS A-1                           CLASS A-2                 PERCENTAGE OF PREPAYMENT
                             PERCENTAGE OF PREPAYMENT RAMP       PERCENTAGE OF PREPAYMENT RAMP                 RAMP
                           ----------------------------------  ----------------------------------  ----------------------------
DISTRIBUTION DATE           0%   50%   75%   100%  125%  150%   0%   50%   75%   100%  125%  150%   0%   50%   75%   100%  125%
- -------------------------- ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----
<S>                        <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>
Initial Percent...........  100   100   100  100   100   100    100   100   100  100   100   100    100   100   100  100   100
May 1997..................   90    73    64   55    47    38    100   100   100  100   100   100    100   100   100  100   100
May 1998..................   84    37    15    0     0     0    100   100   100   95    75    57    100   100   100  100   100
May 1999..................   76     5     0    0     0     0    100   100    75   49    26     6    100   100   100  100   100
May 2000..................   69     0     0    0     0     0    100    78    43   15     0     0    100   100   100  100    82
May 2001..................   60     0     0    0     0     0    100    54    18    0     0     0    100   100   100   77    29
May 2002..................   50     0     0    0     0     0    100    33     0    0     0     0    100   100    92   34     0
May 2003..................   40     0     0    0     0     0    100    15     0    0     0     0    100   100    55    1     0
May 2004..................   28     0     0    0     0     0    100     0     0    0     0     0    100    97    24    0     0
May 2005..................   15     0     0    0     0     0    100     0     0    0     0     0    100    66     0    0     0
May 2006..................    3     0     0    0     0     0    100     0     0    0     0     0    100    40     0    0     0
May 2007..................    0     0     0    0     0     0     90     0     0    0     0     0    100    18     0    0     0
May 2008..................    0     0     0    0     0     0     77     0     0    0     0     0    100     0     0    0     0
May 2009..................    0     0     0    0     0     0     62     0     0    0     0     0    100     0     0    0     0
May 2010..................    0     0     0    0     0     0     46     0     0    0     0     0    100     0     0    0     0
May 2011..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0     63     0     0    0     0
May 2012..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2013..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2014..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2015..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2016..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2017..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2018..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2019..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2020..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2021..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2022..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2023..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2024..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2025..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
May 2026..................    0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0
Weighted Average Life
  (years)***..............  5.7   1.7   1.3  1.1   1.0   0.9   13.4   5.3   3.9  3.1   2.6   2.2   15.1   9.7   7.3  5.7   4.7
 
<CAPTION>
 
                                              CLASS A-4                           CLASS A-5
                                    PERCENTAGE OF PREPAYMENT RAMP             PERCENTAGE OF CPR
                                  ----------------------------------  ----------------------------------
DISTRIBUTION DATE           150%   0%   50%   75%   100%  125%  150%   0%   10%   15%   20%   25%   30%
- --------------------------  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----
<S>                        <C>    <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>
Initial Percent...........  100    100   100   100  100   100   100    100   100   100  100   100   100
May 1997..................  100    100   100   100  100   100   100     97    87    82   77    72    67
May 1998..................  100    100   100   100  100   100   100     96    77    69   61    53    46
May 1999..................  100    100   100   100  100   100   100     95    69    57   48    39    32
May 2000..................   39    100   100   100  100   100   100     94    61    48   38    29    22
May 2001..................    0    100   100   100  100   100    91     92    54    40   30    22    15
May 2002..................    0    100   100   100  100    91    59     91    47    34   23    16    11
May 2003..................    0    100   100   100  100    63    36     90    42    28   18    12     7
May 2004..................    0    100   100   100   75    42    22     88    37    24   14     9     5
May 2005..................    0    100   100    98   54    28    13     86    33    20   11     6     3
May 2006..................    0    100   100    77   39    18     7     84    29    16    9     4     2
May 2007..................    0    100   100    60   28    11     3     82    25    13    7     3     1
May 2008..................    0    100    98    46   19     7     1     79    22    11    5     2     1
May 2009..................    0    100    80    34   13     3     0     76    19     9    4     1     *
May 2010..................    0    100    63    25    8     1     0     73    16     7    3     1     *
May 2011..................    0    100    29    10    2     0     0     69    14     6    2     *     0
May 2012..................    0    100    14     3    0     0     0     65    12     5    1     *     0
May 2013..................    0     76     8     1    0     0     0     61    10     3    1     0     0
May 2014..................    0     50     4     0    0     0     0     56     8     3    1     0     0
May 2015..................    0     37     1     0    0     0     0     50     7     2    *     0     0
May 2016..................    0     24     0     0    0     0     0     44     5     1    *     0     0
May 2017..................    0     23     0     0    0     0     0     37     4     1    0     0     0
May 2018..................    0     21     0     0    0     0     0     30     3     *    0     0     0
May 2019..................    0     19     0     0    0     0     0     21     1     *    0     0     0
May 2020..................    0     16     0     0    0     0     0     12     *     0    0     0     0
May 2021..................    0     14     0     0    0     0     0      3     0     0    0     0     0
May 2022..................    0     11     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0
May 2023..................    0      8     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0
May 2024..................    0      4     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0
May 2025..................    0      1     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0
May 2026..................    0      0     0     0    0     0     0      0     0     0    0     0     0
Weighted Average Life
  (years)***..............  3.9   19.6  14.5  12.1  9.9   8.2   6.9   17.2   7.4   5.3  4.1   3.2   2.6
</TABLE>
 
- ------------------------------
 
  * Less than 0.5 but more than zero.
 
 ** Rounded to the nearest whole percentage.
 
*** The weighted average life of an Offered Certificate is determined by (a)
    multiplying the amount of the reduction, if any, of the Class Certificate
    Balance of such Certificate on each Distribution Date by the number of years
    from the date of issuance to such Distribution Date, (b) summing the results
    and (c) dividing the sum by the aggregate amount of the reductions in Class
    Certificate Balance of such Certificate referred to in clause (a).
<PAGE>
                        DESCRIPTION OF THE CERTIFICATES
 
     The Certificates will be issued pursuant to the Agreement. The following
summaries describe certain provisions of the Agreement. The summaries do not
purport to be complete and are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety
by reference to, all of the provisions of the Agreement. Wherever particular
sections or defined terms of the Agreement are referred to, such sections or
defined terms are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
 
GENERAL
 
     Each Class of Offered Certificates will evidence specified undivided
interests in the Trust. The property of the Trust will consist of, to the extent
provided in the Agreement: (i) the Home Equity Loans in the Loan Groups; (ii)
payments on the Home Equity Loans received on and after the Cut-Off Date; (iii)
Mortgaged Properties relating to the Home Equity Loans that are acquired by
foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure; (iv) each Collection Account and
Distribution Account; (v) the Capitalized Interest Account; (vi) the Pre-Funding
Account; (vii) the Yield Supplement Account; (viii) the Spread Account; (ix) the
Policy; (x) certain hazard insurance policies maintained by the borrowers of the
Home Equity Loans or the Servicer in respect thereof; and (xi) the Depositor's
rights under the Purchase Agreement (defined below).
 
BOOK-ENTRY REGISTRATION
 
     The Offered Certificates initially will be registered in the name of Cede &
Co. ('Cede'), the nominee of The Depository Trust Company ('DTC'). DTC has
advised the Depositor as follows: DTC is a limited purpose trust company
organized under the laws of the State of New York, a member of the Federal
Reserve System, a 'clearing corporation' within the meaning of the Uniform
Commercial Code ('UCC') and a 'clearing agency' registered pursuant to the
provisions of Section 17A of the Exchange Act. DTC was created to hold
securities for its participating organizations ('Participants') and facilitate
the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between Participants
through electronic book-entry changes in their accounts, thereby eliminating the
need for physical movement of certificates. Participants include securities
brokers and dealers, banks, trust companies and clearing corporations and may
include certain other organizations. Indirect access to the DTC system also is
available to others such as brokers, dealers, banks and trust companies that
clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a Participant, either
directly or indirectly ('Indirect Participant').
 
     Under a book-entry format, beneficial owners of the Offered Certificates
('Certificate Owners') that are not Participants or Indirect Participants but
desire to purchase, sell or otherwise transfer ownership of Offered Certificates
registered in the name of Cede, as nominee of DTC, may do so only through
Participants and Indirect Participants. In addition, such Certificate Owners
will receive all distributions of principal of and interest on the Offered
Certificates from the Trustee through DTC and its Participants. Under a book-
entry format, Certificate Owners will receive payments after the related
Distribution Date because, while payments are required to be forwarded to Cede,
as nominee for DTC, on each such date, DTC will forward such payments to its
Participants which thereafter will be required to forward them to Indirect
Participants or Certificate Owners. Under a book entry format, it is anticipated
that the only Certificateholder will be Cede, as nominee of DTC, and that the
Certificate Owners will not be recognized by the Trustee as Certificateholders
under the Agreement. The Certificate Owners will only be permitted to exercise
the rights of Certificateholders under the Agreement indirectly through DTC and
its Participants who in turn will exercise their rights through DTC.
 
     Under the rules, regulations and procedures creating and affecting DTC and
its operations, DTC is required to make book-entry transfers among Participants
on whose behalf it acts with respect to the Offered Certificates and is required
to receive and transmit payments of principal of and interest on the Offered
Certificates. Participants and Indirect Participants with which Certificate
Owners have accounts with respect to the Offered Certificates similarly are
required to make book-entry transfers and receive and transmit such payments on
behalf of their respective Certificate Owners. Accordingly, although Certificate
Owners will not possess certificates, the rules provide a mechanism by which
Certificate Owners will receive distributions and will be able to transfer their
interests.
 
     Certificate Owners who are not Participants may transfer ownership of the
Offered Certificates only through Participants by instructing such Participants
to transfer the Offered Certificates, by book-entry transfer, through
 
                                      S-31
<PAGE>
DTC for the account of the purchasers of such Certificates, which account is
maintained with their respective Participants. Under the rules and in accordance
with DTC's normal procedures, transfers of ownership of Offered Certificates
will be executed through DTC and the accounts of the respective Participants at
DTC will be debited and credited. Similarly, the respective Participants will
make debits or credits, as the case may be, on their records on behalf of the
selling and purchasing Certificate Owners.
 
     Because DTC can only act on behalf of Participants, who in turn act on
behalf of Indirect Participants and certain banks, the ability of Certificate
Owners to pledge the Offered Certificates to persons or entities that do not
participant in the DTC system, or otherwise take actions in respect of such
Certificates may be limited due to the lack of a physical certificate for such
Certificates.
 
     DTC in general advises that it will take any action permitted to be taken
by a Certificate Owner under the Agreement only at the direction of one or more
Participants to whose account with DTC the Offered Certificates are credited.
Additionally, DTC in general advises that it will take such actions with respect
to specified percentages of the Certificate Owners only at the direction of and
on behalf of Participants whose holdings include current principal amounts of
outstanding Offered Certificates that satisfy such specified percentages. DTC
may take conflicting actions with respect to other current principal amounts of
outstanding Offered Certificates to the extent that such actions are taken on
behalf of Participants whose holdings include such current principal amounts of
outstanding Offered Certificates.
 
     Any Offered Certificates initially registered in the name of Cede, as
nominee of DTC, will be issued in fully registered, certificated form to
Certificate Owners or their nominees ('Definitive Certificates'), rather than to
DTC or its nominee only under the following circumstances: (i) the Depositor
advises the Trustee in writing that DTC is no longer willing or able to properly
discharge its responsibilities as Depository with respect to the Offered
Certificates, and the Trustee or the Depositor is unable to locate a qualified
successor, (ii) the Depositor, at its option, elects to terminate the book-entry
system through DTC, or (iii) after the occurrence of an Event of Default
(defined herein), Certificate Owners representing not less than 50% of the
aggregate Class Certificate Balance of the Offered Certificates advise the
Trustee and DTC through Participants in writing that the continuation of a
book-entry system through DTC (or a successor thereto) is no longer in the best
interest of the Certificate Owners. Upon the occurrence of any of such events,
DTC will be required to notify all Participants of the availability through DTC
of Definitive Certificates. Upon surrender by DTC of the certificates
representing the Offered Certificates and instruction for re-registration, the
Trustee will issue the Offered Certificates in the form of Definitive
Certificates, and thereafter the Trustee will recognize the holders of such
Definitive Certificates as Certificateholders. Thereafter, payments of principal
of and interest on the Offered Certificates will be made by the Trustee directly
to Certificateholders in accordance with the procedures set forth in the
Agreement. The final distribution of any Offered Certificate (whether Definitive
Certificates or Offered Certificates registered in the name of Cede), however,
will be made only upon presentation and surrender of such Certificates on the
final Distribution Date at such office or agency as is specified in the notice
of final payment to Certificateholders.
 
     Although DTC has agreed to the foregoing procedures in order to facilitate
transfers of interests in the Offered Certificates among Participants, it is
under no obligation to perform or continue to perform such procedures, and such
procedures may be discontinued at any time. None of the Depositor, the Seller,
the Servicer or the Trustee will have any responsibility for the performance by
DTC or its Participants or Indirect Participants of their respective obligations
under the rules and procedures governing their operations.
 
ASSIGNMENT OF HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
     The Home Equity Loans will be acquired by the Depositor from the Seller
pursuant to the Mortgage Loan Purchase Agreement, dated the Closing Date (the
'Purchase Agreement'), between the Seller and the Depositor. At the time of
issuance of the Certificates, the Depositor will transfer to the Trust all of
its right, title and interest in and to each Home Equity Loan, the related
mortgage note, mortgage and other related documents (collectively, the 'Related
Documents'), including all payments received on or with respect to each such
Mortgage Loan on or after the Cut-Off Date (exclusive of payments in respect of
accrued interest on the Home Equity Loans through the related Due Date in the
month preceding the month of the Cut-Off Date). The Depositor also will assign
to the Trustee all of the Depositor's rights under the Purchase Agreement. The
Trustee, concurrently with such
 
                                      S-32
<PAGE>
transfer, will deliver the Certificates to the Depositor. Each Home Equity Loan
transferred to the Trust will be identified on a schedule (the 'Home Equity Loan
Schedule') delivered to the Trustee pursuant to the Agreement. Such schedule
will include information as to the Principal Balance of each Home Equity Loan as
of the Cut-Off Date, as well as information with respect to the current Loan
Rate.
 
     The Agreement will require that, within the time period specified therein,
the Depositor will deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee (or a
custodian, as the Trustee's agent for such purpose) the Home Equity Loans
endorsed to the Trustee and the Related Documents. In lieu of delivery of
original mortgages, the Depositor may deliver or cause to be delivered true and
correct copies thereof which have been certified as to authenticity by the
appropriate county recording office where such mortgage is recorded.
 
     Under the terms of the Purchase Agreement, the Seller will have 30 days
after the Closing Date to prepare and submit for recording assignments of the
mortgages related to each Home Equity Loan in favor of the Trustee (unless
opinions of counsel satisfactory to the Rating Agencies and the Certificate
Insurer are delivered to the Trustee and the Certificate Insurer to the effect
that recordation of such assignments is not required in the relevant
jurisdictions to protect the interests of the Trustee in the Home Equity Loans).
If the recording information with respect to any assignment of Mortgage is
unavailable within 30 days of the Closing Date, such assignment will be prepared
and recorded promptly after receipt of such information, but in no event later
than one year after the Closing Date.
 
     Within 90 days of the Closing Date, the Trustee will review the Home Equity
Loans and the Related Documents pursuant to the Agreement and if any Home Equity
Loan or Related Document is found to be defective in any material respect and
such defect is not cured within 90 days following notification thereof to the
Seller and the Depositor by the Trustee, the Seller will be obligated to either
(i) substitute for such Home Equity Loan an Eligible Substitute Home Equity
Loan; however, such substitution is permitted only within two years of the
Closing Date, and may not be made unless an opinion of counsel is provided to
the effect that such substitution will not disqualify the Trust as a REMIC for
federal income tax purposes or result in a prohibited transaction tax under the
Code or (ii) purchase such Home Equity Loan at a price (the 'Purchase Price')
equal to the outstanding Principal Balance of such Home Equity Loan as of the
date of purchase, plus the greater of (i) all accrued and unpaid interest
thereon and (ii) 30 days' interest thereon, computed at the Loan Rate, net of
the Servicing Fee with respect to such Home Equity Loan if the Seller or an
affiliate is the Servicer, plus the amount of any unreimbursed Servicing
Advances made by the Servicer with respect to such Home Equity Loan. The
Purchase Price will be deposited in the applicable Collection Account on or
prior to the next succeeding Determination Date after such obligation arises.
The obligation of the Seller to repurchase or substitute for a Defective Home
Equity Loan is the sole remedy regarding any defects in the Home Equity Loans
and Related Documents available to the Trustee or the Certificateholders.
 
     In connection with the substitution of an Eligible Substitute Home Equity
Loan, the Seller will be required to deposit in the applicable Collection
Account on or prior to the next succeeding Determination Date after such
obligation arises an amount (the 'Substitution Adjustment') equal to the sum of
(i) the excess of the Principal Balance of the related Defective Home Equity
Loan over the Principal Balance of such Eligible Substitute Home Equity Loan,
(ii) 30 days' interest on such excess computed at the Loan Rate, net of the
Servicing Fee if the Seller or an affiliate is the Servicer, and (iii) the
amount of any unreimbursed Servicing Advances and Monthly Advances made by the
Servicer with respect to such Defective Home Equity Loan if the Servicer is not
an affiliate of the Seller. The Servicer will be deemed to have been reimbursed
for any Servicing Advances and Monthly Advances that are not paid pursuant to
clause (iii).
 
     An 'Eligible Substitute Home Equity Loan' is a home equity loan substituted
by the Seller for a Defective Home Equity Loan which must, on the date of such
substitution, (i) have an outstanding Principal Balance (or in the case of a
substitution of more than one Home Equity Loan for a Defective Home Equity Loan,
an aggregate Principal Balance), not in excess of, and not more than 5% less
than, the Principal Balance of the Defective Home Equity Loan; (ii) have a Loan
Rate not less than the Loan Rate of the Defective Home Equity Loan and not more
than 1% in excess of the Loan Rate of such Defective Home Equity Loan, provided
that if the Defective Home Equity Loan is a Low Coupon Loan, the Eligible
Substitute Home Equity Loan may not be a Low Coupon Loan; (iii) have a mortgage
of the same or higher level of lien priority as the mortgage relating to the
Defective Home Equity Loan; (iv) have a remaining term to maturity not more than
six months earlier and not later than the
 
                                      S-33
<PAGE>
remaining term to maturity of the Defective Home Equity Loan; (v) comply with
each representation and warranty as to the Home Equity Loans set forth in the
Purchase Agreement (deemed to be made as of the date of substitution); (vi) have
a Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio not greater than that of the Defective Home
Equity Loan; (vii) bear a fixed or adjustable Loan Rate if the Defective Home
Equity Loan was in Loan Group One or Loan Group Two, respectively; and (viii) if
the Home Equity Loan is an ARM, have a Gross Margin and Lifetime Cap no less
than, the same interval between the Change Dates as, and a Loan Rate based on
the same Index as, that of the Defective Home Equity Loan.
 
     In the Purchase Agreement, the Seller will make certain representations and
warranties with respect to the Home Equity Loans including, among others: (i)
the information with respect to each Home Equity Loan set forth in the Home
Equity Loan Schedule is true and correct in all material respects as of the
Cut-Off Date; (ii) each Mortgage is a valid and subsisting first or second lien
of record on the Mortgaged Property subject, in the case of any second Home
Equity Loan, only to a First Lien on such Mortgaged Property and subject in all
cases to the exceptions to title set forth in the title insurance policy with
respect to the related Home Equity Loan, which exceptions are generally
acceptable to mortgage lending companies, and such other exceptions to which
similar properties are commonly subject and which do not individually, or in the
aggregate, materially and adversely affect the benefits of the security intended
to be provided by such Mortgage; (iii) except with respect to liens released
immediately prior to the transfer contemplated in the Purchase Agreement, each
Mortgage Note and the related Mortgage have not been assigned or pledged and
immediately prior to the transfer and assignment herein contemplated, the Seller
held good, marketable and indefeasible title to, and was the sole owner and
holder of, each Home Equity Loan subject to no liens, charges, mortgages,
claims, participation interests, equities, pledges or security interests of any
nature, encumbrances or rights of others (collectively, a 'Lien'); and
immediately upon the completion of the transfers and assignments contemplated in
the Agreement, the Trustee will hold good, marketable and indefeasible title,
to, and be the sole owner of, each Home Equity Loan subject to no Liens; (iv) no
Home Equity Loan was 30 or more days delinquent as of the Cut-Off Date, as
measured at the end of the month; and (v) each Home Equity Loan at the time it
was made complied in all material respects with applicable state and federal
laws and regulations, including, without limitation, usury, equal credit
opportunity, consumer credit, truth-in-lending, real estate settlement
procedures and disclosure laws.
 
     Upon discovery of a breach of any such representation and warranty which
materially and adversely affects the interests of the Certificateholders or the
Certificate Insurer in the related Home Equity Loan, the Seller will have a
period of 60 days after discovery or notice of the breach to effect a cure. If
the breach cannot be cured within the 60-day period, the Seller will be
obligated to (i) substitute for such Defective Home Equity Loan an Eligible
Substitute Home Equity Loan or (ii) purchase such Defective Home Equity Loan
from the Trust. The same procedure and limitations that are set forth above for
the substitution or purchase of Defective Home Equity Loans as a result of
deficient documentation relating thereto will apply to the substitution or
purchase of a Defective Home Equity Loan as a result of a breach of a
representation or warranty that materially and adversely affects the interests
of the Certificateholders or the Certificate Insurer. The obligation of the
Seller to repurchase or substitute for a Defective Home Equity Loan is the sole
remedy regarding any breach of a representation or warranty with respect thereto
available to the Trustee or the Certificateholders.
 
     The Seller will have similar obligations with respect to any Subsequent
Home Equity Loans delivered to the Trust.
 
     The Depositor will make no representations or warranties with respect to
the Home Equity Loans and will have no obligation (other than to assign to the
Trustee the Depositor's rights under the Purchase Agreement) or liability with
respect to breaches of the Seller's representations or warranties or its
obligations to cure, purchase or substitute for any Defective Home Equity Loan.
 
PAYMENTS ON HOME EQUITY LOANS; DEPOSITS TO COLLECTION ACCOUNTS AND DISTRIBUTION
ACCOUNT
 
     The Trustee will establish and maintain a separate account (each a
'Collection Account') for each Loan Group. Each Collection Account will be an
Eligible Account (as defined herein). Subject to the investment provision
described in the following paragraphs, upon receipt by the Servicer of amounts
in respect of the Home Equity Loans (excluding amounts representing the
Servicing Fee, reimbursement for previous related Monthly Advances or Servicing
Advances, administrative charges, taxes, assessments, credit insurance charges,
insurance
 
                                      S-34
<PAGE>
proceeds to be applied to the restoration or repair of a Mortgaged Property or
similar items), the Servicer will deposit such amounts in the Collection Account
for the applicable Loan Group. Amounts so deposited may be invested in Eligible
Investments (as described in the Agreement) maturing no later than one Business
Day prior to the date on which the amount on deposit therein is required to be
deposited in the Distribution Account or on such Distribution Date if approved
by the Rating Agencies and the Certificate Insurer.
 
     The Trustee will establish a separate account (each, a 'Distribution
Account') for each Loan Group into which will be deposited amounts withdrawn
from the related Collection Account for distribution to Certificateholders on a
Distribution Date. Each Distribution Account will be an Eligible Account.
Amounts on deposit therein may be invested in Eligible Investments maturing on
or before the Business Day prior to the related Distribution Date.
 
     An 'Eligible Account' is an account that is (i) maintained with a
depository institution the deposits in which are insured by the FDIC to the
limits established by the FDIC and the short-term debt obligations of which (or
in the case of a depository institution that is the principal subsidiary of a
holding company, the short-term debt obligations of which) are rated in the
highest short-term rating category by each Rating Agency and the long-term debt
obligations of which are rated at least Aa3 by Moody's, (ii) a trust account or
accounts maintained with the trust department of a federal or a state chartered
depository institution or trust company the long-term debt obligations of which
are rated at least Baa3 by Moody's, acting in a fiduciary capacity or (iii) an
account or accounts otherwise acceptable to each Rating Agency and the
Certificate Insurer.
 
     Eligible Investments are specified in the Agreement and are limited to
investments which meet the criteria of the Rating Agencies from time to time as
being consistent with their then-current ratings of the Certificates.
 
PRE-FUNDING ACCOUNT
 
     On the Closing Date, an aggregate cash amount (the 'Pre-Funded Amount') not
to exceed approximately $24,706,702 will be deposited in the Pre-Funding
Account. Of such amount, approximately $19,865,767 will be used to purchase
Subsequent Home Equity Loans for deposit into Loan Group One and, if required,
to make accelerated payments of principal on the Fixed Rate Certificates and
approximately $4,840,935 will be used to purchase Subsequent Home Equity Loans
for deposit into Loan Group Two and, if required, to make accelerated payments
of principal on the Variable Rate Certificates. During the period (the
'Pre-Funding Period') from the Closing Date to the earliest to occur of (a) the
date on which the amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account is less than
$100,000, (b) an Event of Default under the Agreement and (c) July 31, 1996,
amounts on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account may be withdrawn from time to time
to acquire Subsequent Home Equity Loans in accordance with the Agreement. Any
net investment earnings on the Pre-Funded Amount will be transferred to the
Capitalized Interest Account on each Distribution Date during the Pre-Funding
Period. Any Pre-Funded Amount remaining in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of
the Pre-Funding Period will be distributed on the Distribution Date occurring at
or immediately following the end of the Pre-Funding Period. If the Pre-Funded
Amount so distributed and allocated to a Loan Group is less than $100,000, it
will be treated as a principal prepayment and allocated to the applicable Class
or Classes of Offered Certificates related to Loan Group One or Loan Group Two,
as applicable, as provided herein; otherwise such amount will be distributed as
principal of the outstanding Class or Classes of Offered Certificates related to
Loan Group One or Loan Group Two, as applicable, pro rata on the basis of their
respective Class Certificate Balances. Only fixed-rate Subsequent Home Equity
Loans may be added to Loan Group One, and only adjustable-rate Subsequent Home
Equity Loans may be added to Loan Group Two.
 
CAPITALIZED INTEREST ACCOUNT
 
     On the Closing Date, funds will be deposited in an account (the
'Capitalized Interest Account') created and maintained with the Trustee. The
amount so deposited will be used by the Trustee on the Distribution Dates in the
Pre-Funding Period to fund the excess, if any, of the Interest Remittance
Amounts for the Offered Certificates and the premium due for the Policy over the
funds available therefor on such Distribution Dates. Any funds remaining in the
Capitalized Interest Account at the end of the Pre-Funding Period will be
distributed to the Holders of the Class R Certificates.
 
                                      S-35
<PAGE>
YIELD SUPPLEMENT ACCOUNT
 
     On the Closing Date, funds will be deposited in an account (the 'Yield
Supplement Account') created and maintained with the Trustee. The amount so
deposited will be used by the Trustee on each Distribution Date to the extent
that the interest collected or advanced with respect to Home Equity Loans with
Loan Rates below 8.73% per annum ('Low Coupon Loans') is insufficient to pay the
Expense Fees and the Interest Remittance Amounts for the Fixed Rate
Certificates. Funds on deposit in the Yield Supplement Account will not be
available to make payments of principal or Additional Principal. Excess amounts
on deposit in the Yield Supplement Account may be released from time to time to
the Holder of the Class R Certificates as provided in the Agreement. The Yield
Supplement Account is an asset of the Trust but will not be included in the
REMIC.
 
ADVANCES
 
     Not later than the close of business on the second Business Day prior to
the related Distribution Date, the Servicer will be required to remit to the
Trustee for deposit in the applicable Collection Account an amount, to be
distributed on the related Distribution Date, equal to the sum of the interest
accrued on each Home Equity Loan through the related Due Date but not received
by the Servicer as of the close of business on the related Determination Date
(net of the Servicing Fee with respect to such Home Equity Loan), plus, with
respect to each REO Property which was acquired during or prior to the related
Due Period and as to which a final disposition thereof did not occur in the
related Due Period, an amount equal to the excess, if any, of interest for the
most recently ended Due Period on the Principal Balance of the Home Equity Loan
relating to such REO Property at the related Loan Rate (net of the Servicing Fee
with respect to such Home Equity Loan) over the net income from the REO Property
transferred to the related Collection Account for such Distribution Date
pursuant to the Agreement (the 'Monthly Advance'). The Servicer may fund all or
a portion of any Monthly Advance from funds on deposit in the applicable
Collection Account that are not required to be distributed on the related
Distribution Date. Any funds so used must be replaced on or before the
Distribution Date on which such funds will be required to be distributed.
 
     In the course of performing its servicing obligations, the Servicer will
pay all reasonable and customary 'out-of-pocket' costs and expenses incurred in
the performance of its servicing obligations, including, but not limited to, the
cost of (i) the preservation, restoration and protection of the Mortgaged
Properties; (ii) any enforcement or judicial proceedings, including
foreclosures, and (iii) the management and liquidation of Mortgaged Properties
acquired in satisfaction of the related Mortgage. Each such expenditure will
constitute a 'Servicing Advance.'
 
     The Servicer's right to reimbursement for unreimbursed Servicing Advances
is limited to late collections on the related Home Equity Loan, including
Liquidation Proceeds, released Mortgaged Property proceeds, Insurance Proceeds
and such other amounts as may be collected by the Servicer from the related
Mortgagor or otherwise relating to the Home Equity Loan in respect of which such
unreimbursed amounts are owed. The Servicer's right to such reimbursement is
prior to the rights of Certificateholders. The Servicer's right to reimbursement
for unreimbursed Monthly Advances is limited to late collections of interest on
any Home Equity Loan and to Liquidation Proceeds and Insurance Proceeds on the
related Home Equity Loan (as to which it will have priority over
Certificateholders) unless such amounts are insufficient. In such event (a
'Nonrecoverable Advance'), the Servicer will be reimbursed for such
Nonrecoverable Advance from funds on deposit in the applicable Distribution
Account.
 
     The Servicer is not required to make any Monthly Advance or Servicing
Advance which it determines would be nonrecoverable from amounts received in
respect of the related Home Equity Loan.
 
COMPENSATING INTEREST
 
     The Agreement provides that not later than the close of business on the
second Business Day prior to the related Distribution Date, the Servicer will
remit to the Trustee for deposit to the applicable Collection Account an amount
equal to the lesser of (i) the aggregate of the Prepayment Interest Shortfalls
for the related Distribution Date resulting from principal prepayments by
Mortgagors during the related Due Period and (ii) the amount otherwise payable
to the Servicer as its aggregate Servicing Fee for such Due Period. The Servicer
will not have the right to reimbursement for any such amounts deposited to
either Collection Account.
 
                                      S-36
<PAGE>
SPREAD ACCOUNT
 
     The Trustee will establish on the Closing Date the Spread Account into
which it will deposit upon receipt from the holder of the Class R Certificate an
amount, if any, specified by the Certificate Insurer (the 'Initial Spread
Account Deposit'). Amounts on deposit in the Spread Account will be available
for withdrawal to fund any shortfall between the available funds for
distribution to Holders of a Class of Offered Certificates and the related
Interest Remittance Amount and Principal Remittance Amount. If the Initial
Spread Account Deposit is available to fund any such shortfall on each
Distribution Date, funds on deposit in the Spread Account equal to the amount of
such shortfall will be withdrawn by the Trustee and deposited into the
applicable Distribution Account for distribution to Holders of the affected
Class or Classes of Offered Certificates.
 
PRIORITY OF DISTRIBUTIONS
 
     On or before each Distribution Date, the Trustee will determine the
Overcollateralization Amount for each Loan Group after giving effect to the
distribution of the Principal Remittance Amount to the related Class or Classes
of Offered Certificates on such Distribution Date and the amount of the related
Net Excess Spread. The 'Amount Available' for a Loan Group on a Distribution
Date will equal the sum of (i) the Available Remittance Amount for such Loan
Group, (ii) if an Available Funds Shortfall exists in such Loan Group, (a)
first, the Net Excess Spread from the other Loan Group, to the extent of such
Available Funds Shortfall, (b) second, the Excess Principal from the other Loan
Group, to the extent of any remaining Available Funds Shortfall, and (c) third,
any amounts in respect of any remaining Available Funds Shortfall withdrawn from
the Spread Account and deposited in the applicable Distribution Account, (iii)
(a) first, the Available Transfer Cashflow, to the extent necessary to reach the
Required Overcollateralization Amount for such Loan Group and (b) second, the
Net Excess Principal, to the extent necessary to reach the Required
Overcollateralization Amount for such Loan Group, and (iv) any Insured Payments
with respect to the related Class or Classes of Certificates. On each
Distribution Date the Trustee will withdraw from each Distribution Account the
Amount Available, and make distributions thereof in the following order of
priority and to the extent of such Amount Available:
 
          (A) From the Distribution Account for Loan Group One:
 
                (i) to the Certificate Insurer the monthly premium then due with
           respect to Loan Group One;
 
                (ii) to the Trustee, the Trustee Fee then due with respect to
           Loan Group One;
 
                (iii) to the Back-Up Servicer, the Back-Up Servicing Fee then
           due with respect to Loan Group One;
 
                (iv) concurrently, to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and
           Class A-4 Certificates, an amount allocable to interest equal to the
           applicable Interest Remittance Amount;
 
                (v) sequentially, to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and
           Class A-4 Certificates, in that order, an amount allocable to
           principal equal to the related Principal Remittance Amount, until
           their respective Class Certificate Balances have been reduced to
           zero;
 
                (vi) to the Certificate Insurer an amount equal to previously
           unreimbursed Insured Payments with respect to the Class A-1, Class
           A-2, Class A-3 or Class A-4 Certificates, together with interest
           thereon at the rate referred to in the Insurance Agreement;
 
                (vii) sequentially, to the Class A-1, Class A-2, Class A-3 and
           Class A-4 Certificates, in that order, an amount allocable to
           principal equal to the Additional Principal, until their respective
           Class Certificate Balances have been reduced to zero;
 
                (viii) to the Certificate Insurer, all other amounts owing to
           the Certificate Insurer under the Insurance Agreement;
 
                (ix) to the Depositor or the Servicer, as applicable, certain
           reimbursable expenses pursuant to the Agreement;
 
                (x) to the Servicer, Nonrecoverable Advances not previously
           reimbursed with respect to Loan Group One; and
 
                                      S-37
<PAGE>
                (xi) to the Class R Certificates, the balance, if any.
 
          (B) From the Distribution Account for Loan Group Two:
 
                (i) to the Certificate Insurer the monthly premium then due with
           respect to Loan Group Two;
 
                (ii) to the Trustee, the Trustee Fee then due with respect to
           Loan Group Two;
 
                (iii) to the Back-Up Servicer, the Back-Up Servicing Fee then
           due with respect to Loan Group Two;
 
                (iv) to the Class A-5 Certificates, an amount allocable to
           interest equal to the related Interest Remittance Amount;
 
                (v) to the Class A-5 Certificates, an amount allocable to
           principal equal to the related Principal Remittance Amount;
 
                (vi) to the Certificate Insurer an amount equal to previously
           unreimbursed Insured Payments with respect to the Class A-5
           Certificates, together with interest thereon at the rate referred to
           in the Insurance Agreement;
 
                (vii) to the Class A-5 Certificates, an amount allocable to
           principal equal to the Additional Principal;
 
                (viii) to the Certificate Insurer, all other amounts owing to
           the Certificate Insurer under the Insurance Agreement;
 
                (ix) to the Depositor or the Servicer, as applicable, certain
           reimbursable expenses pursuant to the Agreement;
 
                (x) to the Servicer, Nonrecoverable Advances not previously
           reimbursed with respect to Loan Group Two; and
 
                (xi) to the Class R Certificates, the balance, if any.
 
     Distributions allocable to principal of a Class of Offered Certificates
will not exceed the Class Certificate Balance of such Class immediately prior to
the applicable Distribution Date. On each Distribution Date, the Trustee will
withdraw the Yield Supplement Payment, if any, from the Yield Supplement Account
and distribute such amount to the Holders of the applicable Classes of Fixed
Rate Certificates.
 
     The 'Additional Principal' for any Class or Classes of Offered Certificates
and any Distribution Date will equal the lesser of (i) the amount required to be
distributed as principal so that the Overcollateralization Amount for the
related Loan Group equals the related Required Overcollateralization Amount and
(ii) the sum of (x) the Remaining Net Excess Spread for such Loan Group, (y) the
Available Transfer Cashflow and (z) the Net Excess Principal.
 
     The 'Adjusted Net Loan Rate' for any Home Equity Loan and any Distribution
Date will equal the related Loan Rate minus the Expense Fee Rate.
 
     An 'Available Funds Shortfall' means with respect to any Loan Group and
Distribution Date, the amount by which the Available Remittance Amount for such
Loan Group is less than the Required Payments for such Loan Group.
 
     The 'Available Remittance Amount' with respect to any Loan Group and
Distribution Date is equal to the sum of all amounts received or required to be
paid by the Servicer or the Seller during the related Due Period with respect to
the Home Equity Loans in such Loan Group (exclusive of the Servicing Fee with
respect to each Home Equity Loan, other servicing compensation payable to the
Servicer as permitted by the Agreement and certain amounts available for
reimbursement of Monthly Advances and Servicing Advances, as described above
under '--Advances') and deposited into the applicable Collection Account
pursuant to the Agreement as of the related Determination Date, including any
Monthly Advances, Compensating Interest and, through the end of the Pre-Funding
Period, amounts withdrawn from the Capitalized Interest Account with respect to
the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates and any remaining amount on
deposit in the Pre-Funding Account at the end of
 
                                      S-38
<PAGE>
the Pre-Funding Period and allocable to the related Loan Group, in each case
with respect to such Distribution Date.
 
     The 'Available Transfer Cashflow' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date
will equal the Remaining Net Excess Spread for the other Loan Group remaining
after the payment, if any, of Additional Principal on the Class or Classes of
Offered Certificates related to such other Loan Group.
 
     The 'Basic Principal Amount' with respect to any Loan Group and
Distribution Date will equal the sum of (i) each payment of principal on a Home
Equity Loan received by the Servicer (exclusive of amounts described in clauses
(ii) and (iii) below during the calendar month preceding the calendar month in
which such Distribution Date occurs (with respect to any Distribution Date, the
'Due Period'); (ii) curtailments (i.e., partial prepayments) and prepayments in
full received during the related Due Period; (iii) all Insurance Proceeds and
Net Liquidation Proceeds allocable to recoveries of principal of Home Equity
Loans received during the related Due Period; (iv) an amount equal to the
excess, if any, of the Principal Balance (immediately prior to liquidation) of
each Home Equity Loan liquidated during the related Due Period over the
principal portion of Net Liquidation Proceeds received during such Due Period
(the 'Unrecovered Class A Portion'); and (v) (a) the outstanding Principal
Balance of any Home Equity Loan repurchased by the Seller or purchased by the
Servicer as required or permitted by the Purchase Agreement or the Agreement as
of the related Determination Date and (b) with respect to any Defective Home
Equity Loan for which the Seller substitutes an Eligible Substitute Home Equity
Loan as of the related Determination Date, any excess of the Principal Balance
of such Defective Home Equity Loan over the Principal Balance of such Eligible
Substitute Home Equity Loan, plus the amount of any unreimbursed Servicing
Advances (defined herein) made by the Servicer with respect to the Home Equity
Loan to the extent received.
 
     The 'Carry-Forward Amount' for any Class of Offered Certificates on any
Distribution Date will equal the sum of (a) the excess of the aggregate Class
Remittance Amounts as of each preceding Distribution Date over the amount of the
actual distributions to the Holders of such Class of Offered Certificates made
on any such Distribution Date and not subsequently distributed, and (b) interest
on the amount, if any, of the interest component of the amount described in
clause (a) at one-twelfth of the applicable Certificate Rate.
 
     The 'Excess Principal' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date will equal
the lesser of (i) the portion, if any, of the Basic Principal Amount for such
Loan Group that is not required to be included in the Principal Remittance
Amount for the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates for such
Distribution Date and (ii) the amount of such portion remaining after the
application of the related Available Remittance Amount to the Required Payments
for such Loan Group.
 
     The 'Excess Spread' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date will equal
interest collected or advanced on the Home Equity Loans in such Loan Group
(including amounts allocated to the related Class of Offered Certificates in the
Capitalized Interest Account) minus the sum of (i) the Interest Remittance
Amount for the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates and (ii) the
Expense Fees for such Loan Group.
 
     The 'Expense Fee Rate' will equal the sum of the per annum rates at which
the Servicing Fee, the Back-up Servicing Fee, the Trustee Fee and the Premium
are calculated which, will be 0.73%.
 
     The 'Interest Remittance Amount' for any Distribution Date and Class of
Offered Certificates will equal interest accrued during the related Interest
Period at the applicable Certificate Rate on the Class Certificate Balance of
such Class of Offered Certificates immediately prior to the related Distribution
Date.
 
     The 'Principal Remittance Amount' for any Class of Offered Certificates and
any Distribution Date will be equal to the sum of:
 
          (i) the lesser of (x) the Basic Principal Amount for the related Loan
     Group and (y) the portion of such Basic Principal Amount required to be
     distributed to increase the Overcollateralization Amount for the related
     Loan Group to the Required Overcollateralization Amount for such Loan Group
     on such Distribution Date;
 
          (ii) the Carry-Forward Amount; and
 
                                      S-39
<PAGE>
          (iii) on the Distribution Date at the end of the Pre-Funding Period,
     amounts deposited in the related Distribution Account from the Pre-Funding
     Account pursuant to the Agreement and allocable to the related Loan Group.
 
     A 'Liquidated Home Equity Loan' means, as to any Distribution Date, any
Home Equity Loan in respect of which the Servicer has determined, based on the
servicing procedures specified in the Agreement, as of the end of the preceding
Due Period that all Liquidation Proceeds which it expects to recover with
respect to the disposition of the related Mortgaged Property have been
recovered.
 
     The 'Net Excess Principal' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date will
equal the Excess Principal for such Loan Group remaining after the application
thereof to cover an Available Funds Shortfall with respect to the other Loan
Group.
 
     The 'Net Excess Spread' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date will equal
the Excess Spread for such Loan Group remaining after the application thereof to
cover an Available Funds Shortfall with respect to such Loan Group.
 
     'Net Liquidation Proceeds' with respect to a Home Equity Loan are equal to
the Liquidation Proceeds, reduced by related expenses, up to the unpaid
Principal Balance of the Home Equity Loan plus accrued and unpaid interest
thereon. 'Liquidation Proceeds' are the proceeds received in connection with the
liquidation of any Home Equity Loan, whether through trustee's sale, foreclosure
sale or otherwise.
 
     The 'Overcollateralization Amount' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date
will equal the sum of (a) the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of the Loan Group
Balance and the amount on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account allocated to such
Loan Group (exclusive of any investment earnings included therein) as of the
close of business on the last day of the related Due Period, over (ii) the Class
Certificate Balance of the related Class or Classes of Offered Certificates,
after giving effect to the distributions of the related Principal Remittance
Amount on such Distribution Date, and (b) the amount, if any on deposit in the
Spread Account allocated to the related Class or Classes of Offered
Certificates.
 
     The 'Remaining Net Excess Spread' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date
will equal the Net Excess Spread for such Loan Group remaining after the
application thereof to cover an Available Funds Shortfall with respect to the
other Loan Group.
 
     The 'Required Payments' for any Loan Group and Distribution Date will equal
the amount required to pay the Expense Fees, other than the Servicing Fee, the
related Interest Remittance Amount(s) and the related Principal Remittance
Amount and to reimburse the Certificate Insurer for previously unreimbursed
Insured Payments with respect to the related Class or Classes of Certificates,
together with interest thereon at the rate referred to in the Insurance
Agreement.
 
     'Yield Supplement Payment' means as to any Distributor Date an amount equal
to the product of (x) the excess, if any, of (i) the sum of the weighted average
of the fixed Certificate Rates of the Fixed Rate Certificates plus the Expense
Fee Rate over (ii) the weighted average of the Loan Rates of the Home Equity
Loans in Loan Group One and (y) the Principal Balance of the Low Coupon Loans.
 
REPORTS TO CERTIFICATEHOLDERS
 
     Concurrently with each distribution to the Certificateholders, the Trustee
will forward to each Certificateholder a statement setting forth, among other
items, the following information with respect to each Class of Offered
Certificates:
 
          (i) the Available Remittance Amount for the related Distribution Date;
 
          (ii) the related Interest Remittance Amount and Certificate Rate;
 
          (iii) the related Principal Remittance Amount, stating separately the
     components thereof;
 
          (iv) the amount of the Monthly Advances and Compensating Interest
     Payments;
 
          (v) the Servicing Fee for such Distribution Date;
 
                                      S-40
<PAGE>
          (vi) the Additional Principal;
 
          (vii) the Class Certificate Balance, after giving effect to such
     distribution;
 
          (viii) the related Loan Group Balance;
 
          (ix) the number and aggregate Principal Balances of the Home Equity
     Loans in the related Loan Group as to which the minimum monthly payment is
     delinquent for 30-59 days, 60-89 days and 90 or more days, respectively, as
     of the end of the preceding Due Period;
 
          (x) the book value of any real estate which is acquired by the Trust
     through foreclosure or grant of deed in lieu of foreclosure;
 
          (xi) the amount of any Insured Payments for such Distribution Date;
     and
 
          (xii) the amount of the Unrecovered Class A Portions for each Loan
     Group realized during the related Due Period; the cumulative amount of
     losses realized since the Cut-Off Date for each Loan Group with separate
     items indicating gross losses, principal losses, recoveries, net losses and
     a breakout for recovery expenses.
 
     In the case of information furnished pursuant to clauses (ii) and (iii)
above, the amounts shall be expressed as a dollar amount per Certificate with a
$1,000 denomination.
 
     Within 60 days after the end of each calendar year, the Trustee will
forward to each Person who was a Certificateholder during the prior calendar
year a statement containing the information set forth in clauses (ii) and (iii)
above aggregated for such calendar year.
 
COLLECTION AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES ON HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
     The Servicer will make reasonable efforts to collect all payments called
for under the Home Equity Loans and will, consistent with the Agreement, follow
such collection procedures as it follows from time to time with respect to the
home equity loans in its servicing portfolio comparable to the Home Equity
Loans. Consistent with the above, the Servicer may in its discretion waive any
late payment charge or any assumption or other fee or charge that may be
collected in the ordinary course of servicing the Home Equity Loans.
 
     With respect to the Home Equity Loans, the Servicer may arrange with a
borrower a schedule for the payment of interest due and unpaid for a period,
provided that any such arrangement is consistent with the Servicer's policies
with respect to the home equity loans it owns or services. With respect to Home
Equity Loans that are junior in priority to a First Lien on a Mortgaged
Property, the Servicer has the power under certain circumstances to consent to a
new mortgage lien on such Mortgaged Property having priority over such Home
Equity Loan in connection with the refinancing of such First Lien.
 
HAZARD INSURANCE
 
     The Servicer will cause to be maintained fire and hazard insurance with
extended coverage customary in the area where the Mortgaged Property is located,
in an amount which is at least equal to the least of (i) the outstanding
Principal Balance on the Home Equity Loan and any related First Lien, (ii) the
full insurable value of the premises securing the Home Equity Loan and (iii) the
minimum amount required to compensate for damage or loss on a replacement cost
basis in each case in an amount not less than such amount as is necessary to
avoid the application of any co-insurance clause contained in the related hazard
insurance policy. Generally, if the Mortgaged Property is in an area identified
in the Federal Register by the Federal Emergency Management Agency as Flood Zone
'A', such flood insurance has been made available and the Servicer determines
that such insurance is necessary in accordance with accepted mortgage servicing
practices of prudent lending institutions servicing similar mortgage loans, the
Servicer will cause to be purchased a flood insurance policy with a generally
acceptable insurance carrier, in an amount representing coverage not less than
the least of (a) the outstanding Principal Balance of the Home Equity Loan and
any related First Lien, (b) the full insurable value of the Mortgaged Property,
or (c) the maximum amount of insurance available under the National Flood
Insurance Act of 1968, as amended. The Servicer will also maintain on REO
Property, to the extent such insurance is available, fire and hazard insurance
in the applicable amounts described above, liability insurance and, to the
 
                                      S-41
<PAGE>
extent required and available under the National Flood Insurance Act of 1968, as
amended, and the Servicer determines that such insurance is necessary in
accordance with accepted mortgage servicing practices of prudent lending
institutions servicing similar home equity loans, flood insurance in an amount
equal to that required above. Any amounts collected by the Servicer under any
such policies (other than amounts to be applied to the restoration or repair of
the Mortgaged Property, or to be released to the Mortgagor in accordance with
the Servicer's normal mortgage servicing procedures) will be deposited in the
applicable Collection Account, subject to retention by the Servicer to the
extent such amounts constitute servicing compensation or to withdrawal pursuant
to the Agreement.
 
     In the event that the Servicer obtains and maintains a blanket policy as
provided in the Agreement insuring against fire and hazards of extended coverage
on all of the Home Equity Loans, then, to the extent such policy names the
Servicer as loss payee and provides coverage in an amount equal to the aggregate
unpaid principal balance of the Home Equity Loans without coinsurance and
otherwise complies with the requirements of the preceding paragraph, the
Servicer will be deemed conclusively to have satisfied its obligations with
respect to fire and hazard insurance coverage.
 
REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
     The Servicer will foreclose upon or otherwise comparably convert to
ownership Mortgaged Properties securing such of the Home Equity Loans as come
into default when, in accordance with applicable servicing procedures under the
Agreement, no satisfactory arrangements can be made for the collection of
delinquent payments. In connection with such foreclosure or other conversion,
the Servicer will follow such practices as it deems necessary or advisable and
as are in keeping with its general mortgage servicing activities, provided the
Servicer will not be required to expend its own funds in connection with
foreclosure or other conversion, correction of default on a related First Lien
or restoration of any property unless, in its sole judgment, such foreclosure,
correction or restoration will increase Net Liquidation Proceeds. The Servicer
will be reimbursed out of Liquidation Proceeds for advances of its own funds as
liquidation expenses before any Net Liquidation Proceeds are distributed to
Certificateholders.
 
ENFORCEMENT OF DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES
 
     When any Mortgaged Property is about to be conveyed by the obligor, the
Servicer will, to the extent it has knowledge of such prospective conveyance and
prior to the time of the consummation of such conveyance, exercise its rights to
accelerate the maturity of the related Home Equity Loan under the applicable
'due-on-sale' clause, if any, unless it reasonably believes that such clause is
not enforceable under applicable law. In such event, the Servicer is authorized
to accept from or enter into an assumption agreement with the person to whom
such property has been or is about to be conveyed, pursuant to which such person
becomes liable under the Home Equity Loan and pursuant to which the original
obligor is released from liability and such person is substituted as the obligor
and becomes liable under the Home Equity Loan. Any fee collected in connection
with an assumption will be retained by the Servicer as additional servicing
compensation. The terms of a Home Equity Loan may not be changed in connection
with an assumption.
 
SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES
 
     With respect to each Due Period, the Servicer will receive from interest
payments actually received in respect of the Home Equity Loans a portion of such
interest payments as a monthly Servicing Fee in the amount equal to 0.50% per
annum (the 'Servicing Fee Rate') on the Principal Balance of each Home Equity
Loan as of the first day of each such Due Period. All assumption fees, late
payment charges and other fees and charges, to the extent collected from
borrowers, will be retained by the Servicer as additional servicing
compensation. The Servicer will pay certain ongoing expenses associated with the
Trust and incurred by it in connection with its responsibilities under the
Agreement.
 
                                      S-42
<PAGE>
EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE
 
     The Agreement provides for delivery on or before January 31 in each year,
beginning in January 1997, to the Depositor, the Trustee, the Certificate
Insurer and the Rating Agencies of an annual statement signed by an officer of
the Servicer to the effect that the Servicer has fulfilled its material
obligations under the Agreement throughout the preceding fiscal year, except as
specified in such statement.
 
     On or before January 31 in each year, beginning in January 1997, the
Servicer will furnish a report prepared by a firm of nationally recognized
independent public accountants (who may also render other services to the
Servicer or the Seller) to the Depositor, the Trustee, the Certificate Insurer
and the Rating Agencies to the effect that such firm has examined certain
documents and the records relating to servicing of the Home Equity Loans under
the Uniform Single Attestation Program for Mortgage Bankers and such firm's
conclusion with respect thereto.
 
CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE SERVICER
 
     The Agreement provides that the Servicer may not resign from its
obligations and duties thereunder, except in connection with a permitted
transfer of servicing, unless (i) such duties and obligations are no longer
permissible under applicable law or are in material conflict by reason of
applicable law with any other activities of a type and nature presently carried
on by it or (ii) upon the satisfaction of the following conditions: (a) the
Servicer has proposed a successor servicer to the Trustee in writing and such
proposed successor servicer is reasonably acceptable to the Trustee; (b) the
Rating Agencies have confirmed to the Trustee that the appointment of such
proposed successor servicer as the Servicer will not result in the reduction or
withdrawal of the then-current rating of the Offered Certificates; and (c) such
proposed successor servicer is reasonably acceptable to the Certificate Insurer.
No such resignation will become effective until the Trustee or a successor
servicer has assumed the Servicer's obligations and duties under the Agreement.
 
     The Servicer may perform any of its duties and obligations under the
Agreement through one or more subservicers or delegates, which may be affiliates
of the Servicer. Notwithstanding any such arrangement, the Servicer will remain
liable and obligated to the Trustee and the Certificateholders for the
Servicer's duties and obligations under the Agreement, without any diminution of
such duties and obligations and as if the Servicer itself were performing such
duties and obligations.
 
     The Agreement provides that none of the Depositor, the Seller or the
Servicer or any of their respective directors, officers, employees or agents
will be under any other liability to the Trust, the Trustee, the
Certificateholders or any other person for any action taken or for refraining
from taking any action pursuant to the Agreement. However, the Servicer will not
be protected against any liability which would otherwise be imposed by reason of
its willful misconduct, bad faith or negligence in the performance of its duties
under the Agreement or by reason of reckless disregard of its obligations
thereunder. In addition, the Agreement provides that the Servicer will not be
under any obligation to appear in, prosecute or defend any legal action which is
not incidental to the Servicer's servicing responsibilities under the Agreement.
The Servicer may, in its sole discretion, undertake any such legal action which
it may deem necessary or desirable with respect to the Agreement and the rights
and duties of the parties thereto and the interest of the Certificateholders
thereunder.
 
     Any corporation into which the Servicer may be merged or consolidated, or
any corporation resulting from any merger, conversion or consolidation to which
the Servicer shall be a party, or any corporation succeeding to the business of
the Servicer shall be the successor of the Servicer, without the execution or
filing of any paper or any further act on the part of any of the parties hereto,
anything in the Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding.
 
THE BACK-UP SERVICER
 
     The Bank of New York will be appointed as the Back-Up Servicer under the
Agreement. Prior to the occurrence of an Event of Servicer Termination, the
Agreement requires the Back-Up Servicer to maintain current records of each
Mortgagor's account and the activity therein. The Servicer will be required to
furnish electronically such records to the Back-Up Servicer on a monthly basis,
and the Back-Up Servicer will be required to recalculate the Servicer's
application of all funds received from or on behalf of the Mortgagors. Upon the
occurrence of an Event of Servicer Termination, the Back-Up Servicer will be
obligated to assume the
 
                                      S-43
<PAGE>
obligations of the Servicer as described below. In performing its obligations
under the Agreement, the Back-Up Servicer will be entitled to the same
protections afforded to the Servicer under the Agreement.
 
EVENTS OF SERVICER TERMINATION
 
     The Servicer's rights under the Agreement may be terminated upon the
occurrence of an Event of Default or a Trigger Event. 'Events of Default' will
consist of: (i) any failure of the Servicer to deposit in either Collection
Account any deposit required to be made under the Agreement, which failure
continues unremedied for three Business Days after the giving of written notice
of such failure to the Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Servicer and the
Trustee by the Certificate Insurer or Certificateholders of any Class evidencing
Percentage Interests aggregating not less than 25% of such Class; (ii) any
failure by the Servicer duly to observe or perform in any material respect any
other of its covenants or agreements in the Agreement which continues unremedied
for 30 days after the giving of written notice of such failure to the Servicer
by the Trustee, or to the Servicer and the Trustee by the Certificate Insurer or
Certificateholders of any Class evidencing Percentage Interests aggregating not
less than 25% of such Class; (iii) any failure by the Servicer to make any
required Servicing Advance, which failure continues unremedied for a period of
30 days after the giving of written notice of such failure to the Servicer by
the Trustee, or to the Servicer and the Trustee by the Certificate Insurer or
Certificateholders of any Class evidencing Percentage Interests aggregating not
less than 25% of such Class; (iv) certain events of insolvency, readjustment of
debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings relating to
the Servicer and certain actions by the Servicer indicating insolvency,
reorganization or inability to pay its obligations (an 'Insolvency Event'); (v)
so long as the Seller is an affiliate of the Servicer, any failure of the Seller
to repurchase or substitute Eligible Substitute Home Equity Loans for Defective
Home Equity Loans as required by the Purchase Agreement; (vi) any failure to pay
any Monthly Advance or any Compensating Interest Payments which continues
unremedied for a period of one Business Day; or (vii) any insufficiency in
either Amount Available excluding Insured Payments occurs on a Distribution Date
resulting in the need for an Insured Payment.
 
     A 'Trigger Event' will consist of: (i) the failure by the Seller or the
Servicer to pay any amount due the Certificate Insurer pursuant to the Insurance
Agreement among the Depositor, the Seller, the Servicer and the Certificate
Insurer, which continues unremedied for three Business Days after written notice
of such failure by the Certificate Insurer; (ii) the Certificate Insurer
determines that the performance of the Servicer is not satisfactory; or (iii)
the Servicer is a party to a merger, consolidation or other corporate
transaction in which the Servicer is not the surviving entity, the debt of such
surviving entity is not investment grade or the Certificate Insurer determines
that the servicing capabilities of the surviving entity could materially and
adversely affect the servicing of the Home Equity Loans.
 
RIGHTS UPON AN EVENT OF SERVICER TERMINATION
 
     So long as an Event of Default remains unremedied, either the Trustee, or
Certificateholders of any Class evidencing Percentage Interests of at least 51%
of such Class, with the consent of the Certificate Insurer, or the Certificate
Insurer, may terminate all of the rights and obligations of the Servicer under
the Agreement and in and to the Home Equity Loans, whereupon the Back-Up
Servicer will succeed to all the responsibilities, duties and liabilities of the
Servicer under the Agreement (the 'Successor Servicer') and will be entitled to
similar compensation arrangements. Upon the occurrence and continuation beyond
the applicable grace period of the event described in clause (vi) in the second
preceding paragraph, the Back-Up Servicer will immediately assume the duties of
the Servicer. The Back-Up Servicer, as Successor Servicer, will be obligated to
make Monthly Advances and Servicing Advances and certain other advances unless
it determines reasonably and in good faith that such advances would not be
recoverable. In the event that the Back-Up Servicer would be obligated to
succeed the Servicer but is unwilling or unable so to act, it may appoint, or
petition a court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of, a housing and
home finance institution or other mortgage loan or home equity loan servicer
with all licenses and permits required to perform its obligations under the
Agreement and having a net worth of at least $15,000,000 and acceptable to the
Certificate Insurer to act as Successor Servicer under the Agreement. Pending
such appointment, the Back-Up Servicer will be obligated to act in such capacity
unless prohibited by law. Such successor will be entitled to receive the same
compensation that the Servicer would otherwise have received (or such lesser
compensation as the Trustee and such successor may agree). A trustee in
 
                                      S-44
<PAGE>
bankruptcy for the Servicer may be empowered to prevent the termination and
replacement of the Servicer if the only Event of Default has occurred is an
Insolvency Event.
 
     Upon the occurrence of a Trigger Event, the Certificate Insurer, in its
sole discretion, may direct the Trustee to remove the Servicer and to appoint a
Successor Servicer.
 
AMENDMENT
 
     The Agreement may be amended from time to time by the Depositor, the
Servicer and the Trustee, with the consent of the Certificate Insurer, but
without the consent of the Certificateholders, to cure any ambiguity, to correct
or supplement any provisions therein which may be defective or inconsistent with
any other provisions of the Agreement, to add to the duties of the Depositor or
the Servicer, to comply with any requirements imposed by the Code or any
regulation thereunder, or to add or amend any provisions of the Agreement as
required by the Rating Agencies in order to maintain or improve any rating of
the Offered Certificates (it being understood that, after obtaining the ratings
in effect on the Closing Date, none of the Depositor, the Seller, the Servicer
or the Trustee is obligated to obtain, maintain, or improve any such rating) or
to add any other provisions with respect to matters or questions arising under
the Agreement which shall not be inconsistent with the provisions of the
Agreement, provided that such action will not, as evidenced by an opinion of
counsel, materially and adversely affect the interests of any Certificateholder
or the Certificate Insurer; provided, that any such amendment will not be deemed
to materially and adversely affect the Certificateholders and no such opinion
will be required to be delivered if the person requesting such amendment obtains
a letter from the Rating Agencies stating that such amendment would not result
in a downgrading of the then-current rating of the Offered Certificates. The
Agreement may also be amended from time to time by the Depositor, the Servicer
and the Trustee, with the consent of Holders of Certificates evidencing
Percentage Interests aggregating not less than 51% of each Class affected
thereby and the Certificate Insurer for the purpose of adding any provisions to
or changing in any manner or eliminating any of the provisions of the Agreement
or of modifying in any manner the rights of the Certificateholders, provided
that no such amendment will (i) reduce in any manner the amount of, or delay the
timing of, collections of payments on the Certificates or distributions or
payments under the Policy which are required to be made on any Certificate
without the consent of the Certificateholder or (ii) reduce the aforesaid
percentage required to consent to any such amendment, without the consent of the
holders of all Certificates then outstanding. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the
provisions of the Agreement relating to overcollateralization may be reduced or
eliminated by the Certificate Insurer without the consent of any
Certificateholder so long as a Certificate Insurer Default does not exist.
 
TERMINATION; RETIREMENT OF THE CERTIFICATES
 
     The Trust will terminate on the Distribution Date following the later of
(A) termination of the Policy and payment in full of all amounts owing to the
Certificate Insurer and (B) the earliest of (i) the Distribution Date on which
the Class Certificate Balance of each Class of Offered Certificates has been
reduced to zero, (ii) the final payment or other liquidation of the last Home
Equity Loan in the Trust, and (iii) the optional transfer to the Servicer of the
Home Equity Loans, as described below.
 
     The Servicer will have the right to purchase all remaining Home Equity
Loans and REO Properties in the Trust and thereby effect early retirement of the
Certificates, subject to the Pool Balance of such Home Equity Loans and REO
Properties at the time of purchase being less than or equal to 10% of the sum of
the Pool Balance as of the Cut-Off Date and the Principal Balance of each
Subsequent Home Equity Loan as of the applicable Subsequent Cut-Off Date. In the
event the Servicer exercises such option, the purchase price will be at least
equal to (x) 100% of its then outstanding principal balance plus (y) the greater
of (i) the aggregate amount of accrued and unpaid interest on the Home Equity
Loans through the related Due Period and (ii) 30 days' accrued interest thereon
at the Loan Rate, in each case net of the Servicing Fee plus (z) any amounts due
to the Certificate Insurer.
 
     The termination of the Trust will be effected in a manner consistent with
applicable federal income tax regulations and the status of the Trust as a
REMIC.
 
                                      S-45
<PAGE>
OPTIONAL PURCHASE OF DEFAULTED HOME EQUITY LOANS
 
     The Servicer has the option to purchase from the Trust any Home Equity Loan
90 days or more delinquent at a purchase price equal to the outstanding
Principal Balance of such Home Equity Loan as of the date of purchase, plus the
greater of (i) all accrued and unpaid interest on such principal balance and
(ii) 30 days' interest on such principal balance, computed at the Loan Rate,
plus all unreimbursed amounts owing to the Certificate Insurer with interest
thereon at the rate referred to in the Insurance Agreement.
 
THE TRUSTEE
 
     The Bank of New York, a banking corporation organized under the laws of the
State of New York, has been named Trustee pursuant to the Agreement.
 
     The Trustee may have normal banking relationships with the Depositor, the
Seller and the Servicer.
 
     The Trustee may resign at any time, in which event the Depositor will be
obligated to appoint a successor Trustee, as approved by the Certificate Insurer
and the Servicer. The Depositor may also remove the Trustee if the Trustee
ceases to be eligible to continue as such under the Agreement or if the Trustee
becomes insolvent. Upon becoming aware of such circumstances, the Depositor will
be obligated to appoint a successor Trustee, as approved by the Certificate
Insurer and the Servicer. Any resignation or removal of the Trustee and
appointment of a successor Trustee will not become effective until acceptance of
the appointment by the successor Trustee.
 
     No holder of a Certificate will have any right under the Agreement to
institute any proceeding with respect to the Agreement unless such holder
previously has given to the Trustee written notice of default and unless
Certificateholders evidencing Percentage Interests of at least 51% of the
applicable Class have made written requests upon the Trustee to institute such
proceeding in its own name as Trustee thereunder and have offered to the Trustee
reasonable indemnity and the Trustee for 60 days has neglected or refused to
institute any such proceeding. The Trustee will be under no obligation to
exercise any of the trusts or powers vested in it by the Agreement or to make
any investigation of matters arising thereunder or to institute, conduct or
defend any litigation thereunder or in relation thereto at the request, order or
direction of any of the Certificateholders, unless such Certificateholders have
offered to the Trustee reasonable security or indemnity against the cost,
expenses and liabilities which may be incurred therein or thereby.
 
                     THE POLICY AND THE CERTIFICATE INSURER
 
THE POLICY
 
     Simultaneously with the issuance of the Certificates, the Certificate
Insurer will issue the Policy pursuant to which it will irrevocably and
unconditionally guaranty payment on each Distribution Date to the Trustee for
the benefit of the Holders of each Class of Offered Certificates of a maximum
amount equal to the applicable Guaranteed Interest Payment Amount and the
applicable Guaranteed Principal Payment Amount for such Distribution Date. The
Offered Certificates, the Purchase Agreement and the Agreement may not be
amended unless the Certificate Insurer has given its prior written consent. The
amount of the actual payment (the 'Insured Payment'), if any, made by the
Certificate Insurer under the Policy on each Distribution Date allocated to such
Class of Offered Certificates is equal to the sum of (A) the excess, if any, of
(1) the Interest Remittance Amount with respect to such Class and Distribution
Date over (2) the Amount Available (net of Insured Payments) for the related
Loan Group, (B) the portion, if any, of the Yield Supplement Payment, allocable
to such Class of Offered Certificates and (C) the amount by which the Class
Certificate Balance of such Class of Offered Certificates (or in the case of the
Fixed Rate Certificates, the aggregate Class Certificate Balance of such
Certificates) after giving effect to all allocations and distributions to
principal on such Class or Classes of Offered Certificates on such Distribution
Date exceeds the related Loan Group Balance as of such Distribution Date. The
Certificate Insurer's obligations under the Policy to make Insured Payments will
be discharged to the extent funds are transferred to the Trustee as provided in
the Policy, whether or not such funds are properly applied by the Trustee.
 
     Payment of claims under the Policy will be made by the Certificate Insurer
following Receipt by the Certificate Insurer of the appropriate notice for
payment on the later to occur of (a) 11:00 a.m., New York City
 
                                      S-46
<PAGE>
time, on the second Business Day following Receipt of such notice for payment,
and (b) 11:00 a.m., New York City time, on the Business Day immediately
preceding the relevant Distribution Date.
 
     The terms 'Receipt' and 'Received,' with respect to the Policy, means
actual delivery to the Certificate Insurer, prior to 2:00 pm., New York City
time, on a Business Day; delivery either on a day that is not a Business Day or
after 2:00 pm., New York City time, shall be deemed to be Receipt on the next
succeeding Business Day.
 
     If the payment of the Guaranteed Interest Payment Amount or the Guaranteed
Principal Payment Amount is voided pursuant to a final and non-appealable order
(a 'Preference Event') under any applicable bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership
or similar law in an Insolvency Proceeding, and, as a result of such a
Preference Event, the Trustee is required to return such voided payment, or any
portion of such voided payment, made in respect of the Certificates (an 'Avoided
Payment'), the Certificate Insurer will pay an amount equal to such Avoided
Payment, upon receipt by the Certificate Insurer from the Trustee of (x) a
certified copy of a final order of a court exercising jurisdiction in such
Insolvency Proceeding to the effect that the Trustee is required to return any
such payment or portion thereof during the term of the Policy because such
payment was voided under applicable law, with respect to which order the appeal
period has expired without an appeal having been filed (the 'Final Order'), (y)
an assignment, in form reasonably satisfactory to the Certificate Insurer,
irrevocably assigning to the Certificate Insurer all rights and claims of the
Trustee relating to or arising under such Avoided Payment and (z) a notice for
payment appropriately completed and executed by the Trustee. Such payment shall
be disbursed to the receiver, conservator, debtor-in-possession or trustee in
bankruptcy named in the Final Order and not to the Trustee directly.
 
     Notwithstanding the foregoing, in no event shall the Certificate Insurer be
obligated to make any payment in respect of any Avoided Payment, which payment
represents a payment of the principal amount of a Class of Offered Certificates,
prior to the time the Certificate Insurer would have been required to make a
payment in respect of such principal in the absence of such Preference Event.
 
     The Certificate Insurer shall make payments due in respect of Avoided
Payments prior to 1:00 p.m., New York City time, on the second Business Day
following the Certificate Insurer's receipt of the documents required under
clauses (x) through (z) of the second preceding paragraph. Any such documents
received by the Certificate Insurer after 3:00 p.m., New York City time, on any
Business Day or on any day that is not a Business Day shall be deemed to have
been received by the Certificate Insurer prior to 3:00 p.m. on the next
succeeding Business Day.
 
     Under the Policy, 'Business Day' means any day other than (i) a Saturday or
Sunday or (ii) a day on which banking institutions in the City of New York, New
York, or the State of New Jersey are authorized or obligated by law or executive
order to be closed.
 
     'Insolvency Proceeding' means the commencement, after the Closing Date, of
any bankruptcy, insolvency, readjustment of debt, reorganization, marshalling of
assets and liabilities or similar proceedings by or against any Person, or the
commencement, after the Closing Date, of any proceedings by or against any
Person for the winding up or liquidation of its affairs, or the consent after
the date hereof to the appointment of a trustee, conservator, receiver or
liquidator in any bankruptcy, insolvency, readjustment of debt, reorganization,
marshalling of assets and liabilities or similar proceedings of or relating to
any Person.
 
     The terms of the Policy cannot be modified, altered or affected by any
other agreement or instrument, or by the merger, consolidation or dissolution of
the Depositor, the Seller or Servicer. The Policy by its terms may not be
canceled or revoked. The Policy is governed by the laws of the State of New
York.
 
     Pursuant to the terms of the Agreement, unless a Certificate Insurer
Default exists, the Certificate Insurer will be entitled to exercise all rights
of the Holders of the Offered Certificates, without the consent of such
Certificateholders, and the Holders of the Offered Certificates may exercise
such rights only with the prior written consent of the Certificate Insurer. In
addition, the Certificate Insurer will, as a third party beneficiary to the
Agreement, have, among others, the following rights: (i) the right to give
notices of breach or to terminate the rights and obligations of the Servicer
under the Agreement in the event of an Event of Default by the Servicer and to
institute proceedings against the Servicer; (ii) the right to consent to or
direct any waivers of defaults by the Servicer; (iii) the right to remove the
Trustee pursuant to the Agreement; (iv) the right to direct the actions of the
Trustee during the continuation of a Servicer default; (v) the right to require
the Seller to repurchase Home
 
                                      S-47
<PAGE>
Equity Loans for breach of representation and warranty or defect in
documentation; (vi) the right to direct foreclosures upon the failure of the
Servicer to do so in accordance with the Agreement; and (vii) the right to
direct the Trustee to investigate certain matters. The Certificate Insurer's
consent will be required prior to, among other things, (i) the removal of the
Trustee, (ii) the appointment of any successor Trustee or Servicer or (iii) any
amendment to the Agreement (which consent will not be withheld if an opinion of
counsel is delivered and addressed to the Certificate Insurer and the Trustee to
the effect that failure to amend the Agreement would adversely affect the
interests of the Certificateholders).
 
THE CERTIFICATE INSURER AND MBIA
 
     Effective February 17, 1998, MBIA Inc., a New York Stock Exchange listed
company (the 'Company') acquired all of the outstanding stock of the Certificate
Insurer through a merger with its parent CapMAC Holdings Inc. Pursuant to a
reinsurance agreement, the Certificate Insurer has ceded all of its net insured
risks (including any amounts due but unpaid from third party reinsurers), as
well as its unearned premiums and contingency reserves, to MBIA Insurance
Corporation ('MBIA'). The Company is not obligated to pay the debts of or claims
against the Certificate Insurer.
 
     MBIA is the principal operating subsidiary of the Company. The Company is
not obligated to pay the debts of or claims against MBIA. MBIA is domiciled in
the State of New York and licensed to do business in and is subject to
regulation under the laws of all 50 states, the District of Columbia, the
Commonwealth of Puerto Rico, the Commonwealth of the Northern Mariana Islands,
the Virgin Islands of the United States and the Territory of Guam. MBIA has two
European branches, one in the Republic of France and the other in the Kingdom of
Spain. New York has laws prescribing minimum capital requirements, limiting
classes and concentrations of investments and requiring the approval of policy
rates and forms. State laws also regulate the amount of both the aggregate and
individual risks that may be insured, the payment of dividends by MBIA, changes
in control and transactions among affiliates. Additionally, MBIA is required to
maintain contingency reserves on its liabilities in certain amounts and for
certain periods of time.
 
     The consolidated financial statements of MBIA, a wholly owned subsidiary of
the Company, and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 1997 and December 31, 1996
and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997, prepared
in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, included in the
Annual Report on Form 10-K of the Company for the year ended December 31, 1997,
and the consolidated financial statements of MBIA and its subsidiaries as of
March 31, 1998 and for the three month periods ending March 31, 1998 and March
31, 1997, included in the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q of the Company for the
period ending March 31, 1998, are hereby incorporated by reference into this
Prospectus Supplement and shall be deemed to be a part hereof. Any statement
contained in a document incorporated by reference herein shall be modified or
superseded for purposes of this Prospectus Supplement to the extent that a
statement contained herein or in any other subsequently filed document which
also is incorporated by reference herein modifies or supersedes such statement.
Any statement so modified or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so
modified or superseded, to constitute a part of this Prospectus Supplement.
 
     All financial statements of MBIA and its subsidiaries included in documents
filed by the Company pursuant to Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, subsequent to the date of this
Prospectus Supplement and prior to the termination of the offering of the
Offered Certificates shall be deemed to be incorporated by reference into this
Prospectus Supplement and to be a part hereof from the respective dates of
filing such documents.
 
                                      S-48
<PAGE>
     The tables below present selected financial information of MBIA determined
in accordance with statutory accounting practices prescribed or permitted by
insurance regulatory authorities ('SAP') and generally accepted accounting
principles ('GAAP'):
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                 SAP
                                                                     ----------------------------
                                                                     DECEMBER 31,     MARCH 31,
                                                                        1997            1998
                                                                     ------------    ------------
                                                                     (UNAUDITED)     (UNAUDITED)
                                                                                                                              
                                                                            (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                                                  <C>             <C>
Admitted Assets...................................................      $5,256          $5,475
Liabilities.......................................................       3,496           3,658
Capital and Surplus...............................................       1,760           1,817
</TABLE>

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION>
                                                                               SAP
                                                                     ----------------------------
                                                                     DECEMBER 31,     MARCH 31,
                                                                        1997            1998
                                                                     ------------    ------------
                                                                     (UNAUDITED)     (UNAUDITED)
                                                                     
                                                                            (IN MILLIONS)
<S>                                                                  <C>             <C>
Assets............................................................      $5,988          $6,196
Liabilities.......................................................       2,624           2,725
Shareholder's Equity..............................................       3,364           3,471
</TABLE>
 
     Copies of the financial statements of MBIA incorporated by reference herein
and copies of MBIA's 1997 year-end audited financial statements prepared in
accordance with the statutory accounting practices are available, without
charge, from MBIA. The address of MBIA is 113 King Street, Armonk, New York
10504. The telephone number of MBIA is (914) 273-4545.
 
     MBIA does not accept any responsibility for the accuracy or completeness of
this Prospectus Supplement or any information or disclosure contained herein, or
omitted herefrom, other than with respect to the accuracy of the information
regarding MBIA set forth under the subheading 'THE POLICY AND THE CERTIFICATE
INSURER--The Certificate Insurer and MBIA.' Additionally, MBIA makes no
representation regarding the Certificates or the advisability of investing in
the Certificates.
 
     Moody's Investors Service, Inc. rates the claims paying ability of MBIA
'Aaa.'
 
     Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill
Companies, Inc. rates the claims paying ability of MBIA 'AAA.'
 
     Fitch IBCA, Inc. (formerly known as Fitch Investors Service, L.P.) rates
the claims paying ability of MBIA 'AAA.'
 
     Each rating of MBIA should be evaluated independently. The ratings reflect
the respective rating agency's current assessment of the creditworthiness of
MBIA and its ability to pay claims on its policies of insurance. Any further
explanation as to the significance of the above ratings may be obtained only
from the applicable rating agency.
 
     The above ratings are not recommendations to buy, sell or hold the
Certificates, and such ratings may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any
time by the rating agencies. Any downward revision or withdrawal of any of the
above ratings may have an adverse effect on the market price of the
Certificates. MBIA does not guaranty the market price of the Certificates, nor
does it guaranty that the ratings on the Certificates, will not be revised or
withdrawn.
 
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The net proceeds to be received from the sale of the Offered Certificates
will be used by the Depositor to purchase the Home Equity Loans. The Home Equity
Loans will have been acquired by the Depositor from the Seller pursuant to the
Purchase Agreement.
 
                                      S-49
<PAGE>
                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
 
     The Depositor has been advised by Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. (the
'Underwriter') that it presently intends to make a market in the Offered
Certificates and by Key Capital Markets, Inc. that it may make a market in the
Offered Certificates; however, the Underwriter and Key Capital Markets, Inc. are
not obligated to do so, any market-making may be discontinued at any time, and
there can be no assurance that an active public market for the Offered
Certificates will develop.
 
     The Depositor is an affiliate of the Underwriter.
 
     Key Capital Markets, Inc. is a broker-dealer registered as such with the
National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., and commenced business on
February 26, 1996. Key Capital Markets, Inc. has acted as an underwriter in a
variety of public finance offerings as well as a number of asset-backed and
other debt offerings for subsidiaries of KeyCorp. The Seller and Servicer are an
affiliate of Key Capital Markets, Inc.
 
     After the initial distribution of the Offered Certificates by the
Underwriter, the Prospectus and Prospectus Supplement may be used by Key Capital
Markets, Inc., an affiliate of the Seller and the Servicer, in connection with
market making transactions in the Offered Certificates. Key Capital Markets,
Inc. may act as principal or agent in such transactions, but has no obligation
to do so. Such transactions will be at prices related to prevailing market
prices at the time of sale.
 
                                    EXPERTS
 
     The consolidated balance sheets of MBIA Insurance Corporation and
Subsidiaries as of December 31, 1997 and 1996 and the related consolidated
statements of income, changes in shareholder's equity, and cash flows for each
of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1997, incorporated by
reference in this Prospectus Supplement, have been incorporated herein in
reliance on the report of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, independent accountants,
given on the authority of that firm as experts in accounting and auditing.
 
                                    RATINGS
 
     It is a condition to issuance that each Class of Offered Certificates be
rated in the highest rating category by Standard & Poor's Ratings Group, a
division of The McGraw Hill Companies and Moody's Investors Service, Inc.
 
     A securities rating addresses the likelihood of the receipt by Holders of
distributions on the Home Equity Loans to which they are entitled. The rating
takes into consideration the characteristics of the Home Equity Loans and the
structural, legal and tax aspects associated with the Offered Certificates. The
ratings on the Offered Certificates do not, however, constitute statements
regarding the likelihood or frequency of prepayments on the Home Equity Loans or
the possibility that Holders might realize a lower than anticipated yield. The
ratings assigned to the Offered Certificates will depend primarily upon the
creditworthiness of the Certificate Insurer. Any reduction in a rating assigned
to the claims-paying ability of the Certificate Insurer below the ratings
initially assigned to the Offered Certificates may result in a reduction of one
or more of the ratings assigned to the Offered Certificates.
 
     A securities rating is not a recommendation to buy, sell or hold securities
and may be subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the assigning rating
organization. Each securities rating should be evaluated independently of
similar ratings on different securities.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
     Certain legal matters with respect to the Certificates will be passed upon
for the Depositor by Stroock & Stroock & Lavan, New York, New York and for the
Underwriter by Brown & Wood, New York, New York.
 
                                      S-50
<PAGE>
                                                                      APPENDIX A
 
                        CERTAIN STATISTICAL INFORMATION
           REGARDING THE INITIAL HOME EQUITY LOANS IN THE LOAN GROUPS
                             AS OF THE CUT-OFF DATE
 
                                      A-1
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-1
                                 LOAN GROUP ONE
                          FIXED RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
                DISTRIBUTION BY CUT-OFF DATE PRINCIPAL BALANCES
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                              NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
       CUT-OFF DATE              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
    PRINCIPAL BALANCES              LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- --------------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                           <C>                  <C>                  <C>
         Up to $  9,999.99             5            $      49,383.82            0.11%
  10,000.00 to   19,999.99            90                1,344,796.68            2.95
  20,000.00 to   29,999.99           123                2,983,387.39            6.54
  30,000.00 to   39,999.99            98                3,378,405.18            7.41
  40,000.00 to   49,999.99            68                2,976,975.46            6.53
  50,000.00 to   59,999.99            57                3,071,784.05            6.74
  60,000.00 to   69,999.99            44                2,846,172.15            6.24
  70,000.00 to   79,999.99            45                3,374,260.95            7.40
  80,000.00 to   89,999.99            22                1,861,216.57            4.08
  90,000.00 to   99,999.99            27                2,560,099.52            5.62
 100,000.00 to  149,999.99            76                9,292,583.94           20.38
 150,000.00 to  199,999.99            40                6,825,162.07           14.97
 200,000.00 to  299,999.99            15                3,556,623.31            7.80
 300,000.00 to  399,999.99             3                1,016,589.45            2.23
 400,000.00 to  499,999.99             1                  455,000.00            1.00
                                     ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                           714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                                     ---           -----------------         -------
                                     ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                      DISTRIBUTION BY GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION
                          OF THE MORTGAGED PROPERTIES
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
  GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION            LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- -----------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Connecticut                         5            $     533,585.14            1.17%
Delaware                            4                  365,392.56            0.80
Maryland                           43                2,653,473.15            5.82
New Jersey                        288               18,815,179.92           41.27
New York                          264               17,219,785.17           37.77
Pennsylvania                      103                5,696,775.46           12.50
Virginia                            7                  308,249.14            0.68
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                        714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-2
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-1
                                 LOAN GROUP ONE
                          FIXED RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
           DISTRIBUTION BY ORIGINAL COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS (1)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
      COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIO               LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
 5.01% to 10.00%                                    4            $      55,932.75            0.12%
10.01% to 15.00%                                   14                  304,716.08            0.67
15.01% to 20.00%                                   23                  773,201.44            1.70
20.01% to 25.00%                                   23                  793,121.76            1.74
25.01% to 30.00%                                   16                  658,013.60            1.44
30.01% to 35.00%                                   25                1,054,594.01            2.31
35.01% to 40.00%                                   37                1,973,821.86            4.33
40.01% to 45.00%                                   31                1,499,068.09            3.29
45.01% to 50.00%                                   38                2,241,473.44            4.92
50.01% to 55.00%                                   33                2,408,904.31            5.28
55.01% to 60.00%                                   51                3,276,456.09            7.19
60.01% to 65.00%                                   39                2,516,056.40            5.52
65.01% to 70.00%                                   64                5,229,174.20           11.47
70.01% to 75.00%                                   59                4,458,887.55            9.78
75.01% to 80.00%                                  231               16,993,353.72           37.27
80.01% to 85.00%                                    7                  196,092.43            0.43
85.01% to 90.00%                                    8                  780,152.39            1.71
90.01% to 95.00%                                    2                   52,710.15            0.12
95.01% to 100.00%                                   9                  326,710.27            0.72
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
- ------------------------------
 
(1) The original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios ('CLTV') shown above are equal,
    with respect to each Home Equity Loan, to (i) the sum of (a) the original
    principal balance of such Home Equity Loan at the date of origination plus
    (b) the remaining balance of the senior lien(s), if any, at the date of
    origination of such Home Equity Loan divided by the value of the related
    Mortgaged Property, based upon the appraisal made at the time of origination
    of such Home Equity Loan. No assurance can be given that the values of such
    Mortgaged Properties have remained or will remain at their levels as of the
    dates of origination of the related Initial Home Equity Loans. If the
    residential real estate market should experience as overall decline in
    property values such that the outstanding balances of such Home Equity Loans
    together with the outstanding balances of the related first liens become
    equal to or greater than the value of the related Mortgaged Properties, the
    actual losses could be higher than those now generally experienced in the
    mortgage lending industry.
 
                         DISTRIBUTION BY LIEN POSITION
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
    LIEN           HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
  POSITION            LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>             <C>                  <C>                  <C>
First Lien             397            $  33,517,274.88           73.51%
Second Lien            317               12,075,165.66           26.49
                       ---           -----------------         -------
     Total             714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                       ---           -----------------         -------
                       ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-3
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-1
                                 LOAN GROUP ONE
                          FIXED RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
               DISTRIBUTION BY LOAN RATES AS OF THE CUT-OFF DATE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
               LOAN RATE                         LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
 7.000% to  7.499%                                  1            $     181,054.98            0.40%
 7.500% to  7.999%                                 17                2,375,164.67            5.21
 8.000% to  8.499%                                 10                1,134,277.51            2.49
 8.500% to  8.999%                                102                8,442,488.65           18.52
 9.000% to  9.499%                                 59                4,042,013.38            8.87
 9.500% to  9.999%                                172               11,598,649.66           25.44
10.000% to 10.499%                                 52                3,287,035.40            7.21
10.500% to 10.999%                                 85                4,860,046.69           10.66
11.000% to 11.499%                                 28                1,223,412.56            2.68
11.500% to 11.999%                                 51                2,754,529.54            6.04
12.000% to 12.499%                                 20                1,079,559.63            2.37
12.500% to 12.999%                                 29                1,110,360.17            2.44
13.000% to 13.499%                                 16                  598,843.01            1.31
13.500% to 13.999%                                 33                1,415,747.13            3.11
14.000% to 14.499%                                  9                  335,473.16            0.74
14.500% to 14.999%                                 16                  401,782.22            0.88
15.000% to 15.499%                                  2                  162,932.27            0.36
15.500% to 15.999%                                  1                   69,000.00            0.15
16.000% to 16.499%                                  1                   90,000.00            0.20
16.500% to 16.999%                                 10                  430,069.91            0.94
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
              DISTRIBUTION BY REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                      NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
 REMAINING MONTHS        HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
TO STATED MATURITY          LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                   <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Up to 120 months             139            $   3,835,864.81            8.41%
121 to 180 months            397               26,740,074.17           58.65
181 to 240 months            145               10,661,824.40           23.39
241 to 360 months             33                4,354,677.16            9.55
                             ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                   714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                             ---           -----------------         -------
                             ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-4
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-1
                                 LOAN GROUP ONE
                          FIXED RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
                      DISTRIBUTION BY MONTHS SINCE FUNDING
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                    NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
  MONTHS SINCE         HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
    FUNDING               LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                 <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Up to 12 months            714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                           ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                 714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                           ---           -----------------         -------
                           ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                   DISTRIBUTION BY TYPE OF MORTGAGED PROPERTY
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
       PROPERTY                  LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- -----------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Single Family Detached            524            $  34,928,940.07           76.61%
Two- to Four-Family                76                5,373,454.65           11.79
Single Family Attached             88                3,795,866.36            8.33
Condominium                        21                1,020,775.15            2.24
Mixed Use                           5                  473,404.31            1.04
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                        714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                       DISTRIBUTION BY OCCUPANCY STATUS*
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
   OCCUPANCY          HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
    STATUS               LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ---------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Owner Occupied            675            $  42,972,977.48           94.25%
Investor Owned             34                2,381,363.06            5.22
Vacation                    1                   77,400.00            0.17
Other                       4                  160,700.00            0.35
                          ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                714            $  45,592,440.54          100.00%
                          ---           -----------------         -------
                          ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
- ------------------------------
 
* Based on representations by the Mortgagors at the time of origination of the
Home Equity Loans.
 
                                      A-5
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-2
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                       ADJUSTABLE RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
                DISTRIBUTION BY CUT-OFF DATE PRINCIPAL BALANCES
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
              CUT-OFF DATE                    HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
           PRINCIPAL BALANCES                    LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Up to $  9,999.99                                   2            $      19,926.75            0.07%
10,000.00 to   19,999.99                           49                  724,575.70            2.40
20,000.00 to   29,999.99                           44                1,121,110.97            3.72
30,000.00 to   39,999.99                           47                1,634,305.06            5.42
40,000.00 to   49,999.99                           44                2,001,426.28            6.64
50,000.00 to   59,999.99                           41                2,239,959.67            7.43
60,000.00 to   69,999.99                           22                1,435,484.52            4.76
70,000.00 to   79,999.99                           23                1,718,225.61            5.70
80,000.00 to   89,999.99                           23                1,952,793.44            6.47
90,000.00 to   99,999.99                           32                3,031,160.09           10.05
100,000.00 to 149,999.99                           62                7,506,973.20           24.89
150,000.00 to 199,999.99                           16                2,798,207.81            9.28
200,000.00 to 299,999.99                           12                2,860,475.86            9.48
300,000.00 to 399,999.99                            2                  699,764.06            2.32
400,000.00 to 499,999.99                            1                  414,676.26            1.37
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                      DISTRIBUTION BY GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION
                          OF THE MORTGAGED PROPERTIES
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                          NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                             HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
 GEOGRAPHIC LOCATION            LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                       <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Connecticut                        7            $     687,264.98            2.28%
District of Columbia               1                   57,538.73            0.19
Delaware                           5                  242,228.71            0.80
Maryland                          26                1,505,577.54            4.99
New Jersey                       171               12,248,533.92           40.61
New York                         118               10,243,978.27           33.97
Pennsylvania                      91                5,145,943.13           17.06
Virginia                           1                   28,000.00            0.09
                                 ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                       420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                 ---           -----------------         -------
                                 ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-6
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-2
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                       ADJUSTABLE RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
           DISTRIBUTION BY ORIGINAL COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIOS (1)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
      COMBINED LOAN-TO-VALUE RATIO               LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
 5.01% to 10.00%                                    3            $      58,922.51            0.20%
10.01% to 15.00%                                    4                  122,372.29            0.41
15.01% to 20.00%                                    5                  154,363.70            0.51
20.01% to 25.00%                                    9                  325,629.05            1.08
25.01% to 30.00%                                    7                  255,194.82            0.85
30.01% to 35.00%                                   15                  675,831.36            2.24
35.01% to 40.00%                                   19                  861,545.90            2.86
40.01% to 45.00%                                   18                1,097,024.34            3.64
45.01% to 50.00%                                   18                  879,908.15            2.92
50.01% to 55.00%                                   17                1,448,565.82            4.80
55.01% to 60.00%                                   30                2,267,892.00            7.52
60.01% to 65.00%                                   24                1,416,180.30            4.70
65.01% to 70.00%                                   30                2,566,429.10            8.51
70.01% to 75.00%                                   44                3,946,257.88           13.08
75.01% to 80.00%                                  177               14,082,948.06           46.70
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
- ------------------------------
(1) The original Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios ('CLTV') shown above are equal,
    with respect to each Home Equity Loan, to (i) the sum of (a) the original
    principal balance of such Home Equity Loan at the date of origination plus
    (b) the remaining balance of the senior lien(s), if any, at the date of
    origination of such Home Equity Loan divided by the value of the related
    Mortgaged Property, based upon the appraisal made at the time of origination
    of such Home Equity Loan. No assurance can be given that the values of such
    Mortgaged Properties have remained or will remain at their levels as of the
    dates of origination of the related Initial Home Equity Loans. If the
    residential real estate market should experience as overall decline in
    property values such that the outstanding balances of such Home Equity Loans
    together with the outstanding balances of the related first liens become
    equal to or greater than the value of the related Mortgaged Properties, the
    actual losses could be higher than those now generally experienced in the
    mortgage lending industry.
 
                         DISTRIBUTION BY LIEN POSITION
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
    LIEN           HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
  POSITION            LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>             <C>                  <C>                  <C>
First Lien             288            $  25,732,713.65           85.32%
Second Lien            132                4,426,351.63           14.68
                       ---           -----------------         -------
     Total             420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                       ---           -----------------         -------
                       ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-7
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-2
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                       ADJUSTABLE RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
               DISTRIBUTION BY LOAN RATES AS OF THE CUT-OFF DATE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
               LOAN RATE                         LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
 7.000% to  7.499%                                 38            $   4,646,401.38           15.41%
 7.500% to  7.999%                                 72                5,966,262.70           19.78
 8.000% to  8.499%                                 37                3,367,435.42           11.17
 8.500% to  8.999%                                 76                5,294,933.95           17.56
 9.000% to  9.499%                                 36                2,231,114.51            7.40
 9.500% to  9.999%                                 91                5,578,916.84           18.50
10.000% to 10.499%                                 35                1,792,811.53            5.94
10.500% to 10.999%                                 33                1,239,588.95            4.11
11.500% to 11.999%                                  2                   41,600.00            0.14
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
              DISTRIBUTION BY REMAINING MONTHS TO STATED MATURITY
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                      NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
 REMAINING MONTHS        HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
TO STATED MATURITY          LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                   <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Up to 120 months               1            $      11,741.98            0.04%
121 to 180 months            222                9,728,263.60           32.26
301 to 360 months            197               20,419,059.70           67.70
                             ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                   420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                             ---           -----------------         -------
                             ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-8
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-2
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                       ADJUSTABLE RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
                      DISTRIBUTION BY MONTHS SINCE FUNDING
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                    NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
     MONTH             HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
 SINCE FUNDING            LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                 <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Up to 12 months            420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                           ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                 420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                           ---           -----------------         -------
                           ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                   DISTRIBUTION BY TYPE OF MORTGAGED PROPERTY
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
     PROPERTY TYPE               LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- -----------------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Single Family Detached            329            $  23,876,175.15           79.17%
Two- to Four-Family                35                3,439,867.33           11.41
Single Family Attached             49                2,359,280.30            7.82
Condominium                         6                  390,142.50            1.29
Mixed Use                           1                   93,600.00            0.31
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                       DISTRIBUTION BY OCCUPANCY STATUS*
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
   OCCUPANCY          HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
    STATUS               LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ---------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                <C>                  <C>                  <C>
Owner Occupied            403            $  29,371,131.23           97.39%
Investor Owned              8                  396,816.56            1.32
Vacation                    4                  144,479.40            0.48
Other                       5                  246,638.09            0.82
                          ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                          ---           -----------------         -------
                          ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
- ------------------------------
*Based on representations by the Mortgagors at the time of origination of the
Home Equity Loans.
 
                                      A-9
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-2
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                       ADJUSTABLE RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
                          DISTRIBUTION BY LIFETIME CAP
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
              LIFETIME CAP                       LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
13.000% to 13.499%                                 38            $   4,646,401.38           15.41%
13.500% to 13.999%                                 72                5,966,262.70           19.78
14.000% to 14.499%                                 37                3,367,435.42           11.17
14.500% to 14.999%                                 76                5,294,933.95           17.56
15.000% to 15.499%                                 36                2,231,114.51            7.40
15.500% to 15.999%                                 91                5,578,916.84           18.50
16.000% to 16.499%                                 35                1,792,811.53            5.94
16.500% to 16.999%                                 33                1,239,588.95            4.11
17.500% to 17.999%                                  2                   41,600.00            0.14
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                         DISTRIBUTION BY LIFETIME FLOOR
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
             LIFETIME FLOOR                      LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
 7.000% to  7.499%                                 38            $   4,646,401.38           15.41%
 7.500% to  7.999%                                 72                5,966,262.70           19.78
 8.000% to  8.499%                                 37                3,367,435.42           11.17
 8.500% to  8.999%                                 76                5,294,933.95           17.56
 9.000% to  9.499%                                 36                2,231,114.51            7.40
 9.500% to  9.999%                                 91                5,578,916.84           18.50
10.000% to 10.499%                                 35                1,792,811.53            5.94
10.500% to 10.999%                                 33                1,239,588.95            4.11
11.500% to 11.999%                                  2                   41,600.00            0.14
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-10
<PAGE>
                                  APPENDIX A-2
                                 LOAN GROUP TWO
                       ADJUSTABLE RATE HOME EQUITY LOANS
                             DISTRIBUTION BY MARGIN
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
                                              HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
                 MARGIN                          LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- ----------------------------------------   -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>                                        <C>                  <C>                  <C>
4.000% to 4.499%                                   88            $   9,808,257.17           32.52%
4.500% to 4.999%                                   15                  757,796.17            2.51
5.000% to 5.499%                                   26                1,086,455.87            3.60
5.500% to 5.999%                                   90                7,437,193.29           24.66
6.000% to 6.499%                                   15                  694,589.85            2.30
6.500% to 6.999%                                  108                7,032,264.78           23.32
7.000% to 7.499%                                   45                2,253,384.62            7.47
7.500% to 7.999%                                   31                1,047,523.53            3.47
8.000% to 8.499%                                    1                   25,200.00            0.08
8.500% to 8.999%                                    1                   16,400.00            0.05
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
     Total                                        420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
                                                  ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                      DISTRIBUTION BY NEXT RATE RESET DATE
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                  NUMBER OF INITIAL      CUT-OFF DATE       % OF CUT-OFF DATE
  NEXT RATE          HOME EQUITY           AGGREGATE            AGGREGATE
  RESET DATE            LOANS          PRINCIPAL BALANCE    PRINCIPAL BALANCE
- --------------    -----------------    -----------------    -----------------
<S>               <C>                  <C>                  <C>
February 1997             49            $   3,484,124.82           11.55%
March 1997               192               14,463,204.15           47.96
April 1997               179               12,211,736.31           40.49
                         ---           -----------------         -------
     Total               420            $  30,159,065.28          100.00%
                         ---           -----------------         -------
                         ---           -----------------         -------
</TABLE>
 
                                      A-11
<PAGE>
                      [This page intentionally left blank]
<PAGE>
PROSPECTUS
 
                           ASSET-BACKED CERTIFICATES
 
                               ASSET-BACKED NOTES
 
                              (ISSUABLE IN SERIES)
 
                   BEAR STEARNS ASSET BACKED SECURITIES, INC.
 
                                  (DEPOSITOR)
 
     Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc. (the 'Depositor') may offer from
time to time under this Prospectus and related Prospectus Supplements the
Asset-Backed Notes (the 'Notes') and the Asset-Backed Certificates (the
'Certificates' and, together with the Notes, the 'Securities') which may be sold
from time to time in one or more series (each, a 'Series').
 
     As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Certificates of a
Series will evidence undivided interests in certain assets deposited into a
trust (each, a 'Trust Fund') by the Depositor pursuant to a Pooling and Service
Agreement or a Trust Agreement, as described herein. As specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Notes of a Series will be issued and secured pursuant
to an Indenture and will represent indebtedness of the related Trust Fund. The
Trust Fund for a Series of Securities will include assets purchased from the
seller or sellers specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (the 'Seller')
composed of (a) Primary Assets, which may include one or more pools of (i)
closed-end home equity loans (the 'Mortgage Loans'), secured by mortgages on
one- to four-family residential or mixed-use properties, (ii) home improvement
installment sales contracts and installment loan agreements (the 'Home
Improvement Contracts') which are either unsecured or secured by mortgages on
one- to four-family residential or mixed-use properties, or by purchase money
security interests in the home improvements financed thereby (the 'Home
Improvements') and (iii) securities backed or secured by Mortgage Loans and/or
Home Improvement Contracts, (b) all monies due thereunder net, if and as
provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, of certain amounts payable to the
servicer of the Mortgage Loans and/or Home Improvement Contracts (collectively,
the 'Loans'), which servicer may also be the Seller, specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement (the 'Servicer'), (c) if specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, funds on deposit in one or more pre-funding amounts
and/or capitalized interest accounts and (d) reserve funds, letters of credit,
surety bonds, insurance policies or other forms of credit support as described
herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement. The amount initially deposited
in a pre-funding account for a Series of Securities will not exceed fifty
percent of the aggregate principal amount of such series of Securities.
                                                  (cover continued on next page)
 
     NOTES OF A GIVEN SERIES REPRESENT OBLIGATIONS OF, AND CERTIFICATES OF A
SERIES EVIDENCE BENEFICIAL INTERESTS IN, THE RELATED TRUST FUND ONLY AND ARE NOT
GUARANTEED BY ANY GOVERNMENTAL AGENCY OR BY THE DEPOSITOR, THE SELLER, THE
TRUSTEE, THE SERVICER OR BY ANY OF THEIR RESPECTIVE AFFILIATES OR, UNLESS
OTHERWISE SPECIFIED IN THE RELATED PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT, BY ANY OTHER PERSON OR
ENTITY. THE DEPOSITOR'S ONLY OBLIGATIONS WITH RESPECT TO ANY SERIES OF
SECURITIES WILL BE PURSUANT TO CERTAIN REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES SET FORTH
IN THE RELATED AGREEMENT AS DESCRIBED HEREIN OR IN THE RELATED PROSPECTUS
SUPPLEMENT.
                            ------------------------
     SEE 'RISK FACTORS' ON PAGE 15 FOR CERTAIN FACTORS TO BE CONSIDERED IN
PURCHASING
THE SECURITIES.
                            ------------------------
 
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES
 AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE
      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
       COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
     PROSPECTUS OR THE PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT. ANY REPRESENTATION
                TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
 
               --------------------------------------------------
 
     Retain this Prospectus for future reference. This Prospectus may not be
used to consummate sales of the Securities offered hereby unless accompanied by
a Prospectus Supplement.
                            ------------------------
 
                            BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.
 
                                  MAY 17, 1996

<PAGE>
(Continued from previous page)
 
     Each Series of Securities will be issued in one or more classes (each, a
'Class'). Interest on and principal of the Securities of a Series will be
payable on each Distribution Date specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, at the times, at the rates, in the amounts and in the order of
priority set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     If a Series includes multiple Classes, such Classes may vary with respect
to the amount, percentage and timing of distributions of principal, interest or
both and one or more Classes may be subordinated to other Classes with respect
to distributions of principal, interest or both as described herein and in the
related Prospectus Supplement. If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Primary Assets and other assets comprising the Trust Fund may be
divided into one or more Asset Groups and each Class of the related Series will
evidence beneficial ownership of the corresponding Asset Group, as applicable.
 
     The rate of reduction of the aggregate principal balance of each Class of a
Series may depend principally upon the rate of payment (including prepayments)
with respect to the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private
Securities, as applicable. A rate of prepayment lower or higher than anticipated
will affect the yield on the Securities of a Series in the manner described
herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement. Under certain limited
circumstances described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement, a
Series of Securities may be subject to termination or redemption under the
circumstances described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, an election may be made
to treat certain assets comprising the Trust Fund for a Series as a 'real estate
mortgage investment conduit' (a 'REMIC') for federal income tax purposes. See
'CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS' herein.
 
                                       2
<PAGE>
                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
 
     The Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities to be offered
hereunder will, among other things, set forth with respect to such Series of
Securities: (i) the aggregate principal amount, interest rate, and authorized
denominations of each Class of such Securities; (ii) certain information
concerning the Primary Assets, the Seller and any Servicer; (iii) the terms of
any Enhancement with respect to such Series; (iv) the terms of any insurance
related to the Primary Assets; (v) information concerning any other assets in
the related Trust Fund, including any Reserve Fund; (vi) the Final Scheduled
Distribution Date of each Class of such Securities; (vii) the method to be used
to calculate the amount of principal required to be applied to the Securities of
each Class of such Series on each Distribution Date, the timing of the
application of principal and the order of priority of the application of such
principal to the respective Classes and the allocation of principal to be so
applied; (viii) the Distribution Dates and any Assumed Reinvestment Rate (as
defined herein); (ix) additional information with respect to the plan of
distribution of such Securities; and (x) whether a REMIC election will be made
with respect to some or all of the Trust Fund for such Series.
 
                               REPORTS TO HOLDERS
 
     Periodic and annual reports concerning the related Trust Fund for a Series
of Securities are required under the related Agreement to be forwarded to
Holders. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, such
reports will not be examined and reported on by an independent public
accountant. If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of
Securities, such Series or one or more Classes of such Series will be issued in
book-entry form. In such event, (i) owners of beneficial interests in such
Securities will not be considered 'Holders' under the Agreements and will not
receive such reports directly from the related Trust Fund; rather, such reports
will be furnished to such owners through the participants and indirect
participants of the applicable book-entry system and (ii) references herein to
the rights of 'Holders' shall refer to the rights of such owners as they may be
exercised indirectly through such participants. See 'THE AGREEMENTS-- Reports to
Holders' herein.
 
                             AVAILABLE INFORMATION
 
     The Depositor has filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission a
Registration Statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, with
respect to the Securities. This Prospectus, which forms a part of the
Registration Statement, and the Prospectus Supplement relating to each Series of
Securities contain summaries of the material terms of the documents referred to
herein and therein, but do not contain all of the information set forth in the
Registration Statement pursuant to the Rules and Regulations of the Commission.
For further information, reference is made to such Registration Statement and
the exhibits thereto. Such Registration Statement and exhibits can be inspected
and copied at prescribed rates at the public reference facilities maintained by
the Commission at its Public Reference Section, 450 Fifth Street, N.W.,
Washington, D.C. 20549, and at its Regional Office located as follows, Midwest
Regional Office, 500 West Madison Street, Chicago, Illinois 60661; and Northeast
Regional Office, Seven World Trade Center, New York, New York 10048.
 
     Each Trust Fund will be required to file certain reports with the
Commission pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934,
as amended. The Depositor intends to cause each Trust Fund to suspend filing
such reports if and when such reports are no longer required under said Act.
 
     No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representation other than those contained in this Prospectus and any Prospectus
Supplement with respect hereto and, if given or made, such information or
representations must not be relied upon. This Prospectus and any Prospectus
Supplement with respect hereto do not constitute an offer to sell or a
solicitation of an offer to buy any securities other than the Securities offered
hereby and thereby nor an offer of the Securities to any person in any state or
other jurisdiction in which such offer would be unlawful. The delivery of this
Prospectus at any time does not imply that information herein is correct as of
any time subsequent to its date.
 
                                       3
<PAGE>
                INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE
 
     All documents subsequently filed by or on behalf of the Trust Fund referred
to in the accompanying Prospectus Supplement with the Commission pursuant to
Section 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended (the 'Exchange Act'), after the date of this Prospectus shall be deemed
to be incorporated by reference into the related Prospectus Supplement and this
Prospectus and to be a part of this Prospectus from the date of the filing of
such documents. Any statement contained in a document incorporated or deemed to
be incorporated by reference in any Prospectus Supplement or in this Prospectus
shall be deemed to be modified or superseded for purposes of such Prospectus
Supplement and this Prospectus to the extent that a statement contained in any
other subsequently filed document which also is or is deemed to be incorporated
by reference modifies or replaces such statement. Any such statement so modified
or superseded shall not be deemed, except as so modified or superseded, to
constitute a part of any Prospectus Supplement or this Prospectus.
 
     The Depositor on behalf of any Trust Fund will provide without charge to
each person to whom this Prospectus is delivered, on the written or oral request
of such person, a copy of any or all of the documents referred to above that
have been or may be incorporated by reference in this Prospectus (not including
exhibits to the information that is incorporated by reference unless such
exhibits are specifically incorporated by reference into the information that
this Prospectus incorporates). Such requests should be directed to the Depositor
at 245 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10167.
 
                                       4
<PAGE>
                                SUMMARY OF TERMS
 
     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the
detailed information appearing elsewhere in this Prospectus and by reference to
the information with respect to each Series of Securities contained in the
Prospectus Supplement to be prepared and delivered in connection with the
offering of Securities of such Series. Capitalized terms used and not otherwise
defined herein or in the related Prospectus Supplement shall have the meanings
set forth in the 'GLOSSARY OF TERMS' herein.
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
Securities Offered........................  Asset-Backed Certificates (the 'Certificates') and Asset-Backed Notes
                                            (the 'Notes'). Certificates are issuable from time to time in Series
                                            pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement.
                                            Each Certificate of a Series will evidence an interest in the Trust
                                            Fund for such Series, or in an Asset Group specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement. Notes are issuable from time to time in Series
                                            pursuant to an Indenture. Each Series of Securities will consist of
                                            one or more Classes, one or more of which may be Classes of Compound
                                            Interest Securities, Planned Amortization Class ('PAC') Securities,
                                            Variable Interest Securities, Zero Coupon Securities, Principal Only
                                            Securities, Interest Only Securities, Participating Securities,
                                            Senior Securities or Subordinate Securities. Each Class may differ
                                            in, among other things, the amounts allocated to and the priority of
                                            principal and interest payments, Final Scheduled Distribution Dates,
                                            Distribution Dates and interest rates. The Securities of each Class
                                            will be issued in fully registered form in the denominations
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. If so specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement, the Securities or certain Classes
                                            of such Securities offered thereby may be available in book-entry
                                            form only.
 
Depositor.................................  Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc. (the 'Depositor') was
                                            incorporated in the State of Delaware in June 1995, and is a wholly-
                                            owned, special purpose subsidiary of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc.
                                            None of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc. nor any other affiliate of
                                            the Depositor, the Servicer, the Trustee or the Seller has guaranteed
                                            or is otherwise obligated with respect to the Securities of any
                                            Series. See 'THE DEPOSITOR.'
 
Interest Payments.........................  Interest payments on the Securities of a Series entitled by their
                                            terms to receive interest will be made on each Distribution Date, to
                                            the extent set forth in, and at the applicable rate specified in (or
                                            determined in the manner set forth in), the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. The interest rate on Securities of a Series may be
                                            variable or change with changes in the rates of interest on the
                                            related Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities,
                                            as applicable and/or as prepayments occur with respect to such Loans
                                            or Underlying Loans, as applicable. Interest Only Securities may be
                                            assigned a 'Notional Amount' set forth in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement which is used solely for convenience in expressing the
                                            calculation of interest and for certain other purposes and does not
                                            represent the right to receive any distributions allocable to
                                            principal. Principal Only Securities may not be entitled to receive
                                            any interest payments or may be entitled to receive only nominal
                                            interest payments. Interest payable on the Securities of a Series on
                                            a Distribution Date will include all interest accrued during the
                                            period
</TABLE>
 
                                       5
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. See 'DESCRIPTION OF
                                            THE SECURITIES--Payments of Interest.'
 
Principal Payments........................  All payments of principal of a Series of Securities will be made in
                                            an aggregate amount determined as set forth in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement and will be paid at the times and will be allocated among
                                            the Classes of such Series in the order and amounts, and will be
                                            applied either on a pro rata or a random lot basis among all
                                            Securities of any such Class, all as specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement.
 
Final Scheduled Distribution Date of the
  Securities..............................  The Final Scheduled Distribution Date with respect to each Class of
                                            Notes is the date no later than which principal thereof will be fully
                                            paid and with respect to each Class of Certificates is the date after
                                            which no Certificates of such Class are expected to remain
                                            outstanding, in each case calculated on the basis of the assumptions
                                            applicable to such Series described in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. The Final Scheduled Distribution Date of a Class may
                                            equal the maturity date of the Primary Asset in the related Trust
                                            Fund which has the latest stated maturity or will be determined as
                                            described herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                            The actual final Distribution Date of the Securities of a Series will
                                            depend primarily upon the rate of payment (including prepayments,
                                            liquidations due to default, the receipt of proceeds from casualty
                                            insurance policies and repurchases) of the Loans or Underlying Loans
                                            relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, in the related
                                            Trust Fund. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement, the actual final Distribution Date of any Security is
                                            likely to occur earlier and may occur substantially earlier or may
                                            occur later than its Final Scheduled Distribution Date as a result of
                                            the application of prepayments to the reduction of the principal
                                            balances of the Securities and as a result of defaults on the Primary
                                            Assets. The rate of payments on the Loans or Underlying Loans
                                            relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, in the Trust Fund
                                            for a Series will depend on a variety of factors, including certain
                                            characteristics of such Loans or Underlying Loans, as applicable, and
                                            the prevailing level of interest rates from time to time, as well as
                                            on a variety of economic, demographic, tax, legal, social and other
                                            factors. No assurance can be given as to the actual prepayment
                                            experience with respect to a Series. See 'RISK FACTORS--Yield May
                                            Vary' and 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES-- Weighted Average Life of
                                            the Securities' herein.
 
Optional Termination......................  One or more Classes of Securities of any Series may be redeemed or
                                            repurchased in whole or in part, at the Depositor's or the Servicer's
                                            option, at such time and under the circumstances specified in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement, at the price set forth therein. If so
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series of
                                            Securities, the Depositor, the Servicer, or such other entity that is
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, may, at its option,
                                            cause an early termination of the related Trust Fund by repurchasing
                                            all of the Primary Assets remaining in the Trust Fund on or after a
                                            specified date, or on or after such time as the aggregate principal
                                            balance of the Securities of the Series or the Primary Assets
                                            relating
</TABLE>
 
                                       6
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            to such Series, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, is
                                            less than the amount or percentage specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES--Optional
                                            Redemption, Purchase or Termination.'
 
                                            In addition, the Prospectus Supplement may provide other
                                            circumstances under which Holders of Securities of a Series could be
                                            fully paid significantly earlier than would otherwise be the case if
                                            payments or distributions were solely based on the activity of the
                                            related Primary Assets.
 
The Trust Fund............................  The Trust Fund for a Series of Securities will consist of one or more
                                            of the assets described below, as described in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement.
 
  A. Primary Assets.......................  The Primary Assets for a Series may consist of any combination of the
                                            following assets, to the extent and as specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement. The Primary Assets will be purchased from the
                                            Seller or may be purchased by the Depositor in the open market or in
                                            privately negotiated transactions, including transactions with
                                            entities affiliated with the Depositor.
 
     (1) Loans............................  Primary Assets for a Series will consist, in whole or in part, of
                                            Loans. Some Loans may be delinquent or non-performing as specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement. Loans may be originated by or
                                            acquired from an affiliate of the Depositor and an affiliate of the
                                            Depositor may be an obligor with respect to any such Loan. The Loans
                                            will be conventional contracts or contracts insured by the Federal
                                            Housing Administration ('FHA') or partially guaranteed by the
                                            Veterans Administration ('VA'). See 'The Trust Funds--The Loans' for
                                            a discussion of such guarantees. To the extent provided in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement, additional Loans may be periodically
                                            added to the Trust Fund, or may be removed from time to time if
                                            certain asset value tests are met, as described in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                            The 'Loans' for a Series will consist of (i) closed-end home equity
                                            loans (the 'Mortgage Loans') and (ii) home improvement installment
                                            sales contracts and installment loan agreements (the 'Home
                                            Improvement Contracts'). The Mortgage Loans and the Home Improvement
                                            Contracts are collectively referred to herein as the 'Loans.' Loans
                                            may, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, have various
                                            payment characteristics, including balloon or other irregular payment
                                            features, and may accrue interest at a fixed rate or an adjustable
                                            rate.As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Mortgage
                                            Loans will and the Home Improvement Contracts may be secured by
                                            mortgages and deeds of trust or other similar security instruments
                                            creating a lien on a Mortgaged Property, which may be subordinated to
                                            one or more senior liens on the Mortgaged Property, as described in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement. As specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement, Home Improvement Contracts may be unsecured or
                                            secured by purchase money security interests in the Home Improvements
                                            financed thereby. The Mortgaged Properties and the Home Improvements
                                            are collectively referred to herein as the 'Properties.'
</TABLE>
 
                                       7
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            The related Prospectus Supplement will describe certain
                                            characteristics of the Loans for a Series, including, without
                                            limitation, and to the extent relevant: (a) the aggregate unpaid
                                            principal balance of the Loans (or the aggregate unpaid principal
                                            balance included in the Trust Fund for the related Series); (b) the
                                            range and weighted average Loan Rate on the Loans and in the case of
                                            adjustable rate Loans, the range and weighted average of the Current
                                            Loan Rates and the Lifetime Rate Caps, if any; (c) the range and the
                                            average outstanding principal balance of the Loans; (d) the weighted
                                            average original and remaining term-to-stated maturity of the Loans
                                            and the range of original and remaining terms-to-stated maturity, if
                                            applicable; (e) the range and Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios or
                                            Loan-to-Value Ratios, as applicable, of the Loans, computed in the
                                            manner described in the related Prospectus Supplement; (f) the
                                            percentage (by principal balance as of the Cut-off Date) of Loans
                                            that accrue interest at adjustable or fixed interest rates; (g) any
                                            enhancement relating to the Loans; (h) the percentage (by principal
                                            balance as of the Cut-off Date) of Loans that are secured by
                                            Mortgaged Properties, Home Improvements or are unsecured; (i) the
                                            geographic distribution of any Mortgaged Properties securing the
                                            Loans; (j) the use and type of each Mortgaged Property securing a
                                            Loan; (k) the lien priority of the Loans; and (l) the delinquency
                                            status and year of origination of the Loans.
 
     (2) Private Securities...............  Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in whole or in part, of
                                            Private Securities which include (a) pass-through certificates
                                            representing beneficial interests in loans of the type that would
                                            otherwise be eligible to be Loans (the 'Underlying Loans') or (b)
                                            collateralized obligations secured by Underlying Loans. Such
                                            pass-through certificates or collateralized obligations will have
                                            previously been (a) offered and distributed to the public pursuant to
                                            an effective registration statement or (b) purchased in a transaction
                                            not involving any public offering from a person who is not an
                                            affiliate of the issuer of such securities at the time of sale (nor
                                            an affiliate thereof at any time during the three preceding months);
                                            provided a period of three years has elapsed since the later of the
                                            date the securities were acquired from the issuer or an affiliate
                                            thereof. Although individual Underlying Loans may be insured or
                                            guaranteed by the United States or an agency or instrumentality
                                            thereof, they need not be, and the Private Securities themselves will
                                            not be so insured or guaranteed. See 'THE TRUST FUNDS-- Private
                                            Securities.' Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement
                                            relating to a Series of Securities, payments on the Private
                                            Securities will be distributed directly to the Trustee as registered
                                            owner of such Private Securities.
 
                                            The related Prospectus Supplement for a Series will specify (such
                                            disclosure may be on an approximate basis, as described above and
                                            will be as of the date specified in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement) to the extent relevant and to the extent such information
                                            is reasonably available to the Depositor and the Depositor reasonably
                                            believes such information to be reliable: (i) the aggregate
                                            approximate principal amount and type of any Private Securities to be
                                            included in the Trust Fund for such Series; (ii) certain
</TABLE>
 
                                       8
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            characteristics of the Underlying Loans including (A) the payment
                                            features of such Underlying Loans (i.e., whether they are fixed rate
                                            or adjustable rate and whether they provide for fixed level payments,
                                            negative amortization or other payment features), (B) the approximate
                                            aggregate principal amount of such Underlying Loans which are insured
                                            or guaranteed by a governmental entity, (C) the servicing fee or
                                            range of servicing fees with respect to such Underlying Loans, (D)
                                            the minimum and maximum stated maturities of such Underlying Loans at
                                            origination, (E) the lien priority of such Underlying Loans, and (F)
                                            the delinquency status and year of origination of such Underlying
                                            Loans; (iii) the maximum original term-to-stated maturity of the
                                            Private Securities; (iv) the weighted average term-to-stated maturity
                                            of the Private Securities; (v) the pass-through or certificate rate
                                            or ranges thereof for the Private Securities; (vi) the sponsor or
                                            depositor of the Private Securities (the 'PS Sponsor'), the servicer
                                            of the Private Securities (the 'PS Servicer') and the trustee of the
                                            Private Securities (the 'PS Trustee'); (vii) certain characteristics
                                            of enhancement, if any, such as reserve funds, insurance policies,
                                            letters of credit or guarantees, relating to the Loans underlying the
                                            Private Securities, or to such Private Securities themselves; (viii)
                                            the terms on which the Underlying Loans may, or are required to, be
                                            repurchased prior to stated maturity; and (ix) the terms on which
                                            substitute Underlying Loans may be delivered to replace those
                                            initially deposited with the PS Trustee. See 'THE TRUST
                                            FUNDS--Additional Information' herein.
 
  B. Collection and Distribution
     Accounts.............................  Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, all
                                            payments on or with respect to the Primary Assets for a Series will
                                            be remitted directly to an account (the 'Collection Account') to be
                                            established for such Series with the Trustee or the Servicer, in the
                                            name of the Trustee. Unless otherwise provided in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee shall be required to apply a
                                            portion of the amount in the Collection Account, together with
                                            reinvestment earnings from eligible investments specified in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement, to the payment of certain amounts
                                            payable to the Servicer under the related Agreement and any other
                                            person specified in the Prospectus Supplement, and to deposit a
                                            portion of the amount in the Collection Account into a separate
                                            account (the 'Distribution Account') to be established for such
                                            Series, each in the manner and at the times established in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement. All amounts deposited in such
                                            Distribution Account will be available, unless otherwise specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement, for (i) application to the payment
                                            of principal of and interest on such Series of Securities on the next
                                            Distribution Date, (ii) the making of adequate provision for future
                                            payments on certain Classes of Securities and (iii) any other purpose
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. After applying the
                                            funds in the Collection Account as described above, any funds
                                            remaining in the Collection Account may be paid over to the Servicer,
                                            the Depositor, any provider of Enhancement with respect to such
                                            Series (an 'Enhancer') or any other person entitled thereto
</TABLE>
 
                                       9
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            in the manner and at the times established in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement.
 
  C. Pre-Funding and Capitalized Interest
     Accounts.............................  If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund will
                                            include one or more segregated trust accounts (each, a 'Pre-Funding
                                            Account') established and maintained with the Trustee for the related
                                            Series. If so specified, on the closing date for such Series, a
                                            portion of the proceeds of the sale of the Securities of such Series
                                            (such amount, the 'Pre-Funded Amount') will be deposited in the
                                            Pre-Funding Account and may be used to purchase additional Primary
                                            Assets during the period of time, not to exceed six months, specified
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement (the 'Pre-Funding Period'). The
                                            Primary Assets to be so purchased will be required to have certain
                                            characteristics specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. If
                                            any Pre-Funded Amount remains on deposit in the Pre-Funding Account
                                            at the end of the Pre-Funding Period, such amount will be applied in
                                            the manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement to prepay
                                            the Notes and/or the Certificates of the applicable Series. The
                                            amount initially deposited in a pre-funding account for a Series of
                                            Securities will not exceed fifty percent of the aggregate principal
                                            amount of such Series of Securities.
 
                                            If a Pre-Funding Account is established, one or more segregated trust
                                            accounts (each, a 'Capitalized Interest Account') may be established
                                            and maintained with the Trustee for the related Series. On the
                                            closing date for such Series, a portion of the proceeds of the sale
                                            of the Securities of such Series will be deposited in the Capitalized
                                            Interest Account and used to fund the excess, if any, of (x) the sum
                                            of (i) the amount of interest accrued on the Securities of such
                                            Series and (ii) if specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            certain fees or expenses during the Pre-Funding Period such as
                                            trustee fees and credit enhancement fees, over (y) the amount of
                                            interest available therefor from the Primary Assets in the Trust
                                            Fund. Any amounts on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account at
                                            the end of the Pre-Funding Period that are not necessary for such
                                            purposes will be distributed to the person specified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement.
 
Enhancement...............................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series, the
                                            Depositor will obtain an irrevocable letter of credit, surety bond,
                                            certificate insurance policy, insurance policy or other form of
                                            credit support (collectively, 'Enhancement') in favor of the Trustee
                                            on behalf of the Holders of such Series and any other person
                                            specified in such Prospectus Supplement from an institution
                                            acceptable to the rating agency or agencies identified in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement as rating such Series of Securities
                                            (collectively, the 'Rating Agency') for the purposes specified in
                                            such Prospectus Supplement. The Enhancement will support the payments
                                            on the Securities and may be used for other purposes, to the extent
                                            and under the conditions specified in such Prospectus Supplement. See
                                            'ENHANCEMENT.'
</TABLE>
 
                                       10
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            Enhancement for a Series may include one or more of the following
                                            types of Enhancement, or such other type of Enhancement specified in
                                            the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
  A. Subordinate Securities...............  If stated in the related Prospectus Supplement, Enhancement for a
                                            Series may consist of one or more Classes of Subordinate Securities.
                                            The rights of Holders of such Subordinate Securities to receive
                                            distributions on any Distribution Date will be subordinate in right
                                            and priority to the rights of holders of Senior Securities of the
                                            Series, but only to the extent described in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement.
 
  B. Insurance............................  If stated in the related Prospectus Supplement, Enhancement for a
                                            Series may consist of special hazard insurance policies, bankruptcy
                                            bonds and other types of insurance supporting payments on the
                                            Securities.
 
  C. Reserve Funds........................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor may deposit
                                            cash, a letter or letters of credit, short-term investments, or other
                                            instruments acceptable to the Rating Agency in one or more reserve
                                            funds to be established in the name of the Trustee (each a 'Reserve
                                            Fund'), which will be used, as specified in such Prospectus
                                            Supplement, by the Trustee to make required payments of principal of
                                            or interest on the Securities of such Series, to make adequate
                                            provision for future payments on such Securities or for any other
                                            purpose specified in the Agreement, with respect to such Series, to
                                            the extent that funds are not otherwise available. In the alternative
                                            or in addition to such deposit, a Reserve Fund for a Series may be
                                            funded through application of all or a portion of the excess cash
                                            flow from the Primary Assets for such Series, to the extent described
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
  D. Minimum Principal Payment
     Agreement............................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of
                                            Securities, the Depositor will enter into a minimum principal payment
                                            agreement (the 'Minimum Principal Payment Agreement') with an entity
                                            meeting the criteria of the Rating Agency, pursuant to which such
                                            entity will provide funds in the event that aggregate principal
                                            payments on the Primary Assets for such Series are not sufficient to
                                            make certain payments, as provided in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement. See 'ENHANCEMENT-- Minimum Principal Payment Agreement.'
 
  E. Deposit Agreement....................  If stated in the Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor and the Trustee
                                            will enter into a guaranteed investment contract or an investment
                                            agreement (the 'Deposit Agreement') pursuant to which all or a
                                            portion of amounts held in the Collection Account, the Distribution
                                            Account or in any Reserve Fund will be invested with the entity
                                            specified in such Prospectus Supplement. The Trustee will be entitled
                                            to withdraw amounts so invested, plus interest at a rate equal to the
                                            Assumed Reinvestment Rate, in the manner specified in the Prospectus
                                            Supplement. See 'ENHANCEMENT--Deposit Agreement.'
 
Servicing.................................  The Servicer will be responsible for servicing, managing and making
                                            collections on the Loans for a Series. In addition, the Servicer, if
                                            so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, will
</TABLE>
 
                                       11
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            act as custodian and will be responsible for maintaining custody of
                                            the Loans and related documentation on behalf of the Trustee.
                                            Advances with respect to delinquent payments of principal or interest
                                            on a Loan will be made by the Servicer only to the extent described
                                            in the related Prospectus Supplement. Such advances will be intended
                                            to provide liquidity only and, unless otherwise specified in the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement, reimbursable to the Servicer from
                                            scheduled payments of principal and interest, late collections, or
                                            from the proceeds of liquidation of the related Loans or from other
                                            recoveries relating to such Loans (including any insurance proceeds
                                            or payments from other credit support). In performing these
                                            functions, the Servicer will exercise the same degree of skill and
                                            care that it customarily exercises with respect to similar
                                            receivables or Loans owned or serviced by it. Under certain limited
                                            circumstances, the Servicer may resign or be removed, in which event
                                            either the Trustee or a third-party servicer will be appointed as
                                            successor servicer. The Servicer will receive a periodic fee as
                                            servicing compensation (the 'Servicing Fee') and may, as specified
                                            herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement, receive certain
                                            additional compensation. See 'SERVICING OF LOANS-- Servicing
                                            Compensation and Payment of Expenses' herein.
 
Federal Income Tax Considerations
 
  A. Debt Securities and REMIC Residual
     Securities...........................  If (i) an election is made to treat all or a portion of a Trust Fund
                                            for a Series as a 'real estate mortgage investment conduit' (a
                                            'REMIC') or (ii) so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, a
                                            Series of Securities will include one or more Classes of taxable debt
                                            obligations under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the
                                            'Code'). Stated interest with respect to such Classes of Securities
                                            will be reported by a Holder in accordance with the Holder's method
                                            of accounting except that, in the case of Securities constituting
                                            'regular interests' in a REMIC ('Regular Interests'), such interest
                                            will be required to be reported on the accrual method regardless of a
                                            Holder's usual method of accounting. Securities that are Compound
                                            Interest Securities, Zero Coupon Securities or Interest Only
                                            Securities will, and certain other Classes of Securities may, be
                                            issued with original issue discount that is not de minimis. In such
                                            cases, the Holder will be required to include original issue discount
                                            in gross income as it accrues, which may be prior to the receipt of
                                            cash attributable to such income. If a Security is issued at a
                                            premium, the Holder may be entitled to make an election to amortize
                                            such premium on a constant yield method.
 
                                            In the case of a REMIC election, a Class of Securities may be treated
                                            as REMIC 'residual interests' ('Residual Interest'). A Holder of a
                                            Residual Interest will be required to include in its income its pro
                                            rata share of the taxable income of the REMIC. In certain
                                            circumstances, the Holder of a Residual Interest may have REMIC
                                            taxable income or tax liability attributable to REMIC taxable income
                                            for a particular period in excess of cash distributions for such
                                            period or have an after-tax return that is less than the after-tax
                                            return on comparable debt instruments. In addition, a portion (or, in
                                            some cases, all) of the income from a Residual Interest (i) except
</TABLE>
 
                                       12
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
                                            in certain circumstances with respect to a Holder classified as a
                                            thrift institution under the Code, may not be subject to offset by
                                            losses from other activities or investments, (ii) for a Holder that
                                            is subject to tax under the Code on unrelated business taxable
                                            income, may be treated as unrelated business taxable income and (iii)
                                            for a foreign holder, may not qualify for exemption from or reduction
                                            of withholding. In addition, (i) Residual Interests are subject to
                                            transfer restrictions and (ii) certain transfers of Residual
                                            Interests will not be recognized for federal income tax purposes.
                                            Further, individual holders are subject to limitations on the
                                            deductibility of expenses of the REMIC. See 'CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME
                                            TAX CONSIDERATIONS.'
 
  B. Non-REMIC Pass-Through Securities....  If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trust Fund
                                            for a Series will be treated as a grantor trust and will not be
                                            classified as an association taxable as a corporation for federal
                                            income tax purposes and Holders of Securities of such Series
                                            ('Pass-Through Securities') will be treated as owning directly rights
                                            to receive certain payments of interest or principal, or both on the
                                            Primary Assets held in the Trust Fund for such Series. All income
                                            with respect to a Stripped Security (as defined herein) will be
                                            accounted for as original issue discount and, unless otherwise
                                            specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, will be reported by
                                            the Trustee on an accrual basis, which may be prior to the receipt of
                                            cash associated with such income.
 
  C. Owner Trust Securities...............  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the Trust Fund will be
                                            treated as a partnership for purposes of federal and state income
                                            tax. Each Noteholder, by the acceptance of a Note of a given Series,
                                            will agree to treat such Note as indebtedness, and each
                                            Certificateholder, by the acceptance of a Certificate of a given
                                            Series, will agree to treat the related Trust as a partnership in
                                            which such Certificateholder is a partner for federal income and
                                            state tax purposes. Alternative characterizations of such Trust and
                                            such Certificates are possible, but would not result in materially
                                            adverse tax consequences to Certificateholders. See 'CERTAIN FEDERAL
                                            INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS.'
 
ERISA Considerations......................  A fiduciary of any employee benefit plan subject to the Employee
                                            Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ('ERISA'), or the
                                            Code should carefully review with its own legal advisors whether the
                                            purchase or holding of Securities could give rise to a transaction
                                            prohibited or otherwise impermissible under ERISA or the Code. See
                                            'ERISA CONSIDERATIONS.'
 
Legal Investment..........................  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
                                            Securities of each Series offered by this Prospectus and the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement will not constitute 'mortgage related
                                            securities' under the Secondary Mortgage Market Enhancement Act of
                                            1984 ('SMMEA'). Investors whose investment authority is subject to
                                            legal restrictions should consult their own legal advisors to
                                            determine whether and to what extent the Securities constitute legal
                                            investments for them. See 'LEGAL INVESTMENT.'
</TABLE>
 
                                       13
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                         <C>
Use of Proceeds...........................  The Depositor will use the net proceeds from the sale of each Series
                                            for one or more of the following purposes: (i) to purchase the
                                            related Primary Assets, (ii) to repay indebtedness which has been
                                            incurred to obtain funds to acquire such Primary Assets, (iii) to
                                            establish any Reserve Funds described in the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement and (iv) to pay costs of structuring and issuing such
                                            Securities, including the costs of obtaining Enhancement, if any. If
                                            so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the purchase of
                                            the Primary Assets for a Series will be effected by an exchange of
                                            Securities with the Seller of such Primary Assets. See 'USE OF
                                            PROCEEDS.'
 
Ratings...................................  It will be a requirement for issuance of any Series that the
                                            Securities offered by this Prospectus and the related Prospectus
                                            Supplement be rated by at least one Rating Agency in one of its four
                                            highest applicable rating categories. The rating or ratings
                                            applicable to Securities of each Series offered hereby and by the
                                            related Prospectus Supplement will be as set forth in the related
                                            Prospectus Supplement. A securities rating should be evaluated
                                            independently of similar ratings on different types of securities. A
                                            securities rating is not a recommendation to buy, hold or sell
                                            securities and does not address the effect that the rate of
                                            prepayments on Loans or Underlying Loans relating to Private
                                            Securities, as applicable, for a Series may have on the yield to
                                            investors in the Securities of such Series. See 'RISK
                                            FACTORS--Ratings Are Not Recommendations.'
</TABLE>
 
                                       14
<PAGE>
                                  RISK FACTORS
 
     Investors should consider, among other things, the following factors in
connection with the purchase of the Securities.
 
NO SECONDARY MARKET
 
     There will be no market for the Securities of any Series prior to the
issuance thereof, and there can be no assurance that a secondary market will
develop or, if it does develop, that it will provide Holders with liquidity of
investment or will continue for the life of the Securities of such Series. The
Underwriter(s) specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, expects to make a
secondary market in the Securities, but has no obligation to do so.
 
PRIMARY ASSETS ARE ONLY SOURCE OF REPAYMENT
 
     The Depositor does not have, nor is it expected to have, any significant
assets. The Securities of a Series will be payable solely from the assets of the
Trust Fund for such Securities. There will be no recourse to the Depositor or
any other person for any default on the Notes or any failure to receive
distributions on the Certificates. Further, unless otherwise stated in the
related Prospectus Supplement, at the times set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement, certain Primary Assets and/or any balance remaining in the
Collection Account or Distribution Account immediately after making all payments
due on the Securities of such Series and other payments specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, may be promptly released or remitted to the Depositor,
the Servicer, the Enhancer or any other person entitled thereto and will no
longer be available for making payments to Holders. Consequently, Holders of
Securities of each Series must rely solely upon payments with respect to the
Primary Assets and the other assets constituting the Trust Fund for a Series of
Securities, including, if applicable, any amounts available pursuant to any
Enhancement for such Series, for the payment of principal of and interest on the
Securities of such Series.
 
     Holders of Notes will be required under the Indenture to proceed only
against the Primary Assets and other assets constituting the related Trust Fund
in the case of a default with respect to such Notes and may not proceed against
any assets of the Depositor. There is no assurance that the market value of the
Primary Assets or any other assets for a Series will at any time be equal to or
greater than the aggregate principal amount of the Securities of such Series
then outstanding, plus accrued interest thereon. Moreover, upon an event of
default under the Indenture for a Series of Notes and a sale of the assets in
the Trust Fund or upon a sale of the assets of a Trust Fund for a Series of
Certificates, the Trustee, the Servicer, if any, the Enhancer and any other
service provider specified in the related Prospectus Supplement generally will
be entitled to receive the proceeds of any such sale to the extent of unpaid
fees and other amounts owing to such persons under the related Agreement prior
to distributions to Holders of Securities. Upon any such sale, the proceeds
thereof may be insufficient to pay in full the principal of and interest on the
Securities of such Series.
 
     The only obligations, if any, of the Depositor with respect to the
Securities of any Series will be pursuant to certain representations and
warranties. See 'THE AGREEMENTS--Assignment of Primary Assets' herein. The
Depositor does not have, and is not expected in the future to have, any
significant assets with which to meet any obligation to repurchase Primary
Assets with respect to which there has been a breach of any representation or
warranty. If, for example, the Depositor were required to repurchase a Primary
Asset, its only sources of funds to make such repurchase would be from funds
obtained from the enforcement of a corresponding obligation, if any, on the part
of the originator of the Primary Assets, the Servicer or the Seller, as the case
may be, or from a Reserve Fund established to provide funds for such
repurchases.
 
LIMITED PROTECTION AGAINST LOSSES
 
     Although any Enhancement is intended to reduce the risk of delinquent
payments or losses to holders of Securities entitled to the benefit thereof, the
amount of such Enhancement will be limited, as set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement, and will decline and could be depleted under certain
circumstances prior to the payment in full of the related Series of Securities,
and as a result Holders may suffer losses. See 'ENHANCEMENT.'
 
                                       15
<PAGE>
YIELD MAY VARY
 
     The yield to maturity experienced by a Holder of Securities may be affected
by the rate of payment of principal of the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to
the Private Securities, as applicable. The timing of principal payments of the
Securities of a Series will be affected by a number of factors, including the
following: (i) the extent of prepayments of the Loans or Underlying Loans
relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, which prepayments may be
influenced by a variety of factors; (ii) the manner of allocating principal
payments among the Classes of Securities of a Series as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement; and (iii) the exercise by the party entitled thereto of
any right of optional termination. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES--Weighted
Average Life of Securities.' Prepayments may also result from repurchases of
Loans or Underlying Loans, as applicable, due to material breaches of the
Seller's or the Depositor's warranties.
 
     Interest payable on the Securities of a Series on a Distribution Date will
include all interest accrued during the period specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. In the event interest accrues during the calendar month
prior to a Distribution Date, the effective yield to Holders will be reduced
from the yield that would otherwise be obtainable if interest payable on the
Security were to accrue through the day immediately preceding each Distribution
Date, and the effective yield (at par) to Holders will be less than the
indicated coupon rate. See 'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES--Payments of
Interest.'
 
PROPERTY VALUES MAY BE INSUFFICIENT
 
     If the Mortgages in a Trust Fund are primarily junior liens subordinate to
the rights of the mortgagee under the related senior mortgage or mortgages, the
proceeds from any liquidation, insurance or condemnation proceedings will be
available to satisfy the outstanding balance of such junior mortgage only to the
extent that the claims of such senior mortgagees have been satisfied in full,
including any related foreclosure costs. In addition, a junior mortgagee may not
foreclose on the Property securing a junior mortgage unless it forecloses
subject to the senior mortgages, in which case it must either pay the entire
amount due on the senior mortgages to the senior mortgagees at or prior to the
foreclosure sale or undertake the obligation to make payments on the senior
mortgages in the event the mortgagor is in default thereunder. The Trust Fund
will not have any source of funds to satisfy the senior mortgages or make
payments due to the senior mortgagees.
 
     There are several factors that could adversely affect the value of
Properties such that the outstanding balance of the related Loan, together with
any senior financing on the Properties, would equal or exceed the value of the
Properties. Among the factors that could adversely affect the value of the
Properties are an overall decline in the residential real estate market in the
areas in which the Properties are located or a decline in the general condition
of the Properties as a result of failure of borrowers to maintain adequately the
Properties or of natural disasters that are not necessarily covered by
insurance, such as earthquakes and floods. Any such decline could extinguish the
value of a junior interest in a Property before having any effect on the related
senior interest therein. If such a decline occurs, the actual rates of
delinquencies, foreclosure and losses on the junior Loans could be higher than
those currently experienced in the mortgage lending industry in general.
 
PRE-FUNDING MAY ADVERSELY AFFECT INVESTMENT
 
     If a Trust Fund includes a Pre-Funding Account and the principal balance of
additional Loans delivered to the Trust Fund during the Pre-Funding Period is
less than the original Pre-Funded Amount, the Holders of the Securities of the
related Series will receive a prepayment of principal as and to the extent
described in the related Prospectus Supplement. Any such principal prepayment
may adversely affect the yield to maturity of the applicable Securities. Since
prevailing interest rates are subject to fluctuation, there can be no issuance
that investors will be able to reinvest such a prepayment at yields equaling or
exceeding the yields on the related Securities. It is possible that the yield on
any such reinvestment will be lower, and may be significantly lower, than the
yield on the related Securities.
 
     The ability of a Trust Fund to invest in subsequent Loans during the
related Pre-Funding Period will be dependant on the ability of the Seller to
originate or acquire Loans that satisfy the requirements for transfer to the
Trust Fund. The ability of the Seller to originate or acquire such Loans will be
affected by a variety of social and economic factors, including the prevailing
level of market interest rates, unemployment levels and consumer perceptions of
general economic conditions.
 
                                       16
<PAGE>
     Although subsequent Loans must satisfy the characteristics described in the
related Prospectus Supplement, such Loans may have been originated more recently
than the Loans originally transferred to the Trust Fund and may be of a lesser
credit quality. As a result, the addition of subsequent Loans may adversely
affect the performance of the related Securities.
 
POTENTIAL LIABILITY FOR ENVIRONMENTAL CONDITIONS
 
     Real property pledged as security to a lender may be subject to certain
environmental risks. Under the laws of certain states, contamination of a
property may give rise to a lien on the property to assure the costs of clean-
up. In several states, such a lien has priority over the lien of an existing
mortgage or owner's interest against such property. In addition, under the laws
of some states and under the federal Comprehensive Environmental Response,
Compensation, and Liability Act of 1980 ('CERCLA'), a lender may be liable, as
an 'owner' or 'operator,' for costs of addressing releases or threatened
releases of hazardous substances that require remedy at a property, if agents or
employees of the lender have become sufficiently involved in the operations of
the borrower, regardless of whether or not the environmental damage or threat
was caused by a prior owner. A lender also risks such liability on foreclosure
of the Mortgaged Property.
 
CONSUMER PROTECTION LAWS MAY AFFECT LOANS
 
     Applicable state laws generally regulate interest rates and other charges
and require certain disclosures. In addition, other state laws, public policy
and general principles of equity relating to the protection of consumers, unfair
and deceptive practices and debt collection practices may apply to the
origination, servicing and collection of the Loans. Depending on the provisions
of the applicable law and the specific facts and circumstances involved,
violations of these laws, policies and principles may limit the ability of the
Servicer to collect all or part of the principal of or interest on the Loans,
may entitle the borrower to a refund of amounts previously paid and, in
addition, could subject the owner of the Loan to damages and administrative
enforcement.
 
     The Loans are also subject to Federal laws, including:
 
      (i) the Federal Truth in Lending Act and Regulation Z promulgated
          thereunder, which require certain disclosures to the borrowers
          regarding the terms of the Loans;
 
      (ii) the Equal Credit Opportunity Act and Regulation B promulgated
           thereunder, which prohibit discrimination on the basis of age, race,
           color, sex, religion, marital status, national origin, receipt of
           public assistance or the exercise of any right under the Consumer
           Credit Protection Act, in the extension of credit; and
 
     (iii) the Fair Credit Reporting Act, which regulates the use and reporting
           of information related to the borrower's credit experience.
 
     The Home Improvement Contracts are also subject to the Preservation of
Consumers' Claims and Defenses regulations of the Federal Trade Commission and
other similar federal and state statutes and regulations (collectively, the
'Holder in Due Course Rules'), which protect the homeowner from defective
craftsmanship or incomplete work by a contractor. These laws permit the obligor
to withhold payment if the work does not meet the quality and durability
standards agreed to by the homeowner and the contractor. The Holder in Due
Course Rules have the effect of subjecting any assignee of the seller in a
consumer credit transaction to all claims and defenses which the obligor in the
credit sale transaction could assert against the seller of the goods.
 
     Violations of certain provisions of these Federal laws may limit the
ability of the Servicer to collect all or part of the principal of or interest
on the Loans and in addition could subject the Trust Fund to damages and
administrative enforcement. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS.'
 
CONTRACTS WILL NOT BE STAMPED
 
     In order to give notice of the right,title and interest of Securityholders
to the Home Improvement Contracts, the Depositor will cause a UCC-1 financing
statement to be executed by the Depositor or the Seller identifying the Trustee
as the secured party and identifying all Home Improvement Contracts as
collateral. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Home Improvement Contracts will not be stamped or
 
                                       17
<PAGE>
otherwise marked to reflect their assignment to the Trust Fund. Therefore, if,
through negligence, fraud or otherwise, a subsequent purchaser were able to take
physical possession of the Home Improvement Contracts without notice of such
assignment, the interest of Securityholders in the Home Improvement Contracts
could be defeated. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS--The Home Improvement
Contracts.'
 
RATINGS ARE NOT RECOMMENDATIONS
 
     It will be a condition to the issuance of a Series of Securities that they
be rated in one of the four highest rating categories by the Rating Agency
identified in the related Prospectus Supplement. Any such rating would be based
on, among other things, the adequacy of the value of the Primary Assets and any
Enhancement with respect to such Series. Such rating should not be deemed a
recommendation to purchase, hold or sell Securities, inasmuch as it does not
address market price or suitability for a particular investor. There is also no
assurance that any such rating will remain in effect for any given period of
time or may not be lowered or withdrawn entirely by the Rating Agency if in its
judgment circumstances in the future so warrant. In addition to being lowered or
withdrawn due to any erosion in the adequacy of the value of the Primary Assets,
such rating might also be lowered or withdrawn, among other reasons, because of
an adverse change in the financial or other condition of an Enhancer or a change
in the rating of such Enhancer's long term debt.
 
                                       18
<PAGE>
                         DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES
 
GENERAL
 
     Each Series of Notes will be issued pursuant to an indenture (the
'Indenture') between the related Trust Fund and the entity named in the related
Prospectus Supplement as trustee (the 'Trustee') with respect to such Series. A
form of Indenture has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of
which this Prospectus forms a part. The Certificates will also be issued in
Series pursuant to separate agreements (each, a 'Pooling and Servicing
Agreement' or a 'Trust Agreement') among the Depositor, the Servicer, if the
Series relates to Loans, and the Trustee. A form of Pooling and Servicing
Agreement has been filed as an exhibit to the Registration Statement of which
this Prospectus forms a part. A Series may consist of both Notes and
Certificates.
 
     The Seller may agree to reimburse the Depositor for certain fees and
expenses of the Depositor incurred in connection with the offering of the
Securities.
 
     The following summaries describe certain provisions in the Agreements
common to each Series of Securities. The summaries do not purport to be complete
and are subject to, and are qualified in their entirety by reference to, the
provisions of the Agreements and the Prospectus Supplement relating to each
Series of Securities. Where particular provisions or terms used in the
Agreements are referred to, the actual provisions (including definitions of
terms) are incorporated herein by reference as part of such summaries.
 
     Each Series of Securities will consist of one or more Classes of
Securities, one or more of which may be Compound Interest Securities, Variable
Interest Securities, PAC Securities, Zero Coupon Securities, Principal Only
Securities, Interest Only Securities or Participating Securities. A Series may
also include one or more Classes of Subordinate Securities. The Securities of
each Series will be issued only in fully registered form, without coupons, in
the authorized denominations for each Class specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement. Upon satisfaction of the conditions, if any, applicable to a Class
of a Series, as described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the transfer of
the Securities may be registered and the Securities may be exchanged at the
office of the Trustee specified in the Prospectus Supplement without the payment
of any service charge other than any tax or governmental charge payable in
connection with such registration of transfer or exchange. If specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, one or more Classes of a Series may be available
in book-entry form only.
 
     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, payments of
principal of and interest on a Series of Securities will be made on the
Distribution Dates specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to such
Series by check mailed to Holders of such Series, registered as such at the
close of business on the record date specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement applicable to such Distribution Dates at their addresses appearing on
the security register, except that (a) payments may be made by wire transfer (at
the expense of the Holder requesting payment by wire transfer) in certain
circumstances described in the related Prospectus Supplement and (b) final
payments of principal in retirement of each Security will be made only upon
presentation and surrender of such Security at the office of the Trustee
specified in the Prospectus Supplement. Notice of the final payment on a
Security will be mailed to the Holder of such Security before the Distribution
Date on which the final principal payment on any Security is expected to be made
to the holder of such Security.
 
     Payments of principal of and interest on the Securities will be made by the
Trustee, or a paying agent on behalf of the Trustee, as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, all payments with respect to the Primary Assets for a Series,
together with reinvestment income thereon, amounts withdrawn from any Reserve
Fund, and amounts available pursuant to any other Enhancement will be deposited
directly into the Collection Account. If provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, such amounts may be net of certain amounts payable to the related
Servicer and any other person specified in the Prospectus Supplement. Such
amounts thereafter will be deposited into the Distribution Account and will be
available to make payments on the Securities of such Series on the next
Distribution Date. See 'THE TRUST FUNDS--Collection and Distribution Accounts.'
 
                                       19
<PAGE>
VALUATION OF THE PRIMARY ASSETS
 
     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Notes,
each Primary Asset included in the related Trust Fund for a Series will be
assigned an initial 'Asset Value.' Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, at any time the Asset Value of the Primary Assets will be
equal to the product of the Asset Value Percentage as set forth in the Indenture
and the lesser of (a) the stream of remaining regularly scheduled payments on
the Primary Assets, net, unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus
Supplement, of certain amounts payable as expenses, together with income earned
on each such scheduled payment received through the day preceding the next
Distribution Date at the Assumed Reinvestment Rate, if any, discounted to
present value at the highest interest rate on the Notes of such Series over
periods equal to the interval between payments on the Notes, and (b) the then
principal balance of the Primary Assets. Unless otherwise specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the initial Asset Value of the Primary Assets
will be at least equal to the principal amount of the Notes of the related
Series at the date of issuance thereof.
 
     The 'Assumed Reinvestment Rate,' if any, for a Series will be the highest
rate permitted by the Rating Agency or a rate insured by means of a surety bond,
guaranteed investment contract, Deposit Agreement or other arrangement
satisfactory to the Rating Agency. If the Assumed Reinvestment Rate is so
insured, the related Prospectus Supplement will set forth the terms of such
arrangement.
 
PAYMENTS OF INTEREST
 
     The Securities of each Class by their terms entitled to receive interest
will bear interest (calculated, unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, on the basis of a 360 day year of twelve 30-day months)
from the date and at the rate per annum specified, or calculated in the method
described, in the related Prospectus Supplement. Interest on such Securities of
a Series will be payable on the Distribution Date specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. The rate of interest on Securities of a Series may be
variable or may change with changes in the annual percentage rates of the Loans
or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable included
in the related Trust Fund and/or as prepayments occur with respect to such Loans
or Underlying Loans, as applicable. Principal Only Securities may not be
entitled to receive any interest distributions or may be entitled to receive
only nominal interest distributions. Any interest on Zero Coupon Securities that
is not paid on the related Distribution Date will accrue and be added to the
principal thereof on such Distribution Date.
 
     Interest payable on the Securities on a Distribution Date will include all
interest accrued during the period specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement. In the event interest accrues during the calendar month preceding a
Distribution Date, the effective yield to Holders will be reduced from the yield
that would otherwise be obtainable if interest payable on the Securities were to
accrue through the day immediately preceding such Distribution Date.
 
PAYMENTS OF PRINCIPAL
 
     On each Distribution Date for a Series, principal payments will be made to
the Holders of the Securities of such Series on which principal is then payable,
to the extent set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement. Such payments will
be made in an aggregate amount determined as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement and will be allocated among the respective Classes of a Series in the
manner, at the times and in the priority (which may, in certain cases, include
allocation by random lot) set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
FINAL SCHEDULED DISTRIBUTION DATE
 
     The Final Scheduled Distribution Date with respect to each Class of Notes
is the date no later than which the principal thereof will be fully paid and
with respect to each Class of a Series of Certificates will be the date on which
the entire aggregate principal balance of such Class is expected to be reduced
to zero, in each case calculated on the basis of the assumptions applicable to
such Series described in the related Prospectus Supplement. The Final Scheduled
Distribution Date for each Class of a Series will be specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. Since payments on the Primary Assets will be used to make
distributions in reduction of the outstanding principal amount of the
Securities, it is likely that the actual final Distribution Date of any such
Class will occur earlier, and may occur substantially earlier, than its Final
Scheduled Distribution Date.
 
                                       20
<PAGE>
Furthermore, with respect to a Series of Certificates, unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, as a result of delinquencies,
defaults and liquidations of the Primary Assets in the Trust Fund, the actual
final Distribution Date of any Certificate may occur later than its Final
Scheduled Distribution Date. No assurance can be given as to the actual
prepayment experience with respect to a Series. See 'Weighted Average Life of
the Securities' below.
 
SPECIAL REDEMPTION
 
     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of
Securities having other than monthly Distribution Dates, one or more Classes of
Securities of such Series may be subject to special redemption, in whole or in
part, on the day specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (a 'Special
Redemption Date') if, as a consequence of prepayments on the Loans or Underlying
Loans, as applicable, relating to such Securities or low yields then available
for reinvestment the entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
determines, based on assumptions specified in the applicable Agreement that the
amount available for the payment of interest that will have accrued on such
Securities (the 'Available Interest Amount') through the designated interest
accrual date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement is less than the
amount of interest that will have accrued on such Securities to such date. In
such event and as further described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Trustee will redeem a principal amount of outstanding Securities of such Series
as will cause the Available Interest Amount to equal the amount of interest that
will have accrued through such designated interest accrual date for such Series
of Securities outstanding immediately after such redemption.
 
OPTIONAL REDEMPTION, PURCHASE OR TERMINATION
 
     The Depositor or the Servicer may, at its option, redeem, in whole or in
part, one or more Classes of Notes or purchase one or more Classes of
Certificates of any Series, on any Distribution Date under the circumstances, if
any, specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to such Series.
Alternatively, if so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series
of Certificates, the Depositor, the Servicer, or another entity designated in
the related Prospectus Supplement may, at its option, cause an early termination
of a Trust Fund by repurchasing all of the Primary Assets from such Trust Fund
on or after a date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, or on or
after such time as the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the
Certificates or Primary Assets, as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement is less than the amount or percentage specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. Notice of such redemption, purchase or termination must
be given by the Depositor or the Trustee prior to the related date. The
redemption, purchase or repurchase price will be set forth in the related
Prospectus Supplement. If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in the
event that a REMIC election has been made, the Trustee shall receive a
satisfactory opinion of counsel that the optional redemption, purchase or
termination will be conducted so as to constitute a 'qualified liquidation'
under Section 860F of the Code.
 
     In addition, the Prospectus Supplement may provide other circumstances
under which Holders of Securities of a Series could be fully paid significantly
earlier than would otherwise be the case if payments or distributions were
solely based on the activity of the related Primary Assets.
 
WEIGHTED AVERAGE LIFE OF THE SECURITIES
 
     Weighted average life refers to the average amount of time that will elapse
from the date of issue of a security until each dollar of principal of such
security will be repaid to the investor. Unless otherwise specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the weighted average life of the Securities of a
Class will be influenced by the rate at which the amount financed under the
Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable,
included in the Trust Fund for a Series is paid, which may be in the form of
scheduled amortization or prepayments.
 
     Prepayments on loans and other receivables can be measured relative to a
prepayment standard or model. The Prospectus Supplement for a Series of
Securities will describe the prepayment standard or model, if any, used and may
contain tables setting forth the projected weighted average life of each Class
of Securities of such Series and the percentage of the original principal amount
of each Class of Securities of such Series that would be outstanding on
specified Distribution Dates for such Series based on the assumptions stated in
such Prospectus Supplement, including assumptions that prepayments on the Loans
or Underlying Loans relating to the Private
 
                                       21
<PAGE>
Securities, as applicable, included in the related Trust Fund are made at rates
corresponding to various percentages of the prepayment standard or model
specified in such Prospectus Supplement.
 
     There is, however, no assurance that prepayment of the Loans or Underlying
Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, included in the related
Trust Fund will conform to any level of any prepayment standard or model
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The rate of principal
prepayments on pools of loans may be influenced by a variety of factors,
including job related factors such as transfers, layoffs or promotions and
personal factors such as divorce, disability or prolonged illness. Economic
conditions, either generally or within a particular geographic area or industry,
also may affect the rate of principal prepayments. Demographic and social
factors may influence the rate of principal prepayments in that some borrowers
have greater financial flexibility to move or refinance than do other borrowers.
The deductibility of mortgage interest payments, servicing decisions and other
factors also affect the rate of principal prepayments. As a result, there can be
no assurance as to the rate or timing of principal prepayments of the Loans or
Underlying Loans either from time to time or over the lives of such Loans or
Underlying Loans.
 
     The rate of prepayments of conventional housing loans and other receivables
has fluctuated significantly in recent years. In general, however, if prevailing
interest rates fall significantly below the interest rates on the Loans or
Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, for a
Series, such loans are likely to prepay at rates higher than if prevailing
interest rates remain at or above the interest rates borne by such loans. In
this regard, it should be noted that the Loans or Underlying Loans, as
applicable, for a Series may have different interest rates. In addition, the
weighted average life of the Securities may be affected by the varying
maturities of the Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities,
as applicable. If any Loans or Underlying Loans relating to the Private
Securities, as applicable, for a Series have actual terms-to-stated maturity of
less than those assumed in calculating the Final Scheduled Distribution Date of
the related Securities, one or more Classes of the Series may be fully paid
prior to their respective Final Scheduled Distribution Date, even in the absence
of prepayments and a reinvestment return higher than the Assumed Reinvestment
Rate.
 
                                THE TRUST FUNDS
 
GENERAL
 
     The Notes of each Series will be secured by the pledge of the assets of the
related Trust Fund, and the Certificates of each Series will represent interests
in the assets of the related Trust Fund. The Trust Fund of each Series will
include assets purchased from the Seller composed of (i) the Primary Assets,
(ii) amounts available from the reinvestment of payments on such Primary Assets
at the Assumed Reinvestment Rate, if any, specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, (iii) any Enhancement, (iv) any Property that secured a Loan but
which is acquired by foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure or repossession
and (v) the amount, if any, initially deposited in the Collection Account or
Distribution Account for a Series as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     The Securities will be non-recourse obligations of the related Trust Fund.
The assets of the Trust Fund specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for
a Series of Securities, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, will serve as collateral only for that Series of Securities. Holders
of a Series of Notes may only proceed against such collateral securing such
Series of Notes in the case of a default with respect to such Series of Notes
and may not proceed against any assets of the Depositor or the related Trust
Fund not pledged to secure such Notes.
 
     The Primary Assets for a Series will be sold by the Seller to the Depositor
or purchased by the Depositor in the open market or in privately negotiated
transactions, which may include transactions with affiliates and will be
transferred by the Depositor to the Trust Fund. Loans relating to a Series will
be serviced by the Servicer, which may be the Seller, specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, pursuant to a Pooling and Servicing Agreement, with
respect to a Series of Certificates or a servicing agreement (each, a 'Servicing
Agreement') between the Trust Fund and Servicer, with respect to a Series of
Notes.
 
                                       22
<PAGE>
     As used herein, 'Agreement' means, with respect to a Series of
Certificates, the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement, and with
respect to a Series of Notes, the Indenture and the Servicing Agreement, as the
context requires.
 
     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund relating
to a Series of Securities may be a business trust formed under the laws of the
state specified in the related Prospectus Supplement pursuant to a trust
agreement (each, a 'Trust Agreement') between the Depositor and the trustee of
such Trust Fund specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
 
     With respect to each Trust Fund, prior to the initial offering of the
related Series of Securities, the Trust Fund will have no assets or liabilities.
No Trust Fund is expected to engage in any activities other than acquiring,
managing and holding the related Primary Assets and other assets contemplated
herein and in the related Prospectus Supplement and the proceeds thereof,
issuing Securities and making payments and distributions thereon and certain
related activities. No Trust Fund is expected to have any source of capital
other than its assets and any related Enhancement.
 
     Primary Assets included in the Trust Fund for a Series may consist of any
combination of Loans and Private Securities, to the extent and as specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
THE LOANS
 
     Mortgage Loans.  The Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in whole or
in part, of closed-end home equity loans (the 'Mortgage Loans') secured by
mortgages primarily on Single Family Properties which may be subordinated to
other mortgages on the same Mortgaged Property. The Mortgage Loans may have
fixed interest rates or adjustable interest rates and may provide for other
payment characteristics as described below and in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     Unless otherwise described in the related Prospectus Supplement, the full
principal amount of a Mortgage Loan is advanced at origination of the loan and
generally is repayable in equal (or substantially equal) installments of an
amount sufficient to fully amortize such loan at its stated maturity. As more
fully described in the related Prospectus Supplement, interest on each Mortgage
Loan is calculated on the basis of the outstanding principal balance of such
loan multiplied by the Loan Rate thereon and further multiplied by a fraction,
the numerator of which is the number of days in the period elapsed since the
preceding payment of interest was made and the denominator is the number of days
in the annual period for which interest accrues on such loan. Unless otherwise
described in the related Prospectus Supplement the original terms to stated
maturity of Mortgage Loans will not exceed 360 months.
 
     The Mortgaged Properties will include Single Family Property (i.e., one- to
four-family residential housing, including Condominium Units and Cooperative
Dwellings) and mixed-use property. Mixed-use properties will consist of
structures of no more than three stories, which include one to four residential
dwelling units and space used for retail, professional or other commercial uses.
Such uses, which will not involve more than 50% of the space in the structure,
may include doctor, dentist or law offices, real estate agencies, boutiques,
newstands, convenience stores or other similar types of uses intended to cater
to individual customers as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The
properties may be located in suburban or metropolitan districts. Any such
non-residential use will be in compliance with local zoning laws and
regulations. The Mortgaged Properties may consist of detached individual
dwellings, individual condominiums, townhouses, duplexes, row houses, individual
units in planned unit developments and other attached dwelling units. Each
Single Family Property will be located on land owned in fee simple by the
borrower or on land leased by the borrower for a term at least ten years (unless
otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement) greater than the term
of the related Loan. Attached dwellings may include owner-occupied structures
where each borrower owns the land upon which the unit is built, with the
remaining adjacent land owned in common or dwelling units subject to a
proprietary lease or occupancy agreement in a cooperatively owned apartment
building.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Mortgages
on Cooperative Dwellings consist of a lien on the shares issued by such
Cooperative Dwelling and the proprietary lease or occupancy agreement relating
to such Cooperative Dwelling.
 
                                       23
<PAGE>
     The aggregate principal balance of Mortgage Loans secured by Mortgaged
Properties that are owner-occupied will be disclosed in the related Prospectus
Supplement. Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the sole
basis for a representation that a given percentage of the Mortgage Loans are
secured by Single Family Property that is owner-occupied will be either (i) the
making of a representation by the Mortgagor at origination of the Mortgage Loan
either that the underlying Mortgaged Property will be used by the Mortgagor for
a period of at least six months every year or that the Mortgagor intends to use
the Mortgaged Property as a primary residence, or (ii) a finding that the
address of the underlying Mortgaged Property is the Mortgagor's mailing address
as reflected in the Servicer's records. To the extent specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Mortgaged Properties may include non-owner occupied
investment properties and vacation and second homes.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
initial Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio of a Loan is computed in the manner
described in the related Prospectus Supplement, taking into account the amounts
of any related senior mortgage loans.
 
     Home Improvement Contracts.  The Primary Assets for a Series may consist,
in whole or part, of home improvement installment sales contracts and
installment loan agreements (the 'Home Improvement Contracts') originated by a
home improvement contractor in the ordinary course of business. As specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Home Improvement Contracts will either be
unsecured or secured by the Mortgages primarily on Single Family Properties
which are generally subordinate to other mortgages on the same Mortgaged
Property or by purchase money security interests in the Home Improvements
financed thereby. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable Prospectus
Supplement, the Home Improvement Contracts will be fully amortizing and may have
fixed interest rates or adjustable interest rates and may provide for other
payment characteristics as described below and in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the home
improvements (the 'Home Improvements') securing the Home Improvement Contracts
include, but are not limited to, replacement windows, house siding, new roofs,
swimming pools, satellite dishes, kitchen and bathroom remodeling goods and
solar heating panels. The initial Loan-to-Value Ratio of a Home Improvement
Contract will be computed in the manner described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     Additional Information.  The selection criteria which will apply with
respect to the Loans, including, but not limited to, the Combined Loan-to-Value
Ratios or Loan-to-Value Ratios, as applicable, original terms to maturity and
delinquency information, will be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     The Loans for a Series may include Loans that do not amortize their entire
principal balance by their stated maturity in accordance with their terms and
require a balloon payment of the remaining principal balance at maturity, as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. As further described in the
related Prospectus Supplement, the Loans for a Series may include Loans that do
not have a specified stated maturity.
 
     The Loans will be conventional contracts or contracts insured by the
Federal Housing Administration ('FHA') or partially guaranteed by the Veterans
Administration ('VA'). Loans designated in the related Prospectus Supplement as
insured by the FHA will be insured by the FHA as authorized under the United
States Housing Act of 1937, as amended. Such Loans will be insured under various
FHA programs. These programs generally limit the principal amount and interest
rates of the mortgage loans insured. Loans insured by the FHA generally require
a minimum down payment of approximately 5% of the original principal amount of
the loan. No FHA-insured Loans relating to a Series may have an interest rate or
original principal amount exceeding the applicable FHA limits at the time of
origination of such loan.
 
     The insurance premiums for Loans insured by the FHA are collected by
lenders approved by the Department of Housing and Urban Development ('HUD') and
are paid to the FHA. The regulations governing FHA single-family mortgage
insurance programs provide that insurance benefits are payable either upon
foreclosure (or other acquisition of possession) and conveyance of the mortgaged
premises to HUD or upon assignment of the defaulted Loan to HUD. With respect to
a defaulted FHA-insured Loan, the Servicer is limited in its ability to initiate
foreclosure proceedings. When it is determined, either by the Servicer or HUD,
that default was caused by circumstances beyond the mortgagor's control, the
Servicer is expected to make an effort to avoid foreclosure by entering, if
feasible, into one of a number of available forms of forbearance plans with the
mortgagor. Such plans
 
                                       24
<PAGE>
may involve the reduction or suspension of regular mortgage payments for a
specified period, with such payments to be made upon or before the maturity date
of the mortgage, or the recasting of payments due under the mortgage up to or
beyond the maturity date. In addition, when a default caused by such
circumstances is accompanied by certain other criteria, HUD may provide relief
by making payments to the Servicer in partial or full satisfaction of amounts
due under the Loan (which payments are to be repaid by the mortgagor to HUD) or
by accepting assignment of the loan from the Servicer. With certain exceptions,
at least three full monthly installments must be due and unpaid under the Loan
and HUD must have rejected any request for relief from the mortgagor before the
Servicer may initiate foreclosure proceedings.
 
     HUD has the option, in most cases, to pay insurance claims in cash or in
debentures issued by HUD. Currently, claims are being paid in cash, and claims
have not been paid in debentures since 1965. HUD debentures issued in
satisfaction of FHA insurance claims bear interest at the applicable HUD
debenture interest rate. The Servicer of each FHA-insured Loan will be obligated
to purchase any such debenture issued in satisfaction of such Loan upon default
for an amount equal to the principal amount of any such debenture.
 
     The amount of insurance benefits generally paid by the FHA is equal to the
entire unpaid principal amount of the defaulted Loan adjusted to reimburse the
Servicer for certain costs and expenses and to deduct certain amounts received
or retained by the Servicer after default. When entitlement to insurance
benefits results from foreclosure (or other acquisition of possession) and
conveyance to HUD, the Servicer is compensated for no more than two-thirds of
its foreclosure costs, and is compensated for interest accrued and unpaid prior
to such date but in general only to the extent it was allowed pursuant to a
forbearance plan approved by HUD. When entitlement to insurance benefits results
from assignment of the Loan to HUD, the insurance payment includes full
compensation for interest accrued and unpaid to the assignment date. The
insurance payment itself, upon foreclosure of an FHA-insured Loan, bears
interest from a date 30 days after the mortgagor's first uncorrected failure to
perform any obligation to make any payment due under the Loan and, upon
assignment, from the date of assignment to the date of payment of the claim, in
each case at the same interest rate as the applicable HUD debenture interest
rate as described above.
 
     Loans designated in the related Prospectus Supplement as guaranteed by the
VA will be partially guaranteed by the VA under the Serviceman's Readjustment
Act of 1944, as amended (a 'VA Guaranty'). The Serviceman's Readjustment Act of
1944, as amended, permits a veteran (or in certain instances the spouse of a
veteran) to obtain a mortgage loan guaranty by the VA covering mortgage
financing of the purchase of a one- to four-family dwelling unit at interest
rates permitted by the VA. The program has no mortgage loan limits, requires no
down payment from the purchaser and permits the guarantee of mortgage loans of
up to 30 years' duration.
 
     The maximum guaranty that may be issued by the VA under a VA guaranteed
mortgage loan depends upon the original principal amount of the mortgage loan,
as further described in 38 United States Code Section 1803(a), as amended. The
liability on the guaranty is reduced or increased pro rata with any reduction or
increase in the amount of indebtedness, but in no event will the amount payable
on the guaranty exceed the amount of the original guaranty. The VA may, at its
option and without regard to the guaranty, make full payment to a mortgage
holder of unsatisfied indebtedness on a mortgage upon its assignment to the VA.
 
     With respect to a defaulted VA guaranteed Loan, the Servicer is, absent
exceptional circumstances, authorized to announce its intention to foreclose
only when the default has continued for three months. Generally, a claim for the
guaranty is submitted after liquidation of the Mortgaged Property.
 
     The amount payable under the guaranty will be the percentage of the
VA-insured Loan originally guaranteed applied to indebtedness outstanding as of
the applicable date of computation specified in the VA regulations. Payments
under the guaranty will be equal to the unpaid principal amount of the loan,
interest accrued on the unpaid balance of the loan to the appropriate date of
computation and limited expenses of the mortgagee, but in each case only to the
extent that such amounts have not been recovered through liquidation of the
Mortgaged Property. The amount payable under the guaranty may in no event exceed
the amount of the original guaranty.
 
     The related Prospectus Supplement for each Series will provide information
with respect to the Loans that are Primary Assets as of the Cut-off Date,
including, among other things, and to the extent relevant: (a) the aggregate
unpaid principal balance of the Loans; (b) the range and weighted average Loan
Rate on the Loans,
 
                                       25
<PAGE>
and, in the case of adjustable rate Loans, the range and weighted average of the
current Loan Rates and the Lifetime Rate Caps, if any; (c) the range and average
outstanding principal balance of the Loans; (d) the weighted average original
and remaining term-to-stated maturity of the Loans and the range of original and
remaining terms-to-stated maturity, if applicable; (e) the range and weighted
average of Combined Loan-to-Value Ratios or Loan-to-Value Ratios for the Loans,
as applicable; (f) the percentage (by outstanding principal balance as of the
Cut-off Date) of Loans that accrue interest at adjustable or fixed interest
rates; (g) any special hazard insurance policy or bankruptcy bond or other
enhancement relating to the Loans; (h) the percentage (by principal balance as
of the Cut-off Date) of Loans that are secured by Mortgaged Properties, Home
Improvements or are unsecured; (i) the geographic distribution of any Mortgaged
Properties securing the Loans; (j) the percentage of Loans (by principal balance
as of the Cut-off Date) that are secured by Single Family Properties, shares
relating to Cooperative Dwellings, Condominium Units, investment property and
vacation or second homes; (k) the lien priority of the Loans; and (l) the
delinquency status and year of origination of the Loans. The related Prospectus
Supplement will also specify any other limitations on the types or
characteristics of Loans for a Series.
 
     If information of the nature described above respecting the Loans is not
known to the Depositor at the time the Securities are initially offered,
approximate or more general information of the nature described above will be
provided in the Prospectus Supplement and additional information will be set
forth in a Current Report on Form 8-K to be available to investors on the date
of issuance of the related Series and to be filed with the Commission within 15
days after the initial issuance of such Securities.
 
PRIVATE SECURITIES
 
     General.  Primary Assets for a Series may consist, in whole or in part, of
Private Securities which include pass-through certificates representing
beneficial interests in loans of the type that would otherwise be eligible to be
Loans (the 'Underlying Loans') or (b) collateralized obligations secured by
Underlying Loans. Such pass-through certificates or collateralized obligations
will have previously been (a) offered and distributed to the public pursuant to
an effective registration statement or (b) purchased in a transaction not
involving any public offering from a person who is not an affiliate of the
issuer of such securities at the time of sale (nor an affiliate thereof at any
time during the three preceding months); provided a period of three years
elapsed since the later of the date the securities were acquired from the issuer
or an affiliate thereof. Although individual Underlying Loans may be insured or
guaranteed by the United States or an agency or instrumentality thereof, they
need not be, and Private Securities themselves will not be so insured or
guaranteed.
 
     Private Securities will have been issued pursuant to a pooling and
servicing agreement, a trust agreement or similar agreement (a 'PS Agreement').
The seller/servicer of the Underlying Loans will have entered into the PS
Agreement with the trustee under such PS Agreement (the 'PS Trustee'). The PS
Trustee or its agent, or a custodian, will possess the Underlying Loans.
Underlying Loans will be serviced by a servicer (the 'PS Servicer') directly or
by one or more sub-servicers who may be subject to the supervision of the PS
Servicer.
 
     The sponsor of the Private Securities (the 'PS Sponsor') will be a
financial institution or other entity engaged generally in the business of
lending; a public agency or instrumentality of a state, local or federal
government; or a limited purpose corporation organized for the purpose of, among
other things, establishing trusts and acquiring and selling loans to such
trusts, and selling beneficial interests in such trusts. If so specified in the
Prospectus Supplement, the PS Sponsor may be an affiliate of the Depositor. The
obligations of the PS Sponsor will generally be limited to certain
representations and warranties with respect to the assets conveyed by it to the
related trust. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
the PS Sponsor will not have guaranteed any of the assets conveyed to the
related trust or any of the Private Securities issued under the PS Agreement.
Additionally, although the Underlying Loans may be guaranteed by an agency or
instrumentality of the United States, the Private Securities themselves will not
be so guaranteed.
 
     Distributions of principal and interest will be made on the Private
Securities on the dates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. The
Private Securities may be entitled to receive nominal or no principal
distributions or nominal or no interest distributions. Principal and interest
distributions will be made on the Private Securities by the PS Trustee or the PS
Servicer. The PS Sponsor or the PS Servicer may have the right to repurchase the
Underlying Loans after a certain date or under other circumstances specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                       26
<PAGE>
     The Underlying Loans may be fixed rate, level payment, fully amortizing
loans or adjustable rate loans or loans having balloon or other irregular
payment features. Such Underlying Loans will be secured by mortgages on
Mortgaged Properties.
 
     Credit Support Relating to Private Securities.  Credit support in the form
of Reserve Funds, subordination of other private securities issued under the PS
Agreement, guarantees, letters of credit, cash collateral accounts, insurance
policies or other types of credit support may be provided with respect to the
Underlying Loans or with respect to the Private Securities themselves. The type,
characteristics and amount of credit support will be a function of certain
characteristics of the Underlying Loans and other factors and will have been
established for the Private Securities on the basis of requirements of the
nationally recognized statistical rating organization that rated the Private
Securities.
 
     Additional Information.  The Prospectus Supplement for a Series for which
the Primary Assets include Private Securities will specify (such disclosure may
be on an approximate basis and will be as of the date specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement), to the extent relevant and to the extent such
information is reasonably available to the Depositor and the Depositor
reasonably believes such information to be reliable: (i) the aggregate
approximate principal amount and type of the Private Securities to be included
in the Trust Fund for such Series; (ii) certain characteristics of the
Underlying Loans including (A) the payment features of such Underlying Loans
(i.e., whether they are fixed rate or adjustable rate and whether they provide
for fixed level payments or other payment features), (B) the approximate
aggregate principal balance, if known, of such Underlying Loans insured or
guaranteed by a governmental entity, (C) the servicing fee or range of servicing
fees with respect to the Underlying Loans, (D) the minimum and maximum stated
maturities of such Underlying Loans at origination, (E) the lien priority of
such Underlying Loans, and (F) the delinquency status and year of origination of
such Underlying Loans; (iii) the maximum original term-to-stated maturity of the
Private Securities; (iv) the weighted average term-to-stated maturity of the
Private Securities; (v) the pass-through or certificate rate or ranges thereof
for the Private Securities; (vi) the PS Sponsor, the PS Servicer (if other than
the PS Sponsor) and the PS Trustee for such Private Securities; (vii) certain
characteristics of credit support if any, such as Reserve Funds, insurance
policies, letters of credit or guarantees relating to such Loans underlying the
Private Securities or to such Private Securities themselves; (viii) the terms on
which Underlying Loans may, or are required to, be purchased prior to their
stated maturity or the stated maturity of the Private Securities; and (ix) the
terms on which Underlying Loans may be substituted for those originally
underlying the Private Securities.
 
     If information of the nature described above representing the Private
Securities is not known to the Depositor at the time the Securities are
initially offered, approximate or more general information of the nature
described above will be provided in the Prospectus Supplement and the additional
information, if available, will be set forth in a Current Report on Form 8-K to
be available to investors on the date of issuance of the related Series and to
be filed with the Commission within 15 days of the initial issuance of such
Securities.
 
COLLECTION AND DISTRIBUTION ACCOUNTS
 
     A separate Collection Account will be established by the Trustee or the
Servicer, in the name of the Trustee, for each Series of Securities for receipt
of the amount of cash, if any, specified in the related Prospectus Supplement to
be initially deposited therein by the Depositor, all amounts received on or with
respect to the Primary Assets and, unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, income earned thereon. Certain amounts on deposit in such
Collection Account and certain amounts available pursuant to any Enhancement, as
provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, will be deposited in a related
Distribution Account, which will also be established by the Trustee for each
such Series of Securities, for distribution to the related Holders. Unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee will
invest the funds in the Collection and Distribution Accounts in Eligible
Investments maturing, with certain exceptions, not later, in the case of funds
in the Collection Account, than the day preceding the date such funds are due to
be deposited in the Distribution Account or otherwise distributed and, in the
case of funds in the Distribution Account, than the day preceding the next
Distribution Date for the related Series of Securities. Eligible Investments
include, among other investments, obligations of the United States and certain
agencies thereof, federal funds, certificates of deposit, commercial paper,
demand and time deposits and banker's acceptances,
 
                                       27
<PAGE>
certain repurchase agreements of United States government securities and certain
guaranteed investment contracts, in each case, acceptable to the Rating Agency.
 
     Notwithstanding any of the foregoing, amounts may be deposited and
withdrawn pursuant to any Deposit Agreement or Minimum Principal Payment
Agreement as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, a Trust Fund will
include one or more segregated trust accounts (each, a 'Pre-Funding Account')
established and maintained with the Trustee for the related Series. If so
specified, on the closing date for such Series, a portion of the proceeds of the
sale of the Securities of such Series (such amount, the 'Pre-Funded Amount')
will be deposited in the Pre-Funding Account and may be used to purchase
additional Primary Assets during the period of time specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement (the 'Pre-Funding Period'). The Primary Assets to be so
purchased will be required to have certain characteristics specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement. If any Pre-Funded Amount remains on deposit in
the Pre-Funding Account at the end of the Pre-Funding Period, such amount will
be applied in the manner specified in the related Prospectus Supplement to
prepay the Notes and/or the Certificates of the applicable Series.
 
     If a Pre-Funding Account is established, one or more segregated trust
accounts (each, a 'Capitalized Interest Account') may be established and
maintained with the Trustee for the related Series. On the closing date for such
Series, a portion of the proceeds of the sale of the Securities of such Series
will be deposited in the Capitalized Interest Account and used to fund the
excess, if any, of the sum of (i) the amount of interest accrued on the
Securities of such Series and (ii) if specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, certain fees or expenses during the Pre-Funding Period, over the
amount of interest available therefor from the Primary Assets in the Trust Fund.
Any amounts on deposit in the Capitalized Interest Account at the end of the
Pre-Funding Period that are not necessary for such purposes will be distributed
to the person specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                  ENHANCEMENT
 
     If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities,
simultaneously with the Depositor's assignment of the Primary Assets to the
Trustee, the Depositor will obtain an irrevocable letter of credit, surety bond
or insurance policy, issue Subordinate Securities or obtain any other form of
enhancement or combination thereof (collectively, 'Enhancement') in favor of the
Trustee on behalf of the Holders of the related Series or designated Classes of
such Series from an institution or by other means acceptable to the Rating
Agency. The Enhancement will support the payment of principal and interest on
the Securities, and may be applied for certain other purposes to the extent and
under the conditions set forth in such Prospectus Supplement. Enhancement for a
Series may include one or more of the following forms, or such other form as may
be specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. If so specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement, any of such Enhancement may be structured so as
to protect against losses relating to more than one Trust Fund, in the manner
described therein.
 
SUBORDINATE SECURITIES
 
     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Enhancement for a Series
may consist of one or more Classes of Subordinate Securities. The rights of
holders of such Subordinate Securities to receive distributions on any
Distribution Date will be subordinate in right and priority to the rights of
Holders of Senior Securities of the Series, but only to the extent described in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
INSURANCE
 
     If stated in the related Prospectus Supplement, Enhancement for a Series
may consist of special hazard insurance policies, bankruptcy bonds and other
types of insurance relating to the Primary Assets, as described below and in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Pool Insurance Policy.  If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement
relating to a Series of Securities, the Depositor will obtain a pool insurance
policy for the Loans in the related Trust Fund. The pool insurance policy will
cover any loss (subject to the limitations described in a related Prospectus
Supplement) by reason of default. but will not cover the portion of the
principal balance of any Loan that is required to be covered by any primary
 
                                       28
<PAGE>
mortgage insurance policy. The amount and terms of any such coverage will be set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Special Hazard Insurance Policy.  Although the terms of such policies vary
to some degree, a special hazard insurance policy typically provides that, where
there has been damage to Property securing a defaulted or foreclosed Loan (title
to which has been acquired by the insured) and to the extent such damage is not
covered by the standard hazard insurance policy or any flood insurance policy,
if applicable, required to be maintained with respect to such Property, or in
connection with partial loss resulting from the application of the coinsurance
clause in a standard hazard insurance policy, the special hazard insurer will
pay the lesser of (i) the cost of repair or replacement of such Property or (ii)
upon transfer of such Property to the special hazard insurer, the unpaid
principal balance of such Loan at the time of acquisition of such Property by
foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure, plus accrued interest to the date of
claim settlement and certain expenses incurred by the Servicer with respect to
such Property. If the unpaid principal balance plus accrued interest and certain
expenses is paid by the special hazard insurer, the amount of further coverage
under the special hazard insurance policy will be reduced by such amount less
any net proceeds from the sale of such Property. Any amount paid as the cost of
repair of such Property will reduce coverage by such amount. Special hazard
insurance policies typically do not cover losses occasioned by war, civil
insurrection, certain governmental actions, errors in design, faulty workmanship
or materials (except under certain circumstances), nuclear reaction, flood (if
the mortgaged property is in a federally designated flood area), chemical
contamination and certain other risks.
 
     Restoration of the Property with the proceeds described under (i) above is
expected to satisfy the condition under any pool insurance policy that such
Property be restored before a claim under such pool insurance policy may be
validly presented with respect to the defaulted Loan secured by such Property.
The payment described under (ii) above will render unnecessary presentation of a
claim in respect of such Loan under any pool insurance policy. Therefore, so
long as such pool insurance policy remains in effect, the payment by the special
hazard insurer of the cost of repair or of the unpaid principal balance of the
related Loan plus accrued interest and certain expenses will not affect the
total insurance proceeds paid to Holders of the Securities, but will affect the
relative amounts of coverage remaining under the special hazard insurance policy
and pool insurance policy.
 
     Bankruptcy Bond.  In the event of a bankruptcy of a borrower, the
bankruptcy court may establish the value of the Property securing the related
Loan at an amount less than the then-outstanding principal balance of such Loan.
The amount of the secured debt could be reduced to such value, and the holder of
such Loan thus would become an unsecured creditor to the extent the outstanding
principal balance of such Loan exceeds the value so assigned to the Property by
the bankruptcy court. In addition, certain other modifications of the terms of a
Loan can result from a bankruptcy proceeding. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF
LOANS.' If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor or
other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement will obtain a
bankruptcy bond or similar insurance contract (the 'bankruptcy bond') covering
losses resulting from proceedings with respect to borrowers under the Bankruptcy
Code. The bankruptcy bond will cover certain losses resulting from a reduction
by a bankruptcy court of scheduled payments of principal of and interest on a
Loan or a reduction by such court of the principal amount of a Loan and will
cover certain unpaid interest on the amount of such a principal reduction from
the date of the filing of a bankruptcy petition.
 
     The bankruptcy bond will provide coverage in the aggregate amount specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement for all Loans in the Trust Fund for such
Series. Such amount will be reduced by payments made under such bankruptcy bond
in respect of such Loans, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, and will not be restored.
 
RESERVE FUNDS
 
     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of
Securities, the Depositor will deposit into one or more funds to be established
with the Trustee as part of the Trust Fund for such Series or for the benefit of
any Enhancer with respect to such Series (the 'Reserve Funds') cash, a letter or
letters of credit, cash collateral accounts, Eligible Investments, or other
instruments meeting the criteria of the Rating Agency rating any Series of the
Securities in the amount specified in such Prospectus Supplement. In the
alternative or in addition to such deposit, a Reserve Fund for a Series may be
funded over time through application of all or a portion of the excess cash flow
from the Primary Assets for such Series, to the extent described in the related
Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                       29
<PAGE>
If applicable, the initial amount of the Reserve Fund and the Reserve Fund
maintenance requirements for a Series of Securities will be described in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Amounts withdrawn from any Reserve Fund will be applied by the Trustee to
make payments on the Securities of a Series, to pay expenses, to reimburse any
Enhancer or for any other purpose, in the manner and to the extent specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Amounts deposited in a Reserve Fund will be invested by the Trustee, in
Eligible Investments maturing no later than the day specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement.
 
MINIMUM PRINCIPAL PAYMENT AGREEMENT
 
     If stated in the Prospectus Supplement relating to a Series of Securities,
the Depositor will enter into a Minimum Principal Payment Agreement with an
entity meeting the criteria of the Rating Agency pursuant to which such entity
will provide certain payments on the Securities of such Series in the event that
aggregate scheduled principal payments and/or prepayments on the Primary Assets
for such Series are not sufficient to make certain payments on the Securities of
such Series, as provided in the Prospectus Supplement.
 
DEPOSIT AGREEMENT
 
     If specified in a Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor and the Trustee for
such Series of Securities will enter into a Deposit Agreement with the entity
specified in such Prospectus Supplement on or before the sale of such Series of
Securities. The purpose of a Deposit Agreement would be to accumulate available
cash for investment so that such cash, together with income thereon, can be
applied to future distributions on one or more Classes of Securities. The
Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities pursuant to which a Deposit
Agreement is used will contain a description of the terms of such Deposit
Agreement.
 
                                       30
<PAGE>
                               SERVICING OF LOANS
 
GENERAL
 
     Customary servicing functions with respect to Loans comprising the Primary
Assets in the Trust Fund will be provided by the Servicer directly pursuant to
the related Servicing Agreement or Pooling and Servicing Agreement, as the case
may be, with respect to a Series of Securities.
 
COLLECTION PROCEDURES; ESCROW ACCOUNTS
 
     The Servicer will make reasonable efforts to collect all payments required
to be made under the Loans and will, consistent with the terms of the related
Agreement for a Series and any applicable Enhancement, follow such collection
procedures as it follows with respect to comparable loans held in its own
portfolio. Consistent with the above, the Servicer may, in its discretion, (i)
waive any assumption fee, late payment charge, or other charge in connection
with a Loan and (ii) to the extent provided in the related Agreement arrange
with an obligor a schedule for the liquidation of delinquencies by extending the
Due Dates for Scheduled Payments on such Loan.
 
     If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer, to the
extent permitted by law, will establish and maintain escrow or impound accounts
('Escrow Accounts') with respect to Loans in which payments by obligors to pay
taxes, assessments, mortgage and hazard insurance premiums, and other comparable
items will be deposited. Loans may not require such payments under the loan
related documents, in which case the Servicer would not be required to establish
any Escrow Account with respect to such Loans. Withdrawals from the Escrow
Accounts are to be made to effect timely payment of taxes, assessments and
mortgage and hazard insurance, to refund to obligors amounts determined to be
overages, to pay interest to obligors on balances in the Escrow Account to the
extent required by law, to repair or otherwise protect the property securing the
related Loan and to clear and terminate such Escrow Account. The Servicer will
be responsible for the administration of the Escrow Accounts and generally will
make advances to such accounts when a deficiency exists therein.
 
DEPOSITS TO AND WITHDRAWALS FROM THE COLLECTION ACCOUNT
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Trustee or the Servicer will establish a separate account (the 'Collection
Account') in the name of the Trustee. Unless otherwise indicated in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Collection Account will be an account maintained (i)
at a depository institution, the long-term unsecured debt obligations of which
at the time of any deposit therein are rated by each Rating Agency rating the
Securities of such Series at levels satisfactory to each Rating Agency or (ii)
in an account or accounts the deposits in which are insured to the maximum
extent available by the FDIC or which are secured in a manner meeting
requirements established by each Rating Agency.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the funds
held in the Collection Account may be invested, pending remittance to the
Trustee, in Eligible Investments. If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Servicer will be entitled to receive as additional compensation
any interest or other income earned on funds in the Collection Account.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer, the Depositor, the Trustee or the Seller, as appropriate, will deposit
into the Collection Account for each Series on the Business Day following the
Closing Date any amounts representing Scheduled Payments due after the related
Cut-off Date but received by the Servicer on or before the Closing Date, and
thereafter, within two business days after the date of receipt thereof, the
following payments and collections received or made by it (other than, unless
otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, in respect of principal
of and interest on the related Primary Assets due on or before such Cut-off
Date):
 
          (i) All payments on account of principal, including prepayments, on
     such Primary Assets;
 
          (ii) All payments on account of interest on such Primary Assets after
     deducting therefrom, at the discretion of the Servicer but only to the
     extent of the amount permitted to be withdrawn or withheld from the
     Collection Account in accordance with the related Agreement, the Servicing
     Fee in respect of such Primary Assets;
 
                                       31
<PAGE>
          (iii) All amounts received by the Servicer in connection with the
     liquidation of Primary Assets or property acquired in respect thereof,
     whether through foreclosure sale, repossession or otherwise, including
     payments in connection with such Primary Assets received from the obligor,
     other than amounts required to be paid or refunded to the obligor pursuant
     to the terms of the applicable loan documents or otherwise pursuant to law
     ('Liquidation Proceeds'), exclusive of, in the discretion of the Servicer,
     but only to the extent of the amount permitted to be withdrawn from the
     Collection Account in accordance with the related Agreement, the Servicing
     Fee, if any, in respect of the related Primary Asset;
 
          (iv) All proceeds under any title insurance, hazard insurance or other
     insurance policy covering any such Primary Asset, other than proceeds to be
     applied to the restoration or repair of the related Property or released to
     the obligor in accordance with the related Agreement;
 
          (v) All amounts required to be deposited therein from any applicable
     Reserve Fund for such Series pursuant to the related Agreement;
 
          (vi) All Advances made by the Servicer required pursuant to the
     related Agreement; and
 
          (vii) All repurchase prices of any such Primary Assets repurchased by
     the Depositor, the Servicer or the Seller pursuant to the related
     Agreement.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer is permitted, from time to time, to make withdrawals from the
Collection Account for each Series for the following purposes:
 
          (i) to reimburse itself for Advances for such Series made by it
     pursuant to the related Agreement; the Servicer's right to reimburse itself
     is limited to amounts received on or in respect of particular Loans
     (including, for this purpose, Liquidation Proceeds and amounts representing
     proceeds of insurance policies covering the related Property) which
     represent late recoveries of Scheduled Payments respecting which any such
     Advance was made;
 
          (ii) to the extent provided in the related Agreement, to reimburse
     itself for any Advances for such Series that the Servicer determines in
     good faith it will be unable to recover from amounts representing late
     recoveries of Scheduled Payments respecting which such Advance was made or
     from Liquidation Proceeds or the proceeds of insurance policies;
 
          (iii) to reimburse itself from Liquidation Proceeds for liquidation
     expenses and for amounts expended by it in good faith in connection with
     the restoration of damaged Property and, in the event deposited in the
     Collection Account and not previously withheld, and to the extent that
     Liquidation Proceeds after such reimbursement exceed the outstanding
     principal balance of the related Loan, together with accrued and unpaid
     interest thereon to the Due Date for such Loan next succeeding the date of
     its receipt of such Liquidation Proceeds, to pay to itself out of such
     excess the amount of any unpaid Servicing Fee and any assumption fees, late
     payment charges, or other charges on the related Loan;
 
          (iv) in the event it has elected not to pay itself the Servicing Fee
     out of the interest component of any Scheduled Payment, late payment or
     other recovery with respect to a particular Loan prior to the deposit of
     such Scheduled Payment, late payment or recovery into the Collection
     Account, to pay to itself the Servicing Fee, as adjusted pursuant to the
     related Agreement, from any such Scheduled Payment, late payment or such
     other recovery, to the extent permitted by the related Agreement;
 
          (v) to reimburse itself for expenses incurred by and recoverable by or
     reimbursable to it pursuant to the related Agreement;
 
          (vi) to pay to the applicable person with respect to each Primary
     Asset or REO Property acquired in respect thereof that has been repurchased
     or removed from the Trust Fund by the Depositor, the Servicer or the Seller
     pursuant to the related Agreement, all amounts received thereon and not
     distributed as of the date on which the related repurchase price was
     determined;
 
          (vii) to make payments to the Trustee of such Series for deposit into
     the Distribution Account, if any, or for remittance to the Holders of such
     Series in the amounts and in the manner provided for in the related
     Agreement; and
 
                                       32
<PAGE>
          (viii) to clear and terminate the Collection Account pursuant to the
     related Agreement.
 
     In addition, if the Servicer deposits in the Collection Account for a
Series any amount not required to be deposited therein, it may, at any time,
withdraw such amount from such Collection Account.
 
ADVANCES AND LIMITATIONS THEREON
 
     The related Prospectus Supplement will describe the circumstances, if any,
under which the Servicer will make Advances with respect to delinquent payments
on Loans. If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will
be obligated to make Advances, and such obligation may be limited in amount, or
may not be activated until a certain portion of a specified Reserve Fund is
depleted. Advances are intended to provide liquidity and, except to the extent
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, not to guarantee or insure
against losses. Accordingly, any funds advanced are recoverable by the Servicer
out of amounts received on particular Loans which represent late recoveries of
principal or interest, proceeds of insurance policies or Liquidation Proceeds
respecting which any such Advance was made. If an Advance is made and
subsequently determined to be nonrecoverable from late collections, proceeds of
insurance policies, or Liquidation Proceeds from the related Loan, the Servicer
may be entitled to reimbursement from other funds in the Collection Account or
Distribution Account, as the case may be, or from a specified Reserve Fund as
applicable, to the extent specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
MAINTENANCE OF INSURANCE POLICIES AND OTHER SERVICING PROCEDURES
 
     Standard Hazard Insurance; Flood Insurance.  Except as otherwise specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will be required to maintain
or to cause the obligor on each Loan to maintain a standard hazard insurance
policy providing coverage of the standard form of fire insurance with extended
coverage for certain other hazards as is customary in the state in which the
related Property is located. The standard hazard insurance policies will provide
for coverage at least equal to the applicable state standard form of fire
insurance policy with extended coverage for property of the type securing the
related Loans. In general, the standard form of fire and extended coverage
policy will cover physical damage to or destruction of, the related Property
caused by fire, lightning, explosion, smoke, windstorm, hail, riot, strike and
civil commotion, subject to the conditions and exclusions particularized in each
policy. Because the standard hazard insurance policies relating to the Loans
will be underwritten by different hazard insurers and will cover Properties
located in various states, such policies will not contain identical terms and
conditions. The basic terms, however, generally will be determined by state law
and generally will be similar. Most such policies typically will not cover any
physical damage resulting from war, revolution, governmental actions, floods and
other water-related causes, earth movement (including earthquakes, landslides
and mudflows), nuclear reaction, wet or dry rot, vermin, rodents, insects or
domestic animals, theft and, in certain cases, vandalism. The foregoing list is
merely indicative of certain kinds of uninsured risks and is not intended to be
all inclusive. Uninsured risks not covered by a special hazard insurance policy
or other form of Enhancement will adversely affect distributions to Holders.
When a Property securing a Loan is located in a flood area identified by HUD
pursuant to the Flood Disaster Protection Act of 1973, as amended, the Servicer
will be required to cause flood insurance to be maintained with respect to such
Property, to the extent available.
 
     The standard hazard insurance policies covering Properties securing Loans
typically will contain a 'coinsurance' clause which, in effect, will require the
insured at all times to carry hazard insurance of a specified percentage
(generally 80% to 90%) of the full replacement value of the Property, including
the improvements on any Property, in order to recover the full amount of any
partial loss. If the insured's coverage falls below this specified percentage,
such clause will provide that the hazard insurer's liability in the event of
partial loss will not exceed the greater of (i) the actual cash value (the
replacement cost less physical depreciation) of the Property, including the
improvements, if any, damaged or destroyed or (ii) such proportion of the loss,
without deduction for depreciation, as the amount of insurance carried bears to
the specified percentage of the full replacement cost of such Property and
improvements. Since the amount of hazard insurance to be maintained on the
improvements securing the Loans declines as the principal balances owing thereon
decrease, and since the value of the Properties will fluctuate in value over
time, the effect of this requirement in the event of partial loss may be that
hazard insurance proceeds will be insufficient to restore fully the damage to
the affected Property.
 
                                       33
<PAGE>
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, coverage
will be in an amount at least equal to the greater of (i) the amount necessary
to avoid the enforcement of any co-insurance clause contained in the policy or
(ii) the outstanding principal balance of the related Loan. Unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will also maintain
on REO Property that secured a defaulted Loan and that has been acquired upon
foreclosure, deed in lieu of foreclosure, or repossession, a standard hazard
insurance policy in an amount that is at least equal to the maximum insurable
value of such REO Property. No earthquake or other additional insurance will be
required of any obligor or will be maintained on REO Property acquired in
respect of a defaulted Loan, other than pursuant to such applicable laws and
regulations as shall at any time be in force and shall require such additional
insurance.
 
     Any amounts collected by the Servicer under any such policies of insurance
(other than amounts to be applied to the restoration or repair of the Property,
released to the obligor in accordance with normal servicing procedures or used
to reimburse the Servicer for amounts to which it is entitled to reimbursement)
will be deposited in the Collection Account. In the event that the Servicer
obtains and maintains a blanket policy insuring against hazard losses on all of
the Loans, written by an insurer then acceptable to each Rating Agency which
assigns a rating to such Series, it will conclusively be deemed to have
satisfied its obligations to cause to be maintained a standard hazard insurance
policy for each Loan or related REO Property. This blanket policy may contain a
deductible clause, in which case the Servicer will be required, in the event
that there has been a loss that would have been covered by such policy absent
such deductible clause, to deposit in the Collection Account the amount not
otherwise payable under the blanket policy because of the application of such
deductible clause.
 
REALIZATION UPON DEFAULTED LOANS
 
     The Servicer will use its reasonable best efforts to foreclose upon,
repossess or otherwise comparably convert the ownership of the Properties
securing the related Loans as come into and continue in default and as to which
no satisfactory arrangements can be made for collection of delinquent payments.
In connection with such foreclosure or other conversion, the Servicer will
follow such practices and procedures as it deems necessary or advisable and as
are normal and usual in its servicing activities with respect to comparable
loans serviced by it. However, the Servicer will not be required to expend its
own funds in connection with any foreclosure or towards the restoration of the
Property unless it determines that (i) such restoration or foreclosure will
increase the Liquidation Proceeds in respect of the related Loan available to
the Holders after reimbursement to itself for such expenses and (ii) such
expenses will be recoverable by it either through Liquidation Proceeds or the
proceeds of insurance. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, in the
case of a Trust Fund for which a REMIC election has been made, the Servicer will
be required to liquidate any Property acquired through foreclosure within two
years after the acquisition of the beneficial ownership of such Property. While
the holder of a Property acquired through foreclosure can often maximize its
recovery by providing financing to a new purchaser, the Trust Fund, if
applicable, will have no ability to do so and neither the Servicer nor the
Depositor will be required to do so.
 
     The Servicer may arrange with the obligor on a defaulted Loan a
modification of such Loan (a 'Modification') to the extent provided in the
related Prospectus Supplement. Such Modifications may only be entered into if
they meet the underwriting policies and procedures employed by the Servicer in
servicing receivables for its own account and meet the other conditions set
forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
ENFORCEMENT OF DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a
Series, when any Property is about to be conveyed by the obligor, the Servicer
will, to the extent it has knowledge of such prospective conveyance and prior to
the time of the consummation of such conveyance, exercise its rights to
accelerate the maturity of the related Loan under the applicable 'due-on-sale'
clause, if any, unless it reasonably believes that such clause is not
enforceable under applicable law or if the enforcement of such clause would
result in loss of coverage under any primary mortgage insurance policy. In such
event, the Servicer is authorized to accept from or enter into an assumption
agreement with the person to whom such property has been or is about to be
conveyed, pursuant to which such person becomes liable under the Loan and
pursuant to which the original obligor is released from liability and such
person is substituted as the obligor and becomes liable under the Loan. Any fee
collected in
 
                                       34
<PAGE>
connection with an assumption will be retained by the Servicer as additional
servicing compensation. The terms of a Loan may not be changed in connection
with an assumption.
 
SERVICING COMPENSATION AND PAYMENT OF EXPENSES
 
     Except as otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer will be entitled to a periodic fee as servicing compensation (the
'Servicing Fee') in an amount to be determined as specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement. The Servicing Fee may be fixed or variable, as specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement. In addition, unless otherwise specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Servicer will be entitled to servicing
compensation in the form of assumption fees, late payment charges and similar
items, or excess proceeds following disposition of Property in connection with
defaulted Loans.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer will pay certain expenses incurred in connection with the servicing of
the Loans, including, without limitation, the payment of the fees and expenses
of the Trustee and independent accountants, payment of insurance policy premiums
and the cost of credit support, if any, and payment of expenses incurred in
preparation of reports to Holders.
 
     When an obligor makes a principal prepayment in full between Due Dates on
the related Loan, the obligor will generally be required to pay interest on the
amount prepaid only to the date of prepayment. If and to the extent provided in
the related Prospectus Supplement in order that one or more Classes of the
Holders of a Series will not be adversely affected by any resulting shortfall in
interest, the amount of the Servicing Fee may be reduced to the extent necessary
to include in the Servicer's remittance to the Trustee for deposit into the
Distribution Account an amount equal to one month's interest on the related Loan
(less the Servicing Fee). If the aggregate amount of such shortfalls in a month
exceeds the Servicing Fee for such month, a shortfall to Holders may occur.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement for certain expenses incurred by it
in connection with the liquidation of defaulted Loans. The related Holders will
suffer no loss by reason of such expenses to the extent expenses are covered
under related insurance policies or from excess Liquidation Proceeds. If claims
are either not made or paid under the applicable insurance policies or if
coverage thereunder has been exhausted, the related Holders will suffer a loss
to the extent that Liquidation Proceeds, after reimbursement of the Servicer's
expenses, are less than the outstanding principal balance of and unpaid interest
on the related Loan which would be distributable to Holders. In addition, the
Servicer will be entitled to reimbursement of expenditures incurred by it in
connection with the restoration of property securing a defaulted Loan, such
right of reimbursement being prior to the rights of the Holders to receive any
related proceeds of insurance policies, Liquidation Proceeds or amounts derived
from other Enhancement. The Servicer is generally also entitled to reimbursement
from the Collection Account for Advances.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the rights
of the Servicer to receive funds from the Collection Account for a Series,
whether as the Servicing Fee or other compensation, or for the reimbursement of
Advances, expenses or otherwise, are not subordinate to the rights of Holders of
such Series.
 
EVIDENCE AS TO COMPLIANCE
 
     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the applicable
Agreement for each Series will provide that each year, a firm of independent
public accountants will furnish a statement to the Trustee to the effect that
such firm has examined certain documents and records relating to the servicing
of the Loans by the Servicer and that, on the basis of such examination, such
firm is of the opinion that the servicing has been conducted in compliance with
such Agreement, except for (i) such exceptions as such firm believes to be
immaterial and (ii) such other exceptions as are set forth in such statement.
 
     If so specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the applicable
Agreement for each Series will also provide for delivery to the Trustee for such
Series of an annual statement signed by an officer of the Servicer to the effect
that the Servicer has fulfilled its obligations under such Agreement throughout
the preceding calendar year.
 
                                       35
<PAGE>
CERTAIN MATTERS REGARDING THE SERVICER
 
     The Servicer for each Series will be identified in the related Prospectus
Supplement. The Servicer may be an affiliate of the Depositor and may have other
business relationships with the Depositor and its affiliates.
 
     If an Event of Default occurs under either a Servicing Agreement or a
Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Servicer may be replaced by the Trustee or
a successor Servicer. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, such Events of Default and the rights of the Trustee upon such a
default under the Agreement for the related Series will be substantially similar
to those described under 'THE AGREEMENTS-- Events of Default; Rights Upon Events
of Default--Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Servicing Agreement' herein.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Servicer does not have the right to assign its rights and delegate its duties
and obligations under the related Agreement for each Series unless the successor
Servicer accepting such assignment or delegation (i) services similar loans in
the ordinary course of its business, (ii) is reasonably satisfactory to the
Trustee for the related Series, (iii) has a net worth of not less than the
amount specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, (iv) would not cause any
Rating Agency's rating of the Securities for such Series in effect immediately
prior to such assignment, sale or transfer to be qualified, downgraded or
withdrawn as a result of such assignment, sale or transfer and (v) executes and
delivers to the Trustee an agreement, in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to the Trustee, which contains an assumption by such Servicer of
the due and punctual performance and observance of each covenant and condition
to be performed or observed by the Servicer under the related Agreement from and
after the date of such agreement. No such assignment will become effective until
the Trustee or a successor Servicer has assumed the servicer's obligations and
duties under the related Agreement. To the extent that the Servicer transfers
its obligations to a wholly-owned subsidiary or affiliate, such subsidiary or
affiliate need not satisfy the criteria set forth above; however, in such
instance, the assigning Servicer will remain liable for the servicing
obligations under the related Agreement. Any entity into which the Servicer is
merged or consolidated or any successor corporation resulting from any merger,
conversion or consolidation will succeed to the Servicer's obligations under the
related Agreement provided that such successor or surviving entity meets the
requirements for a successor Servicer set forth above.
 
     Except to the extent otherwise provided therein, each Agreement will
provide that neither the Servicer, nor any director, officer, employee or agent
of the Servicer, will be under any liability to the related Trust Fund, the
Depositor or the Holders for any action taken or for failing to take any action
in good faith pursuant to the related Agreement, or for errors in judgment;
provided, however, that neither the Servicer nor any such person will be
protected against any breach of warranty or representations made under such
Agreement or the failure to perform its obligations in compliance with any
standard of care set forth in such Agreement, or liability which would otherwise
be imposed by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or negligence in the
performance of their duties or by reason of reckless disregard of their
obligations and duties thereunder. Each Agreement will further provide that the
Servicer and any director, officer, employee or agent of the Servicer is
entitled to indemnification from the related Trust Fund and will be held
harmless against any loss, liability or expense incurred in connection with any
legal action relating to the Agreement or the Securities, other than any loss,
liability or expense incurred by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith or
negligence in the performance of duties thereunder or by reason of reckless
disregard of obligations and duties thereunder. In addition, the related
Agreement will provide that the Servicer is not under any obligation to appear
in, prosecute or defend any legal action which is not incidental to its
servicing responsibilities under such Agreement which, in its opinion, may
involve it in any expense or liability. The Servicer may, in its discretion,
undertake any such action which it may deem necessary or desirable with respect
to the related Agreement and the rights and duties of the parties thereto and
the interests of the Holders thereunder. In such event the legal expenses and
costs of such action and any liability resulting therefrom may be expenses,
costs, and liabilities of the Trust Fund and the Servicer may be entitled to be
reimbursed therefor out of the Collection Account.
 
                                       36
<PAGE>
                                 THE AGREEMENTS
 
     The following summaries describe certain provisions of the Agreements. The
summaries do not purport to be complete and are subject to, and qualified in
their entirety by reference to, the provisions of the Agreements. Where
particular provisions or terms used in the Agreements are referred to, such
provisions or terms are as specified in the related Agreements.
 
ASSIGNMENT OF PRIMARY ASSETS
 
     General.  At the time of issuance of the Securities of a Series, the
Depositor will transfer, convey and assign to the Trust Fund all right, title
and interest of the Depositor in the Primary Assets and other property to be
transferred to the Trust Fund for a Series. Such assignment will include all
principal and interest due on or with respect to the Primary Assets after the
Cut-off Date specified in the related Prospectus Supplement (except for any
Retained Interests). The Trustee will, concurrently with such assignment,
execute and deliver the Securities.
 
     Assignment of Loans.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Depositor will, as to each Loan, deliver or cause to be
delivered to the Trustee, or, as specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
a custodian on behalf of the Trustee (the 'Custodian'), the Mortgage Note
endorsed without recourse to the order of the Trustee or in blank, the original
Mortgage with evidence of recording indicated thereon (except for any Mortgage
not returned from the public recording office, in which case a copy of such
Mortgage will be delivered, together with a certificate that the original of
such Mortgage was delivered to such recording office) and an assignment of the
Mortgage in recordable form. The Trustee, or, if so specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Custodian, will hold such documents in trust for the
benefit of the Holders.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Depositor will as to each Home Improvement Contract deliver or cause to be
delivered to the Trustee (or the Custodian) the original Home Improvement
Contract and copies of documents and instruments related to each Home
Improvement Contract and, other than in the case of unsecured Home Improvement
Contracts, the security interest in the property securing such Home Improvement
Contract. In order to give notice of the right, title and interest of
Securityholders to the Home Improvement Contracts, the Depositor will cause a
UCC-1 financing statement to be executed by the Depositor or the Seller
identifying the Trustee as the secured party and identifying all Home
Improvement Contracts as collateral. Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Home Improvement Contracts will not be stamped or
otherwise marked to reflect their assignment to the Trust. Therefore, if,
through negligence, fraud or otherwise, a subsequent purchaser were able to take
physical possession of the Home Improvement Contracts without notice of such
assignment, the interest of Securityholders in the Home Improvement Contracts
could be defeated. See 'CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF THE LOANS--The Home Improvement
Contracts.'
 
     With respect to Loans secured by Mortgages, if so specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor will, at the time of issuance of the
Securities, cause assignments to the Trustee of the Mortgages relating to the
Loans for a Series to be recorded in the appropriate public office for real
property records, except in states where, in the opinion of counsel acceptable
to the Trustee, such recording is not required to protect the Trustee's interest
in the related Loans. If specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Depositor will cause such assignments to be so recorded within the time after
issuance of the Securities as is specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
in which event, the Agreement may, as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, require the Depositor to repurchase from the Trustee any Loan the
related Mortgage of which is not recorded within such time, at the price
described below with respect to repurchases by reason of defective
documentation. Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement,
the enforcement of the repurchase obligation would constitute the sole remedy
available to the Holders or the Trustee for the failure of a Mortgage to be
recorded.
 
     Each Loan will be identified in a schedule appearing as an exhibit to the
related Agreement (the 'Loan Schedule'). Such Loan Schedule will specify with
respect to each Loan: the original principal amount and unpaid principal balance
as of the Cut-off Date; the current interest rate; the current Scheduled Payment
of principal and interest; the maturity date, if any, of the related Mortgage
Note; if the Loan is an adjustable rate Loan, the Lifetime Rate Cap, if any, and
the current index.
 
                                       37
<PAGE>
     Assignment of Private Securities.  The Depositor will cause Private
Securities to be registered in the name of the Trustee (or its nominee or
correspondent). The Trustee (or its nominee or correspondent) will have
possession of any certificated Private Securities. Unless otherwise specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee will not be in possession of or
be assignee of record of any underlying assets for a Private Security. See 'THE
TRUST FUNDS--Private Securities' herein. Each Private Security will be
identified in a schedule appearing as an exhibit to the related Agreement (the
'Certificate Schedule'), which will specify the original principal amount,
outstanding principal balance as of the Cut-off Date, annual pass-through rate
or interest rate and maturity date for each Private Security conveyed to the
Trust Fund. In the Agreement, the Depositor will represent and warrant to the
Trustee regarding the Private Securities: (i) that the information contained in
the Certificate Schedule is true and correct in all material respects; (ii)
that, immediately prior to the conveyance of the Private Securities, the
Depositor had good title thereto, and was the sole owner thereof (subject to any
Retained Interest); (iii) that there has been no other sale by it of such
Private Securities; and (iv) that there is no existing lien, charge, security
interest or other encumbrance (other than any Retained Interest) on such Private
Securities.
 
     Repurchase and Substitution of Non-Conforming Primary Assets.  Unless
otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, if any document in the
file relating to the Primary Assets delivered by the Depositor to the Trustee
(or Custodian) is found by the Trustee within 90 days of the execution of the
related Agreement (or promptly after the Trustee's receipt of any document
permitted to be delivered after the Closing Date) to be defective in any
material respect and the Depositor or Seller does not cure such defect within 90
days, or within such other period specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the Depositor or Seller will, not later than 90 days or within such
other period specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, after the Trustee's
notice to the Depositor or the Seller, as the case may be, of the defect,
repurchase the related Primary Asset or any property acquired in respect thereof
from the Trustee at a price equal to, unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, (a) the lesser of (i) the outstanding principal balance
of such Primary Asset and (ii) the Trust Fund's federal income tax basis in the
Primary Asset and (b) accrued and unpaid interest to the date of the next
scheduled payment on such Primary Asset at the rate set forth in the related
Agreement, provided, however, the purchase price shall not be limited in (i)
above to the Trust Fund's federal income tax basis if the repurchase at a price
equal to the outstanding principal balance of such Primary Asset will not result
in any prohibited transaction tax under Section 860F(a) of the Code.
 
      If provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Depositor or Seller,
as the case may be, may, rather than repurchase the Primary Asset as described
above, remove such Primary Asset from the Trust Fund (the 'Deleted Primary
Asset') and substitute in its place one or more other Primary Assets (each, a
'Qualifying Substitute Primary Asset') provided, however, that (i) with respect
to a Trust Fund for which no REMIC election is made, such substitution must be
effected within 120 days of the date of initial issuance of the Securities and
(ii) with respect to a Trust Fund for which a REMIC election is made, after a
specified time period, the Trustee must have received a satisfactory opinion of
counsel that such substitution will not cause the Trust Fund to lose its status
as a REMIC or otherwise subject the Trust Fund to a prohibited transaction tax.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, any
Qualifying Substitute Primary Asset will have, on the date of substitution, (i)
an outstanding principal balance, after deduction of all Scheduled Payments due
in the month of substitution, not in excess of the outstanding principal balance
of the Deleted Primary Asset (the amount of any shortfall to be deposited to the
Collection Account in the month of substitution for distribution to Holders),
(ii) an interest rate not less than (and not more than 2% greater than) the
interest rate of the Deleted Primary Asset, (iii) a remaining term-to-stated
maturity not greater than (and not more than two years less than) that of the
Deleted Primary Asset, and will comply with all of the representations and
warranties set forth in the applicable Agreement as of the date of substitution.
 
     Unless otherwise provided in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
above-described cure, repurchase or substitution obligations constitute the sole
remedies available to the Holders or the Trustee for a material defect in a
document for a Primary Asset.
 
     The Depositor or another entity will make representations and warranties
with respect to Primary Assets for a Series. If the Depositor or such entity
cannot cure a breach of any such representations and warranties in all material
respects within the time period specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
after notification by the
 
                                       38
<PAGE>
Trustee of such breach, and if such breach is of a nature that materially and
adversely affects the value of such Primary Asset, the Depositor or such entity
is obligated to repurchase the affected Primary Asset or, if provided in the
related Prospectus Supplement, provide a Qualifying Substitute Primary Asset
therefor, subject to the same conditions and limitations on purchases and
substitutions as described above.
 
     The Depositor's only source of funds to effect any cure, repurchase or
substitution will be through the enforcement of the corresponding obligations,
if any, of the responsible originator or Seller of such Primary Assets. See
'SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS--Limited Assets.'
 
     No Holder of Securities of a Series, solely by virtue of such Holder's
status as a Holder, will have any right under the applicable Agreement for such
Series to institute any proceeding with respect to such Agreement, unless such
Holder previously has given to the Trustee for such Series written notice of
default and unless the Holders of Securities evidencing not less than 51% of the
aggregate voting rights of the Securities for such Series have made written
request upon the Trustee to institute such proceeding in its own name as Trustee
thereunder and have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity, and the Trustee
for 60 days has neglected or refused to institute any such proceeding.
 
REPORTS TO HOLDERS
 
     The Trustee or other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
will prepare and forward to each Holder on each Distribution Date, or as soon
thereafter as is practicable, a statement setting forth, to the extent
applicable to any Series, among other things:
 
       (i) the amount of principal distributed to Holders of the related
           Securities and the outstanding principal balance of such Securities
           following such distribution;
 
      (ii) the amount of interest distributed to Holders of the related
           Securities and the current interest on such Securities;
 
      (iii) the amounts of (a) any overdue accrued interest included in such
            distribution, (b) any remaining overdue accrued interest with
            respect to such Securities or (c) any current shortfall in amounts
            to be distributed as accrued interest to Holders of such Securities;
 
      (iv) the amounts of (a) any overdue payments of scheduled principal
           included in such distribution, (b) any remaining overdue principal
           amounts with respect to such Securities, (c) any current shortfall in
           receipt of scheduled principal payments on the related Primary Assets
           or (d) any realized losses or Liquidation Proceeds to be allocated as
           reductions in the outstanding principal balances of such Securities;
 
       (v) the amount received under any related Enhancement, and the remaining
           amount available under such Enhancement;
 
      (vi) the amount of any delinquencies with respect to payments on the
           related Primary Assets;
 
      (vii) the book value of any REO Property acquired by the related Trust
            Fund; and
 
     (viii) such other information as specified in the related Agreement.
 
     In addition, within a reasonable period of time after the end of each
calendar year the Trustee, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, will furnish to each Holder of record at any time during such
calendar year (a) the aggregate of amounts reported pursuant to (i), (ii), and
(iv)(d) above for such calendar year and (b) such information specified in the
related Agreement to enable Holders to prepare their tax returns including,
without limitation, the amount of original issue discount accrued on the
Securities, if applicable. Information in the Distribution Date and annual
statements provided to the Holders will not have been examined and reported upon
by an independent public accountant. However, the Servicer will provide to the
Trustee a report by independent public accountants with respect to the
Servicer's servicing of the Loans. See 'SERVICING OF LOANS--Evidence as to
Compliance' herein.
 
     If so specified in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities,
such Series or one or more Classes of such Series will be issued in book-entry
form. In such event, owners of beneficial interests in such Securities will
 
                                       39
<PAGE>
not be considered Holders and will not receive such reports directly from the
Trustee. The Trustee will forward such reports only to the entity or its nominee
which is the registered holder of the global certificate which evidences such
book-entry securities. Beneficial owners will receive such reports from the
participants and indirect participants of the applicable book-entry system in
accordance with the practices and procedures of such entities.
 
EVENTS OF DEFAULT; RIGHTS UPON EVENT OF DEFAULT
 
     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Servicing Agreement.  Unless otherwise
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Events of Default under the
Pooling and Servicing Agreement for each Series of Certificates relating to
Loans include (i) any failure by the Servicer to deposit amounts in the
Collection Account and Distribution Account to enable the Trustee to distribute
to Holders of such Series any required payment, which failure continues
unremedied for the number of days specified in the related Prospectus Supplement
after the giving of written notice of such failure to the Servicer by the
Trustee for such Series, or to the Servicer and the Trustee by the Holders of
such Series evidencing not less than 25% of the aggregate voting rights of the
Securities for such Series, (ii) any failure by the Servicer duly to observe or
perform in any material respect any other of its covenants or agreements in the
applicable Agreement which continues unremedied for the number of days specified
in the related Prospectus Supplement after the giving of written notice of such
failure to the Servicer by the Trustee, or to the Servicer and the Trustee by
the Holders of such Series evidencing not less than 25% of the aggregate voting
rights of the Securities for such Series, and (iii) certain events of
insolvency, readjustment of debt, marshalling of assets and liabilities or
similar proceedings and certain actions by the Servicer indicating its
insolvency, reorganization or inability to pay its obligations.
 
     So long as an Event of Default remains unremedied under the applicable
Agreement for a Series of Securities relating to the servicing of Loans, unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the Trustee for such
Series or Holders of Securities of such Series evidencing not less than 51% of
the aggregate voting rights of the Securities for such Series may terminate all
of the rights and obligations of the Servicer as servicer under the applicable
Agreement (other than its right to recovery of other expenses and amounts
advanced pursuant to the terms of such Agreement which rights the Servicer will
retain under all circumstances), whereupon the Trustee will succeed to all the
responsibilities, duties and liabilities of the Servicer under such Agreement
and will be entitled to reasonable servicing compensation not to exceed the
applicable servicing fee, together with other servicing compensation in the form
of assumption fees, late payment charges or otherwise as provided in such
Agreement.
 
     In the event that the Trustee is unwilling or unable so to act, it may
select, or petition a court of competent jurisdiction to appoint, a finance
institution, bank or loan servicing institution with a net worth specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement to act as successor Servicer under the
provisions of the applicable Agreement. The successor Servicer would be entitled
to reasonable servicing compensation in an amount not to exceed the Servicing
Fee as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement, together with the other
servicing compensation in the form of assumption fees, late payment charges or
otherwise, as provided in such Agreement.
 
     During the continuance of any Event of Default of a Servicer under an
Agreement for a Series of Securities, the Trustee for such Series will have the
right to take action to enforce its rights and remedies and to protect and
enforce the rights and remedies of the Holders of such Series, and, unless
otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, Holders of Securities
evidencing not less than 51% of the aggregate voting rights of the Securities
for such Series may direct the time, method and place of conducting any
proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or
power conferred upon that Trustee. However, the Trustee will not be under any
obligation to pursue any such remedy or to exercise any of such trusts or powers
unless such Holders have offered the Trustee reasonable security or indemnity
against the cost, expenses and liabilities which may be incurred by the Trustee
therein or thereby. The Trustee may decline to follow any such direction if the
Trustee determines that the action or proceeding so directed may not lawfully be
taken or would involve it in personal liability or be unjustly prejudicial to
the nonassenting Holders.
 
     Indenture.  Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, Events of Default under the Indenture for each Series of Notes
include: (i) a default for thirty (30) days or more in the payment of any
principal of or interest on any Note of such Series; (ii) failure to perform any
other covenant of the Depositor or
 
                                       40
<PAGE>
the Trust Fund in the Indenture which continues for a period of sixty (60) days
after notice thereof is given in accordance with the procedures described in the
related Prospectus Supplement; (iii) any representation or warranty made by the
Depositor or the Trust Fund in the Indenture or in any certificate or other
writing delivered pursuant thereto or in connection therewith with respect to or
affecting such Series having been incorrect in a material respect as of the time
made, and such breach is not cured within sixty (60) days after notice thereof
is given in accordance with the procedures described in the related Prospectus
Supplement; (iv) certain events of bankruptcy, insolvency, receivership or
liquidation of the Depositor or the Trust Fund; or (v) any other Event of
Default provided with respect to Notes of that Series.
 
     If an Event of Default with respect to the Notes of any Series at the time
outstanding occurs and is continuing, either the Trustee or the Holders of a
majority of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series
may declare the principal amount (or, if the Notes of that Series are Zero
Coupon Securities, such portion of the principal amount as may be specified in
the terms of that Series, as provided in the related Prospectus Supplement) of
all the Notes of such Series to be due and payable immediately. Such declaration
may, under certain circumstances, be rescinded and annulled by the Holders of a
majority in aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series.
 
     If, following an Event of Default with respect to any Series of Notes, the
Notes of such Series have been declared to be due and payable, the Trustee may,
in its discretion, notwithstanding such acceleration, elect to maintain
possession of the collateral securing the Notes of such Series and to continue
to apply distributions on such collateral as if there had been no declaration of
acceleration if such collateral continues to provide sufficient funds for the
payment of principal of and interest on the Notes of such Series as they would
have become due if there had not been such a declaration. In addition, the
Trustee may not sell or otherwise liquidate the collateral securing the Notes of
a Series following an Event of Default other than a default in the payment of
any principal or interest on any Note of such Series for thirty (30) days or
more, unless (a) the Holders of 100% of the then aggregate outstanding amount of
the Notes of such Series consent to such sale, (b) the proceeds of such sale or
liquidation are sufficient to pay in full the principal of and accrued interest
due and unpaid on the outstanding Notes of such Series at the date of such sale
or (c) the Trustee determines that such collateral would not be sufficient on an
ongoing basis to make all payments on such Notes as such payments would have
become due if such Notes had not been declared due and payable, and the Trustee
obtains the consent of the Holders of 66 2/3% of the then aggregate outstanding
amount of the Notes of such Series.
 
     In the event that the Trustee liquidates the collateral in connection with
an Event of Default involving a default for thirty (30) days or more in the
payment of principal of or interest on the Notes of a Series, the Indenture
provides that the Trustee will have a prior lien on the proceeds of any such
liquidation for unpaid fees and expenses. As a result, upon the occurrence of
such an Event of Default, the amount available for distribution to the
Noteholders may be less than would otherwise be the case. However, the Trustee
may not institute a proceeding for the enforcement of its lien except in
connection with a proceeding for the enforcement of the lien of the Indenture
for the benefit of the Noteholders after the occurrence of such an Event of
Default.
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, in the
event the principal of the Notes of a Series is declared due and payable, as
described above, the Holders of any such Notes issued at a discount from par may
be entitled to receive no more than an amount equal to the unpaid principal
amount thereof less the amount of such discount which is unamortized.
 
     Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the
Trustee, in case an Event of Default shall occur and be continuing with respect
to a Series of Notes, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of
the rights or powers under the Indenture at the request or direction of any of
the Holders of Notes of such Series, unless such Holders offered to the Trustee
security or indemnity satisfactory to it against the costs, expenses and
liabilities which might be incurred by it in complying with such request or
direction. Subject to such provisions for indemnification and certain
limitations contained in the Indenture, the Holders of a majority of the then
aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series shall have the right to
direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy
available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on the
Trustee with respect to the Notes of such Series, and the Holders of a majority
of the then aggregate outstanding amount of the Notes of such Series may, in
certain cases, waive any default with respect thereto, except a default in the
payment of principal or interest or a default in respect of a covenant or
provision
 
                                       41
<PAGE>
of the Indenture that cannot be modified without the waiver or consent of all
the Holders of the outstanding Notes of such Series affected thereby.
 
THE TRUSTEE
 
     The identity of the commercial bank, savings and loan association or trust
company named as the Trustee for each Series of Securities will be set forth in
the related Prospectus Supplement. The entity serving as Trustee may have normal
banking relationships with the Depositor or the Servicer. In addition, for the
purpose of meeting the legal requirements of certain local jurisdictions, the
Trustee will have the power to appoint co-trustees or separate trustees of all
or any part of the Trust Fund relating to a Series of Securities. In the event
of such appointment, all rights, powers, duties and obligations conferred or
imposed upon the Trustee by the Agreement relating to such Series will be
conferred or imposed upon the Trustee and each such separate trustee or
co-trustee jointly, or, in any jurisdiction in which the Trustee shall be
incompetent or unqualified to perform certain acts, singly upon such separate
trustee or co-trustee who will exercise and perform such rights, powers, duties
and obligations solely at the direction of the Trustee. The Trustee may also
appoint agents to perform any of the responsibilities of the Trustee, which
agents will have any or all of the rights, powers, duties and obligations of the
Trustee conferred on them by such appointment; provided that the Trustee will
continue to be responsible for its duties and obligations under the Agreement.
 
DUTIES OF THE TRUSTEE
 
     The Trustee will not make any representations as to the validity or
sufficiency of the Agreement, the Securities or of any Primary Asset or related
documents. If no Event of Default (as defined in the related Agreement) has
occurred, the Trustee is required to perform only those duties specifically
required of it under the Agreement. Upon receipt of the various certificates,
statements, reports or other instruments required to be furnished to it, the
Trustee is required to examine them to determine whether they are in the form
required by the related Agreement. However, the Trustee will not be responsible
for the accuracy or content of any such documents furnished to it by the Holders
or the Servicer under the Agreement.
 
     The Trustee may be held liable for its own negligent action or failure to
act, or for its own misconduct; provided, however, that the Trustee will not be
personally liable with respect to any action taken, suffered or omitted to be
taken by it in good faith in accordance with the direction of the Holders in an
Event of Default. The Trustee is not required to expend or risk its own funds or
otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of any of its duties
under the Agreement, or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers, if it
has reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate
indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it.
 
RESIGNATION OF TRUSTEE
 
     The Trustee may, upon written notice to the Depositor, resign at any time,
in which event the Depositor will be obligated to use its best efforts to
appoint a successor Trustee. If no successor Trustee has been appointed and has
accepted the appointment within 30 days after the giving of such notice of
resignation, the resigning Trustee may petition any court of competent
jurisdiction for appointment of a successor Trustee. The Trustee may also be
removed at any time (i) if the Trustee ceases to be eligible to continue as such
under the Agreement, (ii) if the Trustee becomes insolvent or (iii) by the
Holders of Securities evidencing over 50% of the aggregate voting rights of the
Securities in the Trust Fund upon written notice to the Trustee and to the
Depositor. Any resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a
successor Trustee will not become effective until acceptance of the appointment
by the successor Trustee.
 
AMENDMENT OF AGREEMENT
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the Agreement for
each Series of Securities may be amended by the Depositor, the Servicer (with
respect to a Series relating to Loans), and the Trustee with respect to such
Series, without notice to or consent of the Holders (i) to cure any ambiguity,
(ii) to correct any defective provisions or to correct or supplement any
provision therein, (iii) to add to the duties of the Depositor, the Trust Fund
or Servicer, (iv) to add any other provisions with respect to matters or
questions arising under
 
                                       42
<PAGE>
such Agreement or related Enhancement, (v) to add or amend any provisions of
such Agreement as required by a Rating Agency in order to maintain or improve
the rating of the Securities (it being understood that none of the Depositor,
the Seller, the Servicer or Trustee is obligated to maintain or improve such
rating), or (vi) to comply with any requirements imposed by the Code; provided
that any such amendment except pursuant to clause (vi) above will not adversely
affect in any material respect the interests of any Holders of such Series, as
evidenced by an opinion of counsel. Any such amendment except pursuant to clause
(vi) of the preceding sentence shall be deemed not to adversely affect in any
material respect the interests of any Holder if the Trustee receives written
confirmation from each Rating Agency rating such Securities that such amendment
will not cause such Rating Agency to reduce the then current rating thereof.
Unless otherwise specified in the Prospectus Supplement, the Agreement for each
Series may also be amended by the Trustee, the Servicer, if applicable, and the
Depositor with respect to such Series with the consent of the Holders possessing
not less than 66 2/3% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of the
Securities of such Series or, if only certain Classes of such Series are
affected by such amendment, 66 2/3% of the aggregate outstanding principal
amount of the Securities of each Class of such Series affected thereby, for the
purpose of adding any provisions to or changing in any manner or eliminating any
of the provisions of such Agreement or modifying in any manner the rights of
Holders of such Series; provided, however, that no such amendment may (a) reduce
the amount or delay the timing of payments on any Security without the consent
of the Holder of such Security; or (b) reduce the aforesaid percentage of the
aggregate outstanding principal amount of Securities of each Class, the Holders
of which are required to consent to any such amendment without the consent of
the Holders of 100% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount of each Class
of Securities affected thereby.
 
VOTING RIGHTS
 
     The related Prospectus Supplement will set forth the method of determining
allocation of voting rights with respect to a Series.
 
LIST OF HOLDERS
 
     Upon written request of three or more Holders of record of a Series for
purposes of communicating with other Holders with respect to their rights under
the Agreement, which request is accompanied by a copy of the communication which
such Holders propose to transmit, the Trustee will afford such Holders access
during business hours to the most recent list of Holders of that Series held by
the Trustee.
 
     No Agreement will provide for the holding of any annual or other meeting of
Holders.
 
BOOK-ENTRY SECURITIES
 
     If specified in the Prospectus Supplement for a Series of Securities, such
Series or one or more Classes of such Series may be issued in book-entry form.
In such event, beneficial owners of such Securities will not be considered
'Holders' under the Agreements and may exercise the rights of Holders only
indirectly through the participants in the applicable book-entry system.
 
REMIC ADMINISTRATOR
 
     For any Series with respect to which a REMIC election is made, preparation
of certain reports and certain other administrative duties with respect to the
Trust Fund may be performed by a REMIC administrator, who may be an affiliate of
the Depositor.
 
TERMINATION
 
     Pooling and Servicing Agreement; Trust Agreement.  The obligations created
by the Pooling and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement for a Series will
terminate upon the distribution to Holders of all amounts distributable to them
pursuant to such Agreement after the earlier of (i) the later of (a) the final
payment or other liquidation of the last Primary Asset remaining in the Trust
Fund for such Series and (b) the disposition of all property acquired upon
foreclosure or deed in lieu of foreclosure or repossession in respect of any
Primary Asset or (ii) the repurchase, as described below, by the Servicer or
other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement from the Trustee for
such Series of all Primary Assets and other property at that time subject to
such
 
                                       43
<PAGE>
Agreement. The Agreement for each Series permits, but does not require, the
Servicer or other entity specified in the related Prospectus Supplement to
purchase from the Trust Fund for such Series all remaining Primary Assets at a
price equal to, unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement,
100% of the aggregate Principal Balance of such Primary Assets plus, with
respect to any property acquired in respect of a Primary Asset, if any, the
outstanding Principal Balance of the related Primary Asset at the time of
foreclosure, less, in either case, related unreimbursed Advances (in the case of
the Primary Assets, only to the extent not already reflected in the computation
of the aggregate Principal Balance of such Primary Assets) and unreimbursed
expenses (that are reimbursable pursuant to the terms of the Pooling and
Servicing Agreement) plus, in either case, accrued interest thereon at the
weighted average rate on the related Primary Assets through the last day of the
Due Period in which such repurchase occurs; provided, however, that if an
election is made for treatment as a REMIC under the Code, the repurchase price
may equal the greater of (a) 100% of the aggregate Principal Balance of such
Primary Assets, plus accrued interest thereon at the applicable net rates on the
Primary Assets through the last day of the month of such repurchase and (b) the
aggregate fair market value of such Primary Assets plus the fair market value of
any property acquired in respect of a Primary Asset and remaining in the Trust
Fund. The exercise of such right will effect early retirement of the Securities
of such Series, but such entity's right to so purchase is subject to the
aggregate Principal Balance of the Primary Assets at the time of repurchase
being less than a fixed percentage, to be set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement, of the aggregate Principal Balance of the Primary Assets as of the
Cut-off Date. In no event, however, will the trust created by the Agreement
continue beyond the expiration of 21 years from the death of the last survivor
of certain persons identified therein. For each Series, the Servicer or the
Trustee, as applicable, will give written notice of termination of the Agreement
to each Holder, and the final distribution will be made only upon surrender and
cancellation of the Securities at an office or agency specified in the notice of
termination. If so provided in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series,
the Depositor or another entity may effect an optional termination of the Trust
Fund under the circumstances described in such Prospectus Supplement. See
'DESCRIPTION OF THE SECURITIES--Optional Redemption, Purchase or Termination'
herein.
 
     Indenture.  The Indenture will be discharged with respect to a Series of
Notes (except with respect to certain continuing rights specified in the
Indenture) upon the delivery to the Trustee for cancellation of all the Notes of
such Series or, with certain limitations, upon deposit with the Trustee of funds
sufficient for the payment in full of all of the Notes of such Series.
 
     In addition to such discharge with certain limitations, the Indenture will
provide that, if so specified with respect to the Notes of any Series, the
related Trust Fund will be discharged from any and all obligations in respect of
the Notes of such Series (except for certain obligations relating to temporary
Notes and exchange of Notes, to register the transfer of or exchange Notes of
such Series, to replace stolen, lost or mutilated Notes of such Series, to
maintain paying agencies and to hold monies for payment in trust) upon the
deposit with the Trustee, in trust, of money and/or direct obligations of or
obligations guaranteed by the United States of America which, through the
payment of interest and principal in respect thereof in accordance with their
terms, will provide money in an amount sufficient to pay the principal of and
each installment of interest on the Notes of such Series on the Final Scheduled
Distribution Date for such Notes and any installment of interest on such Notes
in accordance with the terms of the Indenture and the Notes of such Series. In
the event of any such defeasance and discharge of Notes of such Series, holders
of Notes of such Series would be able to look only to such money and/or direct
obligations for payment of principal and interest, if any, on their Notes until
maturity.
 
                         CERTAIN LEGAL ASPECTS OF LOANS
 
     The following discussion contains summaries of certain legal aspects of
mortgage loans, home improvement installment sales contracts and home
improvement installment loan agreements which are general in nature. Because
certain of such legal aspects are governed by applicable state law (which laws
may differ substantially), the summaries do not purport to be complete nor
reflect the laws of any particular state, nor encompass the laws of all states
in which the properties securing the Loans are situated.
 
                                       44
<PAGE>
MORTGAGES
 
     The Loans for a Series will, and certain Home Improvement Contracts for a
Series may, be secured by either mortgages or deeds of trust or deeds to secure
debt (such Mortgage Loans and Home Improvement Contracts are hereinafter
referred to in this section as 'mortgage loans'), depending upon the prevailing
practice in the state in which the property subject to a mortgage loan is
located. The filing of a mortgage, deed of trust or deed to secure debt creates
a lien or title interest upon the real property covered by such instrument and
represents the security for the repayment of an obligation that is customarily
evidenced by a promissory note. It is not prior to the lien for real estate
taxes and assessments or other charges imposed under governmental police powers
and may also be subject to other liens pursuant to the laws of the jurisdiction
in which the Mortgaged Property is located. Priority with respect to such
instruments depends on their terms, the knowledge of the parties to the mortgage
and generally on the order of recording with the applicable state, county or
municipal office. There are two parties to a mortgage, the mortgagor, who is the
borrower/property owner or the land trustee (as described below), and the
mortgagee, who is the lender. Under the mortgage instrument, the mortgagor
delivers to the mortgagee a note or bond and the mortgage. In the case of a land
trust, there are three parties because title to the property is held by a land
trustee under a land trust agreement of which the borrower/property owner is the
beneficiary; at origination of a mortgage loan, the borrower executes a separate
undertaking to make payments on the mortgage note. A deed of trust transaction
normally has three parties: the trustor, who is the borrower/property owner; the
beneficiary, who is the lender; and the trustee, a third-party grantee. Under a
deed of trust, the trustor grants the property, irrevocably until the debt is
paid, in trust, generally with a power of sale, to the trustee to secure payment
of the obligation. The mortgagee's authority under a mortgage and the trustee's
authority under a deed of trust are governed by the law of the state in which
the real property is located, the express provisions of the mortgage or deed of
trust, and, in some cases, in deed of trust transactions, the directions of the
beneficiary.
 
FORECLOSURE ON MORTGAGES
 
     Foreclosure of a mortgage is generally accomplished by judicial action.
Generally, the action is initiated by the service of legal pleadings upon all
parties having an interest of record in the real property. Delays in completion
of the foreclosure occasionally may result from difficulties in locating
necessary parties defendant. When the mortgagee's right to foreclosure is
contested, the legal proceedings necessary to resolve the issue can be
time-consuming and expensive. After the completion of a judicial foreclosure
proceeding, the court may issue a judgment of foreclosure and appoint a receiver
or other officer to conduct the sale of the property. In some states, mortgages
may also be foreclosed by advertisement, pursuant to a power of sale provided in
the mortgage. Foreclosure of a mortgage by advertisement is essentially similar
to foreclosure of a deed of trust by nonjudicial power of sale.
 
     Foreclosure of a deed of trust is generally accomplished by a nonjudicial
trustee's sale under a specific provision in the deed of trust which authorizes
the trustee to sell the property upon any default by the borrower under the
terms of the note or deed of trust. In certain states, such foreclosure also may
be accomplished by judicial action in the manner provided for foreclosure of
mortgages. In some states, the trustee must record a notice of default and send
a copy to the borrower-trustor and to any person who has recorded a request for
a copy of a notice of default and notice of sale. In addition, the trustee in
some states must provide notice to any other individual having an interest in
the real property, including any junior lienholders. If the deed of trust is not
reinstated within any applicable cure period, a notice of sale must be posted in
a public place and, in most states, published for a specified period of time in
one or more newspapers. In addition, some state laws require that a copy of the
notice of sale be posted on the property and sent to all parties having an
interest of record in the property. The trustor, borrower, or any person having
a junior encumbrance on the real estate, may, during a reinstatement period,
cure the default by paying the entire amount in arrears plus the costs and
expenses incurred in enforcing the obligation. Generally, state law controls the
amount of foreclosure expenses and costs, including attorney's fees, which may
be recovered by a lender. If the deed of trust is not reinstated, a notice of
sale must be posted in a public place and, in most states, published for a
specified period of time in one or more newspapers. In addition, some state laws
require that a copy of the notice of sale be posted on the property, recorded
and sent to all parties having an interest in the real property.
 
     An action to foreclose a mortgage is an action to recover the mortgage debt
by enforcing the mortgagee's rights under the mortgage. It is regulated by
statutes and rules and subject throughout to the court's equitable
 
                                       45
<PAGE>
powers. Generally, a mortgagor is bound by the terms of the related mortgage
note and the mortgage as made and cannot be relieved from his default if the
mortgagee has exercised his rights in a commercially reasonable manner. However,
since a foreclosure action historically was equitable in nature, the court may
exercise equitable powers to relieve a mortgagor of a default and deny the
mortgagee foreclosure on proof that either the mortgagor's default was neither
willful nor in bad faith or the mortgagee's action established a waiver, fraud,
bad faith, or oppressive or unconscionable conduct such as to warrant a court of
equity to refuse affirmative relief to the mortgagee. Under certain
circumstances a court of equity may relieve the mortgagor from an entirely
technical default where such default was not willful.
 
     A foreclosure action is subject to most of the delays and expenses of other
lawsuits if defenses or counterclaims are interposed, sometimes requiring up to
several years to complete. Moreover, a non-collusive, regularly conducted
foreclosure sale may be challenged as a fraudulent conveyance, regardless of the
parties' intent, if a court determines that the sale was for less than fair
consideration and such sale occurred while the mortgagor was insolvent and
within one year (or within the state statute of limitations if the trustee in
bankruptcy elects to proceed under state fraudulent conveyance law) of the
filing of bankruptcy. Similarly, a suit against the debtor on the related
mortgage note may take several years and, generally, is a remedy alternative to
foreclosure, the mortgagee being precluded from pursuing both at the same time.
 
     In the case of foreclosure under either a mortgage or a deed of trust, the
sale by the referee or other designated officer or by the trustee is a public
sale. However, because of the difficulty potential third party purchasers at the
sale have in determining the exact status of title and because the physical
condition of the property may have deteriorated during the foreclosure
proceedings, it is uncommon for a third party to purchase the property at a
foreclosure sale. Rather, it is common for the lender to purchase the property
from the trustee or referee for an amount which may be equal to the unpaid
principal amount of the mortgage note secured by the mortgage or deed of trust
plus accrued and unpaid interest and the expenses of foreclosure, in which event
the mortgagor's debt will be extinguished or the lender may purchase for a
lesser amount in order to preserve its right against a borrower to seek a
deficiency judgment in states where such a judgment is available. Thereafter,
subject to the right of the borrower in some states to remain in possession
during the redemption period, the lender will assume the burdens of ownership,
including obtaining hazard insurance, paying taxes and making such repairs at
its own expense as are necessary to render the property suitable for sale. The
lender will commonly obtain the services of a real estate broker and pay the
broker's commission in connection with the sale of the property. Depending upon
market conditions, the ultimate proceeds of the sale of the property may not
equal the lender's investment in the property. Any loss may be reduced by the
receipt of any mortgage guaranty insurance proceeds.
 
RIGHTS OF REDEMPTION
 
     In some states, after sale pursuant to a deed of trust or foreclosure of a
mortgage, the trustor or mortgagor and foreclosed junior lienors are given a
statutory period in which to redeem the property from the foreclosure sale. The
right of redemption should be distinguished from the equity of redemption, which
is a non-statutory right that must be exercised prior to the foreclosure sale.
In some states, redemption may occur only upon payment of the entire principal
balance of the loan, accrued interest and expenses of foreclosure. In other
states, redemption may be authorized if the former borrower pays only a portion
of the sums due. The effect of a statutory right of redemption is to diminish
the ability of the lender to sell the foreclosed property. The exercise of a
right of redemption would defeat the title of any purchaser at a foreclosure
sale, or of any purchaser from the lender subsequent to foreclosure or sale
under a deed of trust. Consequently the practical effect of a right of
redemption is to force the lender to retain the property and pay the expenses of
ownership until the redemption period has run. In some states, there is no right
to redeem property after a trustee's sale under a deed of trust.
 
JUNIOR MORTGAGES; RIGHTS OF SENIOR MORTGAGES
 
     The mortgage loans comprising or underlying the Primary Assets included in
the Trust Fund for a Series will be secured by mortgages or deeds of trust which
may be second or more junior mortgages to other mortgages held by other lenders
or institutional investors. The rights of the Trust Fund (and therefore the
Holders), as mortgagee under a junior mortgage, are subordinate to those of the
mortgagee under the senior mortgage, including the prior rights of the senior
mortgagee to receive hazard insurance and condemnation proceeds and to cause the
property securing the mortgage loan to be sold upon default of the mortgagor,
thereby extinguishing the
 
                                       46
<PAGE>
junior mortgagee's lien unless the junior mortgagee asserts its subordinate
interest in the property in foreclosure litigation and, possibly, satisfies the
defaulted senior mortgage. A junior mortgagee may satisfy a defaulted senior
loan in full and, in some states, may cure such default and bring the senior
loan current, in either event adding the amounts expended to the balance due on
the junior loan. In most states, absent a provision in the mortgage or deed of
trust, no notice of default is required to be given to a junior mortgagee.
 
     The standard form of the mortgage used by most institutional lenders
confers on the mortgagee the right both to receive all proceeds collected under
any hazard insurance policy and all awards made in connection with condemnation
proceedings, and to apply such proceeds and awards to any indebtedness secured
by the mortgage, in such order as the mortgagee may determine. Thus, in the
event improvements on the property are damaged or destroyed by fire or other
casualty, or in the event the property is taken by condemnation, the mortgagee
or beneficiary under underlying senior mortgages will have the prior right to
collect any insurance proceeds payable under a hazard insurance policy and any
award of damages in connection with the condemnation and to apply the same to
the indebtedness secured by the senior mortgages. Proceeds in excess of the
amount of senior mortgage indebtedness, in most cases, may be applied to the
indebtedness of a junior mortgage.
 
     Another provision sometimes found in the form of the mortgage or deed of
trust used by institutional lenders obligates the mortgagor to pay before
delinquency all taxes and assessments on the property and, when due, all
encumbrances, charges and liens on the property which appear prior to the
mortgage or deed of trust, to provide and maintain fire insurance on the
property, to maintain and repair the property and not to commit or permit any
waste thereof, and to appear in and defend any action or proceeding purporting
to affect the property or the rights of the mortgagee under the mortgage. Upon a
failure of the mortgagor to perform any of these obligations, the mortgagee is
given the right under certain mortgages to perform the obligation itself, at its
election, with the mortgagor agreeing to reimburse the mortgagee for any sums
expended by the mortgagee on behalf of the mortgagor. All sums so expended by
the mortgagee become part of the indebtedness secured by the mortgage.
 
ANTI-DEFICIENCY LEGISLATION AND OTHER LIMITATIONS ON LENDERS
 
     Certain states have imposed statutory prohibitions which limit the remedies
of a beneficiary under a deed of trust or a mortgagee under a mortgage. In some
states, statutes limit the right of the beneficiary or mortgagee to obtain a
deficiency judgment against the borrower following foreclosure or sale under a
deed of trust. A deficiency judgment is a personal judgment against the former
borrower equal in most cases to the difference between the net amount realized
upon the public sale of the real property and the amount due to the lender.
Other statutes require the beneficiary or mortgagee to exhaust the security
afforded under a deed of trust or mortgage by foreclosure in an attempt to
satisfy the full debt before bringing a personal action against the borrower. In
certain other states, the lender has the option of bringing a personal action
against the borrower on the debt without first exhausting such security;
however, in some of these states, the lender, following judgment on such
personal action, may be deemed to have elected a remedy and may be precluded
from exercising remedies with respect to the security. Consequently, the
practical effect of the election requirement, when applicable, is that lenders
will usually proceed first against the security rather than bringing a personal
action against the borrower. Finally, other statutory provisions limit any
deficiency judgment against the former borrower following a foreclosure sale to
the excess of the outstanding debt over the fair market value of the property at
the time of the public sale. The purpose of these statutes is generally to
prevent a beneficiary or a mortgagee from obtaining a large deficiency judgment
against the former borrower as a result of low or no bids at the foreclosure
sale.
 
     In addition to laws limiting or prohibiting deficiency judgments, numerous
other statutory provisions, including the federal bankruptcy laws, the Federal
Soldiers' and Sailors' Relief Act and state laws affording relief to debtors,
may interfere with or affect the ability of the secured lender to realize upon
collateral and/or enforce a deficiency judgment. For example, with respect to
federal bankruptcy law, the filing of a petition acts as a stay against the
enforcement of remedies for collection of a debt. Moreover, a court with federal
bankruptcy jurisdiction may permit a debtor through a Chapter 13 Bankruptcy Code
rehabilitative plan to cure a monetary default with respect to a loan on a
debtor's residence by paying arrearages within a reasonable time period and
reinstating the original loan payment schedule even though the lender
accelerated the loan and the lender has taken all steps to realize upon his
security (provided no sale of the property has yet occurred) prior to the filing
of the debtor's Chapter 13 petition. Some courts with federal bankruptcy
jurisdiction have approved plans, based on
 
                                       47
<PAGE>
the particular facts of the reorganization case, that effected the curing of a
loan default by permitting the obligor to pay arrearages over a number of years.
 
     Courts with federal bankruptcy jurisdiction have also indicated that the
terms of a mortgage loan may be modified if the borrower has filed a petition
under Chapter 13. These courts have suggested that such modifications may
include reducing the amount of each monthly payment, changing the rate of
interest, altering the repayment schedule and reducing the lender's security
interest to the value of the residence, thus leaving the lender a general
unsecured creditor for the difference between the value of the residence and the
outstanding balance of the loan. Federal bankruptcy law and limited case law
indicate that the foregoing modifications could not be applied to the terms of a
loan secured by property that is the principal residence of the debtor. In all
cases, the secured creditor is entitled to the value of its security plus
post-petition interest, attorney's fees and costs to the extent the value of the
security exceeds the debt.
 
     In a Chapter 11 case under the Bankruptcy Code, the lender is precluded
from foreclosing without authorization from the bankruptcy court. The lender's
lien may be transferred to other collateral and/or be limited in amount to the
value of the lender's interest in the collateral as of the date of the
bankruptcy. The loan term may be extended, the interest rate may be adjusted to
market rates and the priority of the loan may be subordinated to bankruptcy
court-approved financing. The bankruptcy court can, in effect, invalidate
due-on-sale clauses through confirmed Chapter 11 plans of reorganization.
 
     The Bankruptcy Code provides priority to certain tax liens over the
lender's security. This may delay or interfere with the enforcement of rights in
respect of a defaulted Loan. In addition, substantive requirements are imposed
upon lenders in connection with the origination and the servicing of mortgage
loans by numerous federal and some state consumer protection laws. The laws
include the federal Truth-in-Lending Act, Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act,
Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Fair Credit Billing Act, Fair Credit Reporting Act
and related statutes and regulations. These federal laws impose specific
statutory liabilities upon lenders who originate loans and who fail to comply
with the provisions of the law. In some cases, this liability may affect
assignees of the loans.
 
DUE-ON-SALE CLAUSES IN MORTGAGE LOANS
 
     Due-on-sale clauses permit the lender to accelerate the maturity of the
loan if the borrower sells or transfers, whether voluntarily or involuntarily,
all or part of the real property securing the loan without the lender's prior
written consent. The enforceability of these clauses has been the subject of
legislation or litigation in many states, and in some cases, typically involving
single family residential mortgage transactions, their enforceability has been
limited or denied. In any event, the Garn-St. Germain Depository Institutions
Act of 1982 (the 'Garn-St. Germain Act') preempts state constitutional,
statutory and case law that prohibits the enforcement of due-on-sale clauses and
permits lenders to enforce these clauses in accordance with their terms, subject
to certain exceptions. As a result, due-on-sale clauses have become generally
enforceable except in those states whose legislatures exercised their authority
to regulate the enforceability of such clauses with respect to mortgage loans
that were (i) originated or assumed during the 'window period' under the
Garn-St. Germain Act which ended in all cases not later than October 15, 1982,
and (ii) originated by lenders other than national banks, federal savings
institutions and federal credit unions. FHLMC has taken the position in its
published mortgage servicing standards that, out of a total of eleven 'window
period states,' five states (Arizona, Michigan, Minnesota, New Mexico and Utah)
have enacted statutes extending, on various terms and for varying periods, the
prohibition on enforcement of due-on-sale clauses with respect to certain
categories of window period loans. Also, the Garn-St. Germain Act does
'encourage' lenders to permit assumption of loans at the original rate of
interest or at some other rate less than the average of the original rate and
the market rate.
 
     In addition, under federal bankruptcy law, due-on-sale clauses may not be
enforceable in bankruptcy proceedings and may, under certain circumstances, be
eliminated in any modified mortgage resulting from such bankruptcy proceeding.
 
                                       48
<PAGE>
ENFORCEABILITY OF PREPAYMENT AND LATE PAYMENT FEES
 
     Forms of notes, mortgages and deeds of trust used by lenders may contain
provisions obligating the borrower to pay a late charge if payments are not
timely made, and in some circumstances may provide for prepayment fees or
penalties if the obligation is paid prior to maturity. In certain states, there
are or may be specific limitations, upon the late charges which a lender may
collect from a borrower for delinquent payments. Certain states also limit the
amounts that a lender may collect from a borrower as an additional charge if the
loan is prepaid. Late charges and prepayment fees are typically retained by
servicers as additional servicing compensation.
 
EQUITABLE LIMITATIONS ON REMEDIES
 
     In connection with lenders' attempts to realize upon their security, courts
have invoked general equitable principles. The equitable principles are
generally designed to relieve the borrower from the legal effect of his defaults
under the loan documents. Examples of judicial remedies that have been fashioned
include judicial requirements that the lender undertake affirmative and
expensive actions to determine the causes of the borrower's default and the
likelihood that the borrower will be able to reinstate the loan. In some cases,
courts have substituted their judgment for the lender's judgment and have
required that lenders reinstate loans or recast payment schedules in order to
accommodate borrowers who are suffering from temporary financial disability. In
other cases, courts have limited the right of a lender to realize upon his
security if the default under the security agreement is not monetary, such as
the borrower's failure to adequately maintain the property or the borrower's
execution of secondary financing affecting the property. Finally, some courts
have been faced with the issue of whether or not federal or state constitutional
provisions reflecting due process concerns for adequate notice require that
borrowers under security agreements receive notices in addition to the
statutorily-prescribed minimums. For the most part, these cases have upheld the
notice provisions as being reasonable or have found that, in cases involving the
sale by a trustee under a deed of trust or by a mortgagee under a mortgage
having a power of sale, there is insufficient state action to afford
constitutional protections to the borrower.
 
     Most conventional single-family mortgage loans may be prepaid in full or in
part without penalty. The regulations of the Office of Thrift Supervision (the
'OTS') prohibit the imposition of a prepayment penalty or equivalent fee for or
in connection with the acceleration of a loan by exercise of a due-on-sale
clause. A mortgagee to whom a prepayment in full has been tendered may be
compelled to give either a release of the mortgage or an instrument assigning
the existing mortgage. The absence of a restraint on prepayment, particularly
with respect to mortgage loans having higher mortgage rates, may increase the
likelihood of refinancing or other early retirements of such mortgage loans.
 
APPLICABILITY OF USURY LAWS
 
     Title V of the Depository Institutions Deregulation and Monetary Control
Act of 1980, enacted in March 1980 ('Title V'), provides that state usury
limitations shall not apply to certain types of residential first mortgage loans
originated by certain lenders after March 31, 1980. Similar federal statutes
were in effect with respect to mortgage loans made during the first three months
of 1980. The OTS, as successor to the Federal Home Loan Bank Board, is
authorized to issue rules and regulations and to publish interpretations
governing implementation of Tide V. Tide V authorizes any state to reimpose
interest rate limits by adopting, before April 1, 1983, a state law, or by
certifying that the voters of such state have voted in favor of any provision,
constitutional or otherwise, which expressly rejects an application of the
federal law. Fifteen states adopted such a law prior to the April 1, 1983
deadline. In addition, even where Title V is not so rejected, any state is
authorized by the law to adopt a provision limiting discount points or other
charges on mortgage loans covered by Title V.
 
THE HOME IMPROVEMENT CONTRACTS
 
  General
 
     The Home Improvement Contracts, other than those Home Improvement Contracts
that are unsecured or secured by mortgages on real estate (such Home Improvement
Contracts are hereinafter referred to in this section as 'contracts') generally
are 'chattel paper' or constitute 'purchase money security interests' each as
defined
 
                                       49
<PAGE>
in the Uniform Commercial Code (the 'UCC'). Pursuant to the UCC, the sale of
chattel paper is treated in a manner similar to perfection of a security
interest in chattel paper. Under the related Agreement, the Depositor will
transfer physical possession of the contracts to the Trustee or a designated
custodian or may retain possession of the contracts as custodian for the
Trustee. In addition, the Depositor will make an appropriate filing of a UCC-1
financing statement in the appropriate states to give notice of the Trustee's
ownership of the contracts. Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the contracts will not be stamped or otherwise marked to reflect
their assignment from the Depositor to the Trustee. Therefore, if through
negligence, fraud or otherwise, a subsequent purchaser were able to take
physical possession of the contracts without notice of such assignment, the
Trustee's interest in the contracts could be defeated.
 
  Security Interests in Home Improvements
 
     The contracts that are secured by the Home Improvements financed thereby
grant to the originator of such contracts a purchase money security interest in
such Home Improvements to secure all or part of the purchase price of such Home
Improvements and related services. A financing statement generally is not
required to be filed to perfect a purchase money security interest in consumer
goods. Such purchase money security interests are assignable. In general, a
purchase money security interest grants to the holder a security interest that
has priority over a conflicting security interest in the same collateral and the
proceeds of such collateral. However, to the extent that the collateral subject
to a purchase money security interest becomes a fixture, in order for the
related purchase money security interest to take priority over a conflicting
interest in the fixture, the holder's interest in such Home Improvement must
generally be perfected by a timely fixture filing. In general, under the UCC, a
security interest does not exist under the UCC in ordinary building material
incorporated into an improvement on land. Home Improvement Contracts that
finance lumber, bricks, other types of ordinary building material or other goods
that are deemed to lose such characterization, upon incorporation of such
materials into the related property, will not be secured by a purchase money
security interest in the Home Improvement being financed.
 
  Enforcement of Security Interest in Home Improvements
 
     So long as the Home Improvement has not become subject to the real estate
law, a creditor can repossess a Home Improvement securing a contract by
voluntary surrender, by 'self-help' repossession that is 'peaceful' (i.e.,
without breach of the peace) or, in the absence of voluntary surrender and the
ability to repossess without breach of the peace, by judicial process. The
holder of a contract must give the debtor a number of days' notice, which varies
from 10 to 30 days depending on the state, prior to commencement of any
repossession. The UCC and consumer protection laws in most states place
restrictions on repossession sales, including requiring prior notice to the
debtor and commercial reasonableness in effecting such a sale. The law in most
states also requires that the debtor be given notice of any sale prior to resale
of the unit that the debtor may redeem it at or before such resale.
 
     Under the laws applicable in most states, a creditor is entitled to obtain
a deficiency judgement from a debtor for any deficiency on repossession and
resale of the property securing the debtor's loan. However, some states impose
prohibitions or limitations on deficiency judgements, and in many cases the
defaulting borrower would have no assets with which to pay a judgement.
 
     Certain other statutory provisions, including federal and state bankruptcy
and insolvency laws and general equitable principles, may limit or delay the
ability of a lender to repossess and resell collateral or enforce a deficiency
judgement.
 
  Consumer Protection Laws
 
     The so-called 'Holder-in-Due-Course' rule of the Federal Trade Commission
is intended to defeat the ability of the transferor of a consumer credit
contract which is the seller of goods which gave rise to the transaction (and
certain related lenders and assignees) to transfer such contract free of notice
of claims by the debtor thereunder. The effect of this rule is to subject the
assignee of such a contract to all claims and defenses which the debtor could
assert against the seller of goods. Liability under this rule is limited to
amounts paid under a contract; however, the obligor also may be able to assert
the rule to set off remaining amounts due as a defense against a claim brought
by the Trustee against such obligor. Numerous other federal and state consumer
 
                                       50
<PAGE>
protection laws impose requirements applicable to the origination and lending
pursuant to the contracts, including the Truth in Lending Act, the Federal Trade
Commission Act, the Fair Credit Billing Act, the Fair Credit Reporting Act, the
Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act and the
Uniform Consumer Credit Code. In the case of some of these laws, the failure to
comply with their provisions may affect the enforceability of the related
contract.
 
  Applicability of Usury Laws
 
     Title V provides that, subject to the following conditions, state usury
limitations shall not apply to any contract which is secured by a first lien on
certain kinds of consumer goods. The contracts would be covered if they satisfy
certain conditions, among other things, governing the terms of any prepayments,
late charges and deferral fees and requiring a 30-day notice period prior to
instituting any action leading to repossession of the related unit.
 
     Title V authorized any state to reimpose limitations on interest rates and
finance charges by adopting before April 1, 1983 a law or constitutional
provision which expressly rejects application of the federal law. Fifteen states
adopted such a law prior to the April 1, 1983 deadline. In addition, even where
Title V was not so rejected, any state is authorized by the law to adopt a
provision limiting discount points or other charges on loans covered by Title V.
 
INSTALLMENT SALES CONTRACTS
 
     The Loans may also consist of installment sales contracts. Under an
installment sales contract ('Installment Sales Contract') the seller
(hereinafter referred to in this section as the 'lender') retains legal title to
the property and enters into an agreement with the purchaser (hereinafter
referred to in this section as the 'borrower') for the payment of the purchase
price, plus interest, over the term of such contract. Only after full
performance by the borrower of the contract is the lender obligated to convey
title to the property to the purchaser. As with mortgage or deed of trust
financing, during the effective period of the Installment Sales Contract, the
borrower is generally responsible for maintaining the property in good condition
and for paying real estate taxes, assessments and hazard insurance premiums
associated with the property.
 
     The method of enforcing the rights of the lender under an Installment Sales
Contract varies on a state-by-state basis depending upon the extent to which
state courts are willing, or able pursuant to state statute, to enforce the
contract strictly according to the terms. The terms of Installment Sales
Contracts generally provide that upon a default by the borrower, the borrower
loses his or her right to occupy the property, the entire indebtedness is
accelerated, and the buyer's equitable interest in the property is forfeited.
The lender in such a situation does not have to foreclose in order to obtain
title to the property, although in some cases a quiet title action is in order
if the borrower has filed the Installment Sales Contract in local land records
and an ejectment action may be necessary to recover possession. In a few states,
particularly in cases of borrower default during the early years of an
Installment Sales Contract, the courts will permit ejectment of the buyer and a
forfeiture of his or her interest in the property. However, most state
legislatures have enacted provisions by analogy to mortgage law protecting
borrowers under Installment Sales Contracts from the harsh consequences of
forfeiture. Under such statutes, a judicial or nonjudicial foreclosure may be
required, the lender may be required to give notice of default and the borrower
may be granted some grace period during which the Installment Sales Contract may
be reinstated upon full payment of the default amount and the borrower may have
a post-foreclosure statutory redemption right. In other states, courts in equity
may permit a borrower with significant investment in the property under an
Installment Sales Contract for the sale of real estate to share in the proceeds
of sale of the property after the indebtedness is repaid or may otherwise refuse
to enforce the forfeiture clause. Nevertheless, generally speaking, the lender's
procedures for obtaining possession and clear title under an Installment Sales
Contract in a given state are simpler and less time-consuming and costly than
are the procedures for foreclosing and obtaining clear title to a property
subject to one or more liens.
 
                                       51
<PAGE>
SOLDIERS' AND SAILORS' CIVIL RELIEF ACT OF 1940
 
     Under the Soldiers' and Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940, members of all
branches of the military on active duty, including draftees and reservists in
military service, (i) are entitled to have interest rates reduced and capped at
6% per annum, on obligations (including Loans) incurred prior to the
commencement of military service for the duration of military service, (ii) may
be entitled to a stay of proceedings on any kind of foreclosure or repossession
action in the case of defaults on such obligations entered into prior to
military service for the duration of military service and (iii) may have the
maturity of such obligations incurred prior to military service extended, the
payments lowered and the payment schedule readjusted for a period of time after
the completion of military service. However, the benefits of (i), (ii), or (iii)
above are subject to challenge by creditors and if, in the opinion of the court,
the ability of a person to comply with such obligations is not materially
impaired by military service, the court may apply equitable principles
accordingly. If a borrower's obligation to repay amounts otherwise due on a Loan
included in a Trust Fund for a Series is relieved pursuant to the Soldiers' and
Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940, none of the Trust Fund, the Servicer, the
Depositor nor the Trustee will be required to advance such amounts, and any loss
in respect thereof may reduce the amounts available to be paid to the Holders of
the Securities of such Series. Unless otherwise specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement, any shortfalls in interest collections on Loans or
Underlying Loans relating to the Private Securities, as applicable, included in
a Trust Fund for a Series resulting from application of the Soldiers' and
Sailors' Civil Relief Act of 1940 will be allocated to each Class of Securities
of such Series that is entitled to receive interest in respect of such Loans or
Underlying Loans in proportion to the interest that each such Class of
Securities would have otherwise been entitled to receive in respect of such
Loans or Underlying Loans had such interest shortfall not occurred.
 
                                 THE DEPOSITOR
 
GENERAL
 
     The Depositor was incorporated in the State of Delaware in June 1995, and
is a wholly-owned subsidiary of The Bear Stearns Companies Inc. The Depositor's
principal executive offices are located at 245 Park Avenue, New York, New York
10167. Its telephone number is (212) 272-4095.
 
     The Depositor will not engage in any activities other than to authorize,
issue, sell, deliver, purchase and invest in (and enter into agreements in
connection with), and/or to engage in the establishment of one or more trusts
which will issue and sell, bonds, notes, debt or equity securities, obligations
and other securities and instruments ('Depositor Securities') collateralized or
otherwise secured or backed by, or otherwise representing an interest in, among
other things, receivables or pass-through certificates, or participations or
certificates of participation or beneficial ownership in one or more pools of
receivables, and the proceeds of the foregoing, that arise in connection with
loans secured by certain first or junior mortgages on real estate or
manufactured housing and any and all other commercial transactions and
commercial, sovereign, student or consumer loans or indebtedness and, in
connection therewith or otherwise, purchasing, acquiring, owning, holding,
transferring, conveying, servicing, selling, pledging, assigning, financing and
otherwise dealing with such receivables, pass-through certificates, or
participations or certificates of participation or beneficial ownership. Article
Third of the Depositor's Certificate of Incorporation limits the Depositor's
activities to the above activities and certain related activities, such as
credit enhancement with respect to such Depositor Securities, and to any
activities incidental to and necessary or convenient for the accomplishment of
such purposes.
 
                                       52
<PAGE>
                                USE OF PROCEEDS
 
     The Depositor will apply all or substantially all of the net proceeds from
the sale of each Series of Securities for one or more of the following purposes:
(i) to purchase the related Primary Assets, (ii) to repay indebtedness which has
been incurred to obtain funds to acquire such Primary Assets, (iii) to establish
any Reserve Funds described in the related Prospectus Supplement and (iv) to pay
costs of structuring and issuing such Securities, including the costs of
obtaining Enhancement, if any. If so specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement, the purchase of the Primary Assets for a Series may be effected by
an exchange of Securities with the Seller of such Primary Assets.
 
                   CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS
 
GENERAL
 
     The following summary is based on the opinion of Stroock & Stroock & Lavan,
special counsel to the Depositor ('Federal Tax Counsel') as to the anticipated
material federal income tax consequences of the purchase, ownership and
disposition of Securities. The summary does not purport to deal with all aspects
of federal income taxation that may affect particular investors in light of
their individual circumstances, nor with certain types of investors subject to
special treatment under the federal income tax laws. This summary focuses
primarily upon investors who will hold Securities as 'capital assets'
(generally, property held for investment) within the meaning of Section 1221 of
the Code, but much of the discussion is applicable to other investors as well.
Prospective investors are advised to consult their own tax advisers concerning
the federal, state, local and any other tax consequences to them of the
purchase, ownership and disposition of the Securities.
 
     The summary is based upon the provisions of the Code, the regulations
promulgated thereunder, including, where applicable, proposed regulations, and
the judicial and administrative rulings and decisions now in effect, all of
which are subject to change or possible differing interpretations. The statutory
provisions, regulations, and interpretations on which this interpretation is
based are subject to change, and such a change could apply retroactively.
 
     The federal income tax consequences to Holders will vary depending on
whether (i) the Securities of a Series are classified as indebtedness; (ii) an
election is made to treat the Trust Fund relating to a particular Series of
Securities as a real estate mortgage investment conduit ('REMIC') under the
Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the 'Code'); (iii) the Securities
represent an ownership interest in some or all of the assets included in the
Trust Fund for a Series; or (iv) an election is made to treat the Trust Fund
relating to a particular Series of Certificates as a partnership. The Prospectus
Supplement for each Series of Securities will specify how the Securities will be
treated for federal income tax purposes and will discuss whether a REMIC
election, if any, will be made with respect to such Series.
 
TAXATION OF DEBT SECURITIES
 
     Status of Regular Interest Securities as Real Property Loans.  The regular
interests in a REMIC ('Regular Interest Securities') will be 'qualifying real
property loans' within the meaning of Section 593(d) of the Code, 'real estate
assets' for purposes of Section 856(c)(5)(A) of the Code and assets described in
Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the Code (assets qualifying under one or more of those
sections, applying each section separately, 'qualifying assets') to the extent
that the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets. However, if at least 95 percent
of the REMIC's assets are qualifying assets, then 100 percent of the Regular
Interest Securities will be qualifying assets. Similarly, income on the Regular
Interest Securities will be treated as 'interest on obligations secured by
mortgages on real property' within the meaning of Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the
Code, subject to the limitations of the preceding two sentences. In addition to
Loans, the REMIC's assets will include payments on Loans held pending
distribution to holders of Regular Interest Securities, amounts in reserve
accounts (if any), other credit enhancements (if any) and possibly buydown funds
('Buydown Funds'). The Loans generally will be qualifying assets under all three
of the foregoing sections of the Code. However, Loans that are not secured by
residential real property or real property used primarily for church purposes
may not constitute qualifying assets under Section 7701(a)(19)(c)(v) of the
Code, and Loans that are not secured by improved real property or real
 
                                       53
<PAGE>
property which is to be improved using Loan proceeds will not constitute
qualifying assets under Section 593(d) of the Code. In addition, to the extent
that the principal amount of a Loan exceeds the value of the property securing
the Loan, it is unclear and Federal Tax Counsel is unable to opine whether the
Loans will be qualifying assets. The regulations under Sections 860A through
860G of the Code (the 'REMIC Regulations') treat credit enhancements as part of
the mortgage or pool of mortgages to which they relate, and therefore credit
enhancements generally should be qualifying assets. Regulations issued in
conjunction with the REMIC Regulations provide that amounts paid on Loans and
held pending distribution to holders of Regular Interest Securities ('cash flow
investments') will be treated as qualifying assets. It is unclear whether
reserve funds or Buydown Funds would also constitute qualifying assets under any
of those provisions.
 
     Interest and Acquisition Discount.  Securities representing Regular
Interest Securities are generally taxable to Holders in the same manner as
evidences of indebtedness issued by the REMIC. Stated interest on the Regular
Interest Securities will be taxable as ordinary income and taken into account
using the accrual method of accounting, regardless of the Holder's normal
accounting method. Interest (other than original issue discount) on Securities
(other than Regular Interest Securities) that are characterized as indebtedness
for federal income tax purposes will be includible in income by Holders thereof
in accordance with their usual methods of accounting. Securities characterized
as debt for federal income tax purposes and Regular Interest Securities will be
referred to hereinafter collectively as 'Debt Securities.'
 
     Debt Securities that are Compound Interest Securities will, and certain of
the other Debt Securities may, be issued with 'original issue discount' ('OID').
The following discussion is based in part on the rules governing OID which are
set forth in Sections 1271-1275 of the Code and the Treasury regulations issued
thereunder on February 2, 1994 (the 'OID Regulations'). A Holder should be
aware, however, that the OID Regulations do not adequately address certain
issues relevant to prepayable securities, such as the Debt Securities.
 
     In general, OID, if any, will equal the difference between the stated
redemption price at maturity of a Debt Security and its issue price. A Holder of
a Debt Security must include such OID in gross income as ordinary interest
income as it accrues under a method taking into account an economic accrual of
the discount. In general, OID must be included in income in advance of the
receipt of the cash representing that income. The amount of OID on a Debt
Security will be considered to be zero if it is less than a de minimis amount
determined under the Code.
 
     The issue price of a Debt Security is the first price at which a
substantial amount of Debt Securities of that class are sold to the public
(excluding bond houses, brokers, underwriters or wholesalers). If less than a
substantial amount of a particular class of Debt Securities is sold for cash on
or prior to the Closing Date, the issue price for such class will be treated as
the fair market value of such class on the Closing Date. The issue price of a
Debt Security also includes the amount paid by an initial Debt Security Holder
for accrued interest that relates to a period prior to the issue date of the
Debt Security. The stated redemption price at maturity of a Debt Security
includes the original principal amount of the Debt Security, but generally will
not include distributions of interest if such distributions constitute
'qualified stated interest.'
 
     Under the OID Regulations, interest payments will not qualify as qualified
stated interest unless the interest payments are 'unconditionally payable.' The
OID Regulations state that interest is unconditionally payable if late payment
of interest (other than late payment that occurs within a reasonable grace
period) or nonpayment of interest is expected to be penalized or reasonable
remedies exist to compel payment. The meaning of 'penalized' under the OID
regulations is unclear. Therefore, interest payments on Debt Securities which do
not have reasonable remedies to compel timely payment of interest may not be
qualified stated interest, and such Debt Securities may have original issue
discount.
 
     Certain Debt Securities will provide for distributions of interest based on
a period that is the same length as the interval between Distribution Dates but
ends prior to each Distribution Date. Any interest that accrues prior to the
Closing Date may be treated under the OID Regulations either (i) as part of the
issue price and the stated redemption price at maturity of the Debt Securities
or (ii) as not included in the issue price or stated redemption price. The OID
Regulations provide a special application of the de minimis rule for debt
instruments with long first accrual periods where the interest payable for the
first period is at a rate which is effectively less than that which applies in
all other periods. In such cases, for the sole purpose of determining whether
original issue discount is de minimis, the OID Regulations provide that the
stated redemption price is equal to the instrument's
 
                                       54
<PAGE>
issue price plus the greater of the amount of foregone interest or the excess
(if any) of the instrument's stated principal amount over its issue price.
 
     Under the de minimis rule, OID on a Debt Security will be considered to be
zero if such OID is less than 0.25% of the stated redemption price at maturity
of the Debt Security multiplied by the weighted average maturity of the Debt
Security. For this purpose, the weighted average maturity of the Debt Security
is computed as the sum of the amounts determined by multiplying the number of
full years (i.e., rounding down partial years) from the issue date until each
distribution in reduction of stated redemption price at maturity is scheduled to
be made by a fraction, the numerator of which is the amount of each distribution
included in the stated redemption price at maturity of the Debt Security and the
denominator of which is the stated redemption price at maturity of the Debt
Security. Holders generally must report de minimis OID pro rata as principal
payments are received, and such income will be capital gain if the Debt Security
is held as a capital asset. However, accrual method Holders may elect to accrue
all de minimis OID as well as market discount under a constant interest method.
 
     The Holder of a Debt Security issued with OID must include in gross income,
for all days during its taxable year on which it holds such Debt Security, the
sum of the 'daily portions' of such original issue discount. The amount of OID
includible in income by a Holder will be computed by allocating to each day
during a taxable year a pro rata portion of the original issue discount that
accrued during the relevant accrual period. In the case of a Debt Security that
is not a Regular Interest Security and the principal payments on which are not
subject to acceleration resulting from prepayments on the Loans, the amount of
OID includible in income of a Holder for an accrual period (generally the period
over which interest accrues on the debt instrument) will equal the product of
the yield to maturity of the Debt Security and the adjusted issue price of the
Debt Security, reduced by any payments of qualified stated interest. The
adjusted issue price is the sum of its issue price plus prior accruals or OID,
reduced by the total payments made with respect to such Debt Security in all
prior periods, other than qualified stated interest payments.
 
     The amount of OID to be included in income by a Holder of a debt
instrument, such as certain Classes of the Debt Securities, that is subject to
acceleration due to prepayments on other debt obligations securing such
instruments (a 'Pay-Through Security'), is computed by taking into account the
anticipated rate of prepayments assumed in pricing the debt instrument (the
'Prepayment Assumption'). The amount of OID that will accrue during an accrual
period on a Pay-Through Security is the excess (if any) of the sum of (a) the
present value of all payments remaining to be made on the Pay-Through Security
as of the close of the accrual period and (b) the payments during the accrual
period of amounts included in the stated redemption price of the Pay-Through
Security, over the adjusted issue price of the Pay-Through Security at the
beginning of the accrual period. The present value of the remaining payments is
to be determined on the basis of three factors: (i) the original yield to
maturity of the Pay-Through Security (determined on the basis of compounding at
the end of each accrual period and properly adjusted for the length of the
accrual period), (ii) events which have occurred before the end of the accrual
period and (iii) the assumption that the remaining payments will be made in
accordance with the original Prepayment Assumption. The effect of this method is
to increase the portions of OID required to be included in income by a Holder to
take into account prepayments with respect to the Loans at a rate that exceeds
the Prepayment Assumption, and to decrease (but not below zero for any period)
the portions of OID required to be included in income by a Holder of a
Pay-Through Security to take into account prepayments with respect to the Loans
at a rate that is slower than the Prepayment Assumption. Although OID will be
reported to Holders of Pay-Through Securities based on the Prepayment
Assumption, no representation is made to Holders that Loans will be prepaid at
that rate or at any other rate.
 
     The Depositor may adjust the accrual of OID on a Class of Regular Interest
Securities (or other regular interests in a REMIC) in a manner that it believes
to be appropriate, to take account of realized losses on the Loans, although the
OID Regulations do not provide for such adjustments. If the Internal Revenue
Service were to require that OID be accrued without such adjustments, the rate
of accrual of OID for a Class of Regular Interest Securities could increase.
 
     Certain classes of Regular Interest Securities may represent more than one
class of REMIC regular interests. Unless the applicable Prospectus Supplement
specifies otherwise, the Trustee intends, based on the OID Regulations, to
calculate OID on such Securities as if, solely for the purposes of computing
OID, the separate regular interests were a single debt instrument.
 
                                       55
<PAGE>
     A subsequent Holder of a Debt Security will also be required to include OID
in gross income, but such a Holder who purchases such Debt Security for an
amount that exceeds its adjusted issue price will be entitled (as will an
initial Holder who pays more than a Debt Security's issue price) to offset such
OID by comparable economic accruals of portions of such excess.
 
     Effects of Defaults and Delinquencies.  Holders will be required to report
income with respect to the related Securities under an accrual method without
giving effect to delays and reductions in distributions attributable to a
default or delinquency on the Loans, except possibly to the extent that it can
be established that such amounts are uncollectible. As a result, the amount of
income (including OID) reported by a Holder of such a Security in any period
could significantly exceed the amount of cash distributed to such Holder in that
period. The Holder will eventually be allowed a loss (or will be allowed to
report a lesser amount of income) to the extent that the aggregate amount of
distributions on the Securities is reduced as a result of a Loan default.
However, the timing and character of such losses or reductions in income are
uncertain and, accordingly, Holders of Securities should consult their own tax
advisors on this point.
 
     Interest-Only Debt Securities.  The Trust Fund intends to report income
from interest-only classes of Debt Securities to the Internal Revenue Service
and to holders of interest-only Debt Securities based on the assumption that the
stated redemption price at maturity is equal to the sum of all payments
determined under the applicable prepayment assumption. As a result, such
interest-only Debt Securities Certificates will be treated as having original
issue discount.
 
     Variable Rate Debt Securities.  Under the OID Regulations, Debt Securities
paying interest at a variable rate (a 'Variable Rate Debt Security') are subject
to special rules. A Variable Rate Debt Security will qualify as a 'variable rate
debt instrument' if (i) its issue price does not exceed the total noncontingent
principal payments due under the Variable Rate Debt Security by more than a
specified de minimis amount and (ii) it provides for stated interest, paid or
compounded at least annually, at (a) one or more qualified floating rates, (b) a
single fixed rate and one or more qualified floating rates, (c) a single
objective rate or (d) a single fixed rate and a single objective rate that is a
qualified inverse floating rate.
 
     A 'qualified floating rate' is any variable rate where variations in the
value of such rate can reasonably be expected to measure contemporaneous
variations in the cost of newly borrowed funds in the currency in which the
Variable Rate Debt Security is denominated. A multiple of a qualified floating
rate will generally not itself constitute a qualified floating rate for purposes
of the OID Regulations. However, a variable rate equal to (i) the product of a
qualified floating rate and a fixed multiple that is greater than zero but not
more than 1.35 or (ii) the product of a qualified floating rate and a fixed
multiple that is greater than zero but not more than 1.35, increased or
decreased by a fixed rate will constitute a qualified floating rate for purposes
of the OID Regulations. In addition, under the OID Regulations, two or more
qualified floating rates that can reasonably be expected to have approximately
the same values throughout the term of the Variable Rate Debt Security will be
treated as a single qualified floating rate (a 'Presumed Single Qualified
Floating Rate'). Two or more qualified floating rates with values within 25
basis points of each other as determined on the Variable Rate Debt Security's
issue date will be conclusively presumed to be a Presumed Single Qualified
Floating Rate. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a variable rate that would
otherwise constitute a qualified floating rate but which is subject to one or
more restrictions such as a cap or floor, will not be a qualified floating rate
for purposes of the OID Regulations unless the restriction is fixed throughout
the term of the Variable Rate Debt Security or the restriction will not
significantly affect the yield of the Variable Rate Debt Security.
 
     An 'objective rate' is a rate that is not itself a qualified floating rate
but which is determined using a single fixed formula and which is based upon (i)
one or more qualified floating rates, (ii) one or more rates where each rate
would be a qualified floating rate for a debt instrument denominated in a
currency other than the currency in which the Variable Rate Debt Security is
denominated, (iii) either the yield or changes in the price of one or more items
of actively traded personal property or (iv) a combination of rates described in
(i), (ii) and (iii). The OID Regulations also provide that other variable rates
may be treated as objective rates if so designated by the Internal Revenue
Service in the future. Despite the foregoing, a variable rate of interest on a
Variable Rate Debt Security will not constitute an objective rate if it is
reasonably expected that the average value of such rate during the first half of
the Variable Rate Debt Security's term will be either significantly less than or
significantly greater than the average value of the rate during the final half
of the Variable Rate Debt Security's term. An objective rate
 
                                       56
<PAGE>
will qualify as a 'qualified inverse floating rate' if such rate is equal to a
fixed rate minus a qualified floating rate and variations in the rate can
reasonably be expected to inversely reflect contemporaneous variations in the
cost of newly borrowed funds. The OID Regulations also provide that if a
Variable Rate Debt Security provides for stated interest at a fixed rate for an
initial period of less than one year followed by a variable rate that is either
a qualified floating rate or an objective rate and if the variable rate on the
Variable Rate Debt Security's issue date is intended to approximate the fixed
rate, then the fixed rate and the variable rate together will constitute either
a single qualified floating rate or objective rate, as the case may be (a
'Presumed Single Variable Rate'). If the value of the variable rate and the
initial fixed rate are within 25 basis points of each other as determined on the
Variable Rate Debt Security's issue date, the variable rate will be conclusively
presumed to approximate the fixed rate.
 
     For Variable Rate Debt Securities that qualify as a 'variable rate debt
instrument' under the OID Regulations and provide for interest at either a
single qualified floating rate, a single objective rate, a Presumed Single
Qualified Floating Rate or a Presumed Single Variable Rate throughout the term
(a 'Single Variable Rate Debt Security'), original issue discount is computed as
described above based on the following: (i) stated interest on the Single
Variable Rate Debt Security which is unconditionally payable in cash or property
(other than debt instruments of the issuer) at least annually will constitute
qualified stated interest and (ii) by assuming that the variable rate on the
Single Variable Debt Security is a fixed rate equal to: (a) in the case of a
Single Variable Rate Debt Security with a qualified floating rate or a qualified
inverse floating rate, the value of, as of the issue date, of the qualified
floating rate or the qualified inverse floating rate or (b) in the case of a
Single Variable Rate Debt Security with an objective rate (other than a
qualified inverse floating rate), a fixed rate which reflects the reasonably
expected yield for such Single Variable Debt Security.
 
     In general, any Variable Rate Debt Security other than a Single Variable
Rate Debt Security (a 'Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security') that qualifies as
a 'variable rate debt instrument' will be converted into an 'equivalent' fixed
rate debt instrument for purposes of determining the amount and accrual of
original issue discount and qualified stated interest on the Multiple Variable
Rate Debt Security. The OID Regulations generally require that such a Multiple
Variable Rate Debt Security be converted into an 'equivalent' fixed rate debt
instrument by substituting any qualified floating rate or qualified inverse
floating rate provided for under the terms of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt
Security with a fixed rate equal to the value of the qualified floating rate or
qualified inverse floating rate, as the case may be, as of the Multiple Variable
Rate Debt Security's issue date. Any objective rate (other than a qualified
inverse floating rate) provided for under the terms of the Multiple Variable
Rate Debt Security is converted into a fixed rate that reflects the yield that
is reasonably expected for the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security. In the case
of a Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security that qualifies as a 'variable rate
debt instrument' and provides for stated interest at a fixed rate in addition to
either one or more qualified floating rates or a qualified inverse floating
rate, the fixed rate is initially converted into a qualified floating rate (or a
qualified inverse floating rate, if the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security
provides for a qualified inverse floating rate). Under such circumstances, the
qualified floating rate or qualified inverse floating rate that replaces the
fixed rate must be such that the fair market value of the Multiple Variable Rate
Debt Security as of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security's issue date is
approximately the same as the fair market value of an otherwise identical debt
instrument that provides for either the qualified floating rate or qualified
inverse floating rate rather than the fixed rate. Subsequent to converting the
fixed rate into either a qualified floating rate or a qualified inverse floating
rate, the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security is then converted into an
'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument in the manner described above.
 
     Once the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security is converted into an
'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument pursuant to the foregoing rules, the
amount of original issue discount and qualified stated interest, if any, are
determined for the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument by applying the
original issue discount rules to the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument in
the manner described above. A Holder of the Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security
will account for such original issue discount and qualified stated interest as
if the Holder held the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument. Each accrual
period appropriate adjustments will be made to the amount of qualified stated
interest or original issue discount assumed to have been accrued or paid with
respect to the 'equivalent' fixed rate debt instrument in the event that such
amounts differ from the accrual amount of interest accrued or paid on the
Multiple Variable Rate Debt Security during the accrual period.
 
                                       57
<PAGE>
     The OID Regulations do not clearly address the treatment of a Variable Rate
Debt Security that is based on a weighted average of the interest rates on
underlying Loans. Under the OID Regulations, interest payments on such a
Variable Rate Debt Security may be characterized as qualified stated interest
which is includible in income in a manner similar to that described in the
previous paragraph. However, it is also possible that interest payments on such
a Variable Rate Debt Security would be treated as contingent interest (possibly
includible in income when the payments become fixed) or in some other manner.
 
     If a Variable Rate Debt Security does not qualify as a 'variable rate debt
instrument' under the OID Regulations, then the Variable Rate Debt Security
would be treated as a contingent payment debt obligation. It is not clear under
current law how a Variable Rate Debt Security would be taxed if such Debt
Security were treated as a contingent payment debt obligation.
 
     Market Discount.  A purchaser of a Security may be subject to the market
discount rules of Sections 1276-1278 of the Code. A Holder that acquires a Debt
Security with more than a prescribed de minimis amount of 'market discount'
(generally, the excess of the principal amount of the Debt Security over the
purchaser's purchase price) will be required to include accrued market discount
in income as ordinary income in each month, but limited to an amount not
exceeding the principal payments on the Debt Security received in that month
and, if the Securities are sold, the gain realized. Such market discount would
accrue in a manner to be provided in Treasury regulations but, until such
regulations are issued, such market discount would in general accrue either (i)
on the basis of a constant yield (in the case of a Pay-Through Security, taking
into account a prepayment assumption) or (ii) in the ratio of (a) in the case of
Securities (or in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as set forth below, the
Loans underlying such Security) not originally issued with original issue
discount, stated interest payable in the relevant period to total stated
interest remaining to be paid at the beginning of the period or (b) in the case
of Securities (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below,
the Loans underlying such Security) originally issued at a discount, OID in the
relevant period to total OID remaining to be paid.
 
     Section 1277 of the Code provides that, regardless of the origination date
of the Debt Security (or, in the case of a Pass-Through Security, the Loans),
the excess of interest paid or accrued to purchase or carry a Security (or, in
the case of a Pass-Through Security, as described below, the underlying Loans)
with market discount over interest received on such Security is allowed as a
current deduction only to the extent such excess is greater than the market
discount that accrued during the taxable year in which such interest expense was
incurred. In general, the deferred portion of any interest expense will be
deductible when such market discount is included in income, including upon the
sale, disposition, or repayment of the Security (or in the case of a
Pass-Through Security, an underlying Loan). A Holder may elect to include market
discount in income currently as it accrues, on all market discount obligations
acquired by such Holder during the taxable year such election is made and
thereafter, in which case the interest deferral rule will not apply.
 
     Premium.  A Holder who purchases a Debt Security (other than an Interest
Weighted Security to the extent described above) at a cost greater than its
stated redemption price at maturity, generally will be considered to have
purchased the Security at a premium, which it may elect to amortize as an offset
to interest income on such Security (and not as a separate deduction item) on a
constant yield method. Although no regulations addressing the computation of
premium accrual on securities similar to the Securities have been issued, the
legislative history of the 1986 Act indicates that premium is to be accrued in
the same manner as market discount. Accordingly, it appears that the accrual of
premium on a Class of Pay-Through Securities will be calculated using the
prepayment assumption used in pricing such Class. If a Holder makes an election
to amortize premium on a Debt Security, such election will apply to all taxable
debt instruments (including all REMIC regular interests and all pass-through
certificates representing ownership interests in a trust holding debt
obligations) held by the Holder at the beginning of the taxable year in which
the election is made, and to all taxable debt instruments acquired thereafter by
such Holder, and will be irrevocable without the consent of the Internal Revenue
Service. Purchasers who pay a premium for the Securities should consult their
tax advisers regarding the election to amortize premium and the method to be
employed.
 
     Election to Treat All Interest as Original Issue Discount.  The OID
Regulations permit a Holder of a Debt Security to elect to accrue all interest,
discount (including de minimis market or original issue discount) and premium in
income as interest, based on a constant yield method for Debt Securities
acquired on or after April 4,
 
                                       58
<PAGE>
1994. If such an election were to be made with respect to a Debt Security with
market discount, the Holder of the Debt Security would be deemed to have made an
election to include in income currently market discount with respect to all
other debt instruments having market discount that such Holder of the Debt
Security acquires during the year of the election or thereafter. Similarly, a
Holder of a Debt Security that makes this election for a Debt Security that is
acquired at a premium will be deemed to have made an election to amortize bond
premium with respect to all debt instruments having amortizable bond premium
that such Holder owns or acquires. The election to accrue interest, discount and
premium on a constant yield method with respect to a Debt Security is
irrevocable.
 
TAXATION OF THE REMIC AND ITS HOLDERS
 
     General.  In the opinion of Federal Tax Counsel, if a REMIC election is
made with respect to a Series of Securities, then the arrangement by which the
Securities of that Series are issued will be treated as a REMIC as long as all
of the provisions of the applicable Agreement are complied with and the
statutory and regulatory requirements are satisfied. Securities will be
designated as 'Regular Interests' or 'Residual Interests' in a REMIC, as
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Except to the extent specified otherwise in a Prospectus Supplement, if a
REMIC election is made with respect to a Series of Securities, (i) Securities
held by a mutual savings bank or domestic building and loan association will
represent interests in 'qualifying real property loans' within the meaning of
Code Section 593(d) (assuming that at least 95% of the REMIC's assets are
'qualifying real property loans'); (ii) Securities held by a domestic building
and loan association will constitute 'a regular or a residual interest in a
REMIC' within the meaning of Code Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(xi) (assuming that at
least 95% of the REMIC's assets consist of cash, government saturates, 'loans
secured by an interest in real property,' and other types of assets described in
Code Section 7701(a)(19)(C)); and (iii) Securities held by a real estate
investment trust will constitute 'real estate assets' within the meaning of Code
Section 856(c)(6)(B), and income with respect to the Saturates will be
considered 'interest on obligations secured by mortgages on real property or on
interests in real property' within the meaning of Code Section 856(c)(3)(B)
(assuming, for both purposes, that at least 95% of the REMIC's assets are
qualifying assets). If less than 95% of the REMIC's assets consist of assets
described in (i), (ii) or (iii) above, then a Security will qualify for the tax
treatment described in (i), (ii) or (iii) in the proportion that such REMIC
assets are qualifying assets.
 
REMIC EXPENSES; SINGLE CLASS REMICS
 
     As a general rule, all of the expenses of a REMIC will be taken into
account by Holders of the Residual Interest Securities. In the case of a 'single
class REMIC,' however, the expenses will be allocated, under Treasury
regulations, among the Holders of the Regular Interest Securities and the
Holders of the Residual Interest Securities on a daily basis in proportion to
the relative amounts of income accruing to each Holder on that day. In the case
of a Holder of a Regular Interest Security who is an individual or a
'pass-through interest holder' (including certain pass-through entities but not
including real estate investment trusts), such expenses will be deductible only
to the extent that such expenses, plus other 'miscellaneous itemized deductions'
of the Holder, exceed 2% of such Holder's adjusted gross income. In addition,
for taxable years beginning after December 31, 1990, the amount of itemized
deductions otherwise allowable for the taxable year for an individual whose
adjusted gross income exceeds the applicable amount (which amount will be
adjusted for inflation for taxable years beginning after 1990) will be reduced
by the lesser of (i) 3% of the excess of adjusted gross income over the
applicable amount, or (ii) 80% of the amount of itemized deductions otherwise
allowable for such taxable year. The reduction or disallowance of this deduction
may have a significant impact on the yield of the Regular Interest Security to
such a Holder. In general terms, a single class REMIC is one that either (i)
would qualify, under existing Treasury regulations, as a grantor trust if it
were not a REMIC (treating all interests as ownership interests, even if they
would be classified as debt for federal income tax purposes) or (ii) is similar
to such a trust and which is structured with the principal purpose of avoiding
the single class REMIC rules. Unless otherwise stated in the applicable
Prospectus Supplement, the expenses of the REMIC will be allocated to Holders of
the related Residual Interest Securities.
 
                                       59
<PAGE>
TAXATION OF THE REMIC
 
     General.  Although a REMIC is a separate entity for federal income tax
purposes, a REMIC is not generally subject to entity-level tax. Rather, the
taxable income or net loss of a REMIC is taken into account by the holders of
residual interests. As described above, the regular interests are generally
taxable as debt of the REMIC.
 
     Tiered REMIC Structures.  For certain Series of Securities, two or more
separate elections may be held to treat designated portions of the related Trust
Fund as REMICs ('Tiered REMICs') for federal income tax purposes. Upon the
issuance of any such Series of Securities, Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its
opinion generally to the effect that, assuming compliance with all provisions of
the related Pooling and Servicing Agreement, the Tiered REMICs will each qualify
as a REMIC and the REMIC Certificates issued by the Tiered REMICs, respectively,
will be considered to evidence ownership of Regular Certificates or Residual
Certificates in the related REMIC within the meaning of the REMIC Provisions.
 
     Solely for purposes of determining whether the REMIC Certificates will be
'qualifying real property loans' under Section 593(d) of the Code, 'real estate
assets' within the meaning of Section 856(c)(5)(A) of the Code, and 'loans
secured by an interest in real property' under Section 7701(a)(19)(C) of the
Code, and whether the income on such Certificates is interest described in
Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code, the Tiered REMICs will be treated as one
REMIC.
 
     Calculation of REMIC Income.  The taxable income or net loss of a REMIC is
determined under an accrual method of accounting and in the same manner as in
the case of an individual, with certain adjustments. In general, the taxable
income or net loss will be the difference between (i) the gross income produced
by the REMIC's assets, including stated interest and any original issue discount
or market discount on loans and other assets, and (ii) deductions, including
stated interest and original issue discount accrued on Regular Interest
Securities, amortization of any premium with respect to Loans, and servicing
fees and other expenses of the REMIC. A Holder of a Residual Interest Security
that is an individual or a 'pass-through interest holder' (including certain
pass-through entities, but not including real estate investment trusts) will be
unable to deduct servicing fees payable on the Loans or other administrative
expenses of the REMIC for a given taxable year, to the extent that such
expenses, when aggregated with such Holder's other miscellaneous itemized
deductions for that year, do not exceed two percent of such Holder's adjusted
gross income.
 
     For purposes of computing its taxable income or net loss, the REMIC should
have an initial aggregate tax basis in its assets equal to the aggregate fair
market value of the regular interests and the residual interests on the Startup
Day (generally, the day that the interests are issued). Such aggregate basis
will be allocated among the assets of the REMIC in proportion to their
respective fair market values.
 
     The OID provisions of the Code apply to loans of individuals originated on
or after March 2, 1984, and the market discount provisions apply to loans
originated after July 18, 1984. Subject to possible application of the de
minimis rules, the method of accrual by the REMIC of OID income on such loans
will be equivalent to the method under which Holders of Pay-Through Securities
accrue original issue discount (i.e., under the constant yield method taking
into account the Prepayment Assumption). The REMIC will deduct OID on the
Regular Interest Securities in the same manner that the Holders of the Regular
Interest ecurities include such discount in income, but without regard to the de
minimis rules. See 'Taxation of Debt Securities' above. However, a REMIC that
acquires loans at a market discount must include such market discount in income
currently, as it accrues, on a constant interest basis.
 
     To the extent that the REMIC's basis allocable to loans that it holds
exceeds their principal amounts, the resulting premium, if attributable to
mortgages originated after September 27, 1985, will be amortized over the life
of the loans (taking into account the Prepayment Assumption) on a constant yield
method. Although the law is somewhat unclear regarding recovery of premium
attributable to loans originated on or before such date, it is possible that
such premium may be recovered in proportion to payments of loan principal.
 
     Prohibited Transactions and Contributions Tax.  The REMIC will be subject
to a 100% tax on any net income derived from a 'prohibited transaction.' For
this purpose, net income will be calculated without taking into account any
losses from prohibited transactions or any deductions attributable to any
prohibited transaction that resulted in a loss. In general, prohibited
transactions include: (i) subject to limited exceptions, the sale or
 
                                       60
<PAGE>
other disposition of any qualified mortgage transferred to the REMIC; (ii)
subject to a limited exception, the sale or other disposition of a cash flow
investment; (iii) the receipt of any income from assets not permitted to be held
by the REMIC pursuant to the Code; or (iv) the receipt of any fees or other
compensation for services rendered by the REMIC. It is anticipated that a REMIC
will not engage in any prohibited transactions in which it would recognize a
material amount of net income. In addition, subject to a number of exceptions, a
tax is imposed at the rate of 100% on amounts contributed to a REMIC after the
close of the three-month period beginning on the Startup Day. The Holders of
Residual Interest Securities will generally be responsible for the payment of
any such taxes imposed on the REMIC. To the extent not paid by such Holders or
otherwise, however, such taxes will be paid out of the Trust Fund and will be
allocated pro rata to all outstanding Classes of Securities of such REMIC.
 
TAXATION OF HOLDERS OF RESIDUAL INTEREST SECURITIES
 
     The Holder of a Security representing a residual interest (a 'Residual
Interest Security') will take into account the 'daily portion' of the taxable
income or net loss of the REMIC for each day during the taxable year on which
such Holder held the Residual Interest Security. The daily portion is determined
by allocating to each day in any calendar quarter its ratable portion of the
taxable income or net loss of the REMIC for such quarter, and by allocating that
amount among the Holders (on such day) of the Residual Interest Securities in
proportion to their respective holdings on such day.
 
     The Holder of a Residual Interest Security must report its proportionate
share of the taxable income of the REMIC whether or not it receives cash
distributions from the REMIC attributable to such income or loss. The reporting
of taxable income without corresponding distributions could occur, for example,
in certain REMIC issues in which the loans held by the REMIC were issued or
acquired at a discount, since mortgage prepayments cause recognition of discount
income, while the corresponding portion of the prepayment could be used in whole
or in part to make principal payments on REMIC Regular Interests issued without
any discount or at an insubstantial discount. (If this occurs, it is likely that
cash distributions will exceed taxable income in later years.) Taxable income
may also be greater in earlier years of certain REMIC issues as a result of the
fact that interest expense deductions, as a percentage of outstanding principal
on REMIC Regular Interest Securities, will typically increase over time as lower
yielding Securities are paid, whereas interest income with respect to loans will
generally remain constant over time as a percentage of loan principal.
 
     In any event, because the holder of a residual interest is taxed on the net
income of the REMIC, the taxable income derived from a Residual Interest
Security in a given taxable year will not be equal to the taxable income
associated with investment in a corporate bond or stripped instrument having
similar cash flow characteristics and pretax yield. Therefore, the after-tax
yield on the Residual Interest Security may be less than that of such a bond or
instrument.
 
     Limitation on Losses.  The amount of the REMIC's net loss that a Holder may
take into account currently is limited to the Holder's adjusted basis at the end
of the calendar quarter in which such loss arises. A Holder's basis in a
Residual Interest Security will initially equal such Holder's purchase price,
and will subsequently be increased by the amount of the REMIC's taxable income
allocated to the Holder, and decreased (but not below zero) by the amount of
distributions made and the amount of the REMIC's net loss allocated to the
Holder. Any disallowed loss may be carried forward indefinitely, but may be used
only to offset income of the REMIC generated by the same REMIC. The ability of
Holders of Residual Interest Securities to deduct net losses may be subject to
additional limitations under the Code, as to which such Holders should consult
their tax advisers.
 
     Distributions.  Distributions on a Residual Interest Security (whether at
their scheduled times or as a result of prepayments) will generally not result
in any additional taxable income or loss to a Holder of a Residual Interest
Security. If the amount of such payment exceeds a holder's adjusted basis in the
Residual Interest Security, however, the Holder will recognize gain (treated as
gain from the sale of the Residual Interest Security) to the extent of such
excess.
 
     Sale or Exchange.  A Holder of a Residual Interest Security will recognize
gain or loss on the sale or exchange of a Residual Interest Security equal to
the difference, if any, between the amount realized and such Holder's adjusted
basis in the Residual Interest Security at the time of such sale or exchange.
Except to the extent provided in regulations, which have not yet been issued,
any loss upon disposition of a Residual Interest Security
 
                                       61
<PAGE>
will be disallowed if the selling Holder acquires any residual interest in a
REMIC or similar mortgage pool within six months before or after such
disposition.
 
     Excess Inclusions.  The portion of the REMIC taxable income of a Holder of
a Residual Interest Security consisting of 'excess inclusion' income may not be
offset by other deductions or losses, including net operating losses, on such
Holder's federal income tax return. An exception applies to organizations to
which Code Section 593 applies (generally, certain thrift institutions);
however, such exception will not apply if the aggregate value of the Residual
Interest Securities is not considered to be 'significant,' as described below.
Further, if the Holder of a Residual Interest Security is an organization
subject to the tax on unrelated business income imposed by Code Section 511,
such Holder's excess inclusion income will be treated as unrelated business
taxable income of such Holder. In addition, under Treasury regulations yet to be
issued, if a real estate investment trust, a regulated investment company, a
common trust fund, or certain cooperatives were to own a Residual Interest
Security, a portion of dividends (or other distributions) paid by the real
estate investment trust (or other entity) would be treated as excess inclusion
income. If a Residual Security is owned by a foreign person, excess inclusion
income is subject to tax at a rate of 30% which may not be reduced by treaty, is
not eligible for treatment as 'portfolio interest' and is subject to certain
additional limitations. See 'Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors.' Regulations
provide that a Residual Interest Security has significant value only if (i) the
aggregate issue price of the Residual Interest Security is at least 2% of the
aggregate of the issue prices of all Regular Interest Securities and Residual
Interest Securities in the REMIC and (ii) the anticipated weighted average life
(determined as specified in the Proposed Regulations) of the Residual Interest
Securities is at least 20% of the weighted average life of the REMIC.
 
     The excess inclusion portion of a REMIC's income is generally equal to the
excess, if any, of REMIC taxable income for the quarterly period allocable to a
Residual Interest Security, over the daily accruals for such quarterly period of
(i) 120% of the long term applicable federal rate on the Startup Date multiplied
by (ii) the adjusted issue price of such Residual Interest Security at the
beginning of such quarterly period. The adjusted issue price of a Residual
Interest Security at the beginning of each calendar quarter will equal its issue
price (calculated in a manner analogous to the determination of the issue price
of a Regular Interest Security), increased by the aggregate of the daily
accruals for prior calendar quarters, and decreased (but not below zero) by the
amount of loss allocated to a Holder and the amount of distributions made on the
Residual Interest Security before the beginning of the quarter. The long-term
federal rate, which is announced monthly by the Treasury Department, is an
interest rate that is based on the average market yield of outstanding
marketable obligations of the United States government having remaining
maturities in excess of nine years.
 
     Under the REMIC Regulations, in certain circumstances, transfers of
Residual Interest Securities may be disregarded. See '--Restrictions on
Ownership and Transfer of Residual Interest Securities' and '--Tax Treatment of
Foreign Investors' below.
 
     Restrictions on Ownership and Transfer of Residual Interest Securities.  As
a condition to qualification as a REMIC, reasonable arrangements must be made to
prevent the ownership of a REMIC residual interest by any 'Disqualified
Organization.' Disqualified Organizations include the United States, any State
or political subdivision thereof, any foreign government, any international
organization, or any agency or instrumentality of any of the foregoing, a rural
electric or telephone cooperative described in Section 1381(a)(2)(C) of the
Code, or any entity exempt from the tax imposed by Sections 1-1399 of the Code,
if such entity is not subject to tax on its unrelated business income.
Accordingly, the applicable Pooling and Servicing Agreement will prohibit
Disqualified Organizations from owning a Residual Interest Security. In
addition, no transfer of a Residual Interest Security will be permitted unless
the proposed transferee shall have furnished to the Trustee an affidavit
representing and warranting that it is neither a Disqualified Organization nor
an agent or nominee acing on behalf of a Disqualified Organization.
 
     If a Residual Interest Security is transferred to a Disqualified
Organization after March 31, 1988 (in violation of the restrictions set forth
above), a substantial tax will be imposed on the transferor of such Residual
Interest Security at the time of the transfer. In addition, if a Disqualified
Organization holds an interest in a pass-through entity after March 31, 1988
(including, among others, a partnership, trust, real estate investment trust,
regulated investment company, or any person holding as nominee), that owns a
Residual Interest Security, the
 
                                       62
<PAGE>
pass-through entity will be required to pay an annual tax on its allocable share
of the excess inclusion income of the REMIC.
 
     Under the REMIC Regulations, if a Residual Interest Security is a
'noneconomic residual interest,' as described below, a transfer of a Residual
Interest Security to a United States person will be disregarded for all federal
tax purposes unless no significant purpose of the transfer was to impede the
assessment or collection of tax. A Residual Interest Security is a 'noneconomic
residual interest' unless, at the time of the transfer (i) the present value of
the expected future distributions on the Residual Interest Security at least
equals the product of the present value of the anticipated excess inclusions and
the highest rate of tax for the year in which the transfer occurs, and (ii) the
transferor reasonably expects that the transferee will receive distributions
from the REMIC at or after the time at which the taxes accrue on the anticipated
excess inclusions in an amount sufficient to satisfy the accrued taxes. If a
transfer of a Residual Interest Security is disregarded, the transferor would be
liable for any federal income tax imposed upon taxable income derived by the
transferee from the REMIC. The REMIC Regulations provide no guidance as to how
to determine if a significant purpose of a transfer is to impede the assessment
or collection of tax. A similar type of limitation exists with respect to
certain transfers of residual interests by foreign persons to United States
persons. See '--Tax Treatment of Foreign Investors.'
 
     Mark to Market Rules.  Prospective purchasers of a Residual Interest
Security should be aware that on December 28, 1993, the Internal Revenue Service
released temporary regulations (the 'Temporary Mark to Market Regulations')
relating to the requirement that a securities dealer mark-to-market securities
held for sale to customers. This mark-to-market requirement applies to all
securities of a dealer, except to the extent that the dealer has specifically
identified a security as held for investment. The Temporary Mark to Market
Regulations provide that for purposes of this mark-to-market requirement, a
'negative value' Residual Interest Security is not treated as a security and
thus may not be marked to market. In addition, a dealer is not required to
identify such Residual Interest Security as held for investment. In general, a
Residual Interest Security has negative value if, as of the date a taxpayer
acquires the Residual Interest Security, the present value of the tax
liabilities associated with holding the Residual Interest Security exceeds the
sum of (i) the present value of the expected future distributions on the
Residual Interest Security, and (ii) the present value of the anticipated tax
savings associated with holding the Residual Interest Security as the REMIC
generates losses. The amounts and present values of the anticipated tax
liabilities, expected future distributions and anticipated tax savings are all
to be determined using (i) the prepayment and reinvestment assumptions adopted
under Section 1272(a)(6), or that would have been adopted had the REMIC's
regular interests been issued with OID, (ii) any required or permitted clean up
calls, or required qualified liquidation provided for in the REMIC's
organizational documents and (iii) a discount rate equal to the 'applicable
Federal rate' (as specified in Section 1274(d)(1)) that would apply to a debt
instrument issued on the date of acquisition of the Residual Interest Security.
Furthermore, the Temporary Mark to Market Regulations provide the IRS with the
authority to treat any Residual Interest Security having substantially the same
economic effect as a 'negative value' residual interest as a 'negative value'
residual interest.
 
     On January 3, 1995, the IRS released proposed regulations under Section 475
(the 'Proposed Mark-to-Market Regulations'). The Proposed Mark-to-Market
Regulations provide that any REMIC Residual Interest acquired after January 3,
1995 cannot be marked to market, regardless of the value of such REMIC residual
interest. The Temporary Mark-to-Market Regulations described above still apply
to any REMIC Residual Interest acquired on or prior to January 3, 1995. Thus,
holders of positive value REMIC Residual Interests acquired on or prior to
January 3, 1995 may continue to mark such residual interests to market for the
entire economic life of such interests.
 
                                       63
<PAGE>
ADMINISTRATIVE MATTERS
 
     The REMIC's books must be maintained on a calendar year basis and the REMIC
must file an annual federal income tax return. The REMIC will also be subject to
the procedural and administrative rules of the Code applicable to partnerships,
including the determination of any adjustments to, among other things, items of
REMIC income, gain, loss, deduction, or credit, by the IRS in a unified
administrative proceeding.
 
TAX STATUS AS A GRANTOR TRUST
 
     General.  As specified in the related Prospectus Supplement if a REMIC or
partnership election is not made, in the opinion of Federal Tax Counsel, the
Trust Fund relating to a Series of Securities will be classified for federal
income tax purposes as a grantor trust under Subpart E, Part 1 of Subchapter J
of the Code and not as an association taxable as a corporation (the Securities
of such Series, 'Pass-Through Securities'). In some Series there will be no
separation of the principal and interest payments on the Loans. In such
circumstances, a Holder will be considered to have purchased a pro rata
undivided interest in each of the Loans. In other cases ('Stripped Securities'),
sale of the Securities will produce a separation in the ownership of all or a
portion of the principal payments from all or a portion of the interest payments
on the Loans.
 
     Each Holder must report on its federal income tax return its share of the
gross income derived from the Loans (not reduced by the amount payable as fees
to the Trustee and the Servicer and similar fees (collectively, the 'Servicing
Fees')), at the same time and in the same manner as such items would have been
reported under the Holder's tax accounting method had it held its interest in
the Loans directly, received directly its share of the amounts received with
respect to the Loans, and paid directly its share of the Servicing Fees. In the
case of Pass-Through Securities other than Stripped Securities, such income will
consist of a pro rata share of all of the income derived from all of the Loans
and, in the case of Stripped Securities, such income will consist of a pro rata
share of the income derived from each stripped bond or stripped coupon in which
the Holder owns an interest. The Holder of a Security will generally be entitled
to deduct such Servicing Fees under Section 162 or Section 212 of the Code to
the extent that such Servicing Fees represent 'reasonable' compensation for the
services rendered by the Trustee and the Servicer (or third parties that are
compensated for the performance of services). In the case of a noncorporate
Holder, however, Servicing Fees (to the extent not otherwise disallowed, e.g.,
because they exceed reasonable compensation) will be deductible in computing
such Holder's regular tax liability only to the extent that such fees, when
added to other miscellaneous itemized deductions, exceed 2% of adjusted gross
income and may not be deducible to any extent in computing such Holder's
alternative minimum tax liability. In addition, for taxable years beginning
after December 31, 1990, the amount of itemized deductions otherwise allowable
for the taxable year for an individual whose adjusted gross income exceeds the
applicable amount (which amount will be adjusted for inflation in taxable years
beginning after 1990) will be reduced by the lesser of (i) 3% of the excess of
adjusted gross income over the applicable amount or (ii) 80% of the amount of
itemized deductions otherwise allowable for such taxable year.
 
     Discount or Premium on Pass-Through Securities.  The Holder's purchase
price of a Pass-Through Security is to be allocated among the Loans in
proportion to their fair market values, determined as of the time of purchase of
the Securities. In the typical case, the Trustee (to the extent necessary to
fulfill its reporting obligations) will treat each Loan as having a fair market
value proportional to the share of the aggregate principal balances of all of
the Loans that it represents, since the Securities, unless otherwise specified
in the applicable Prospectus Supplement, will have a relatively uniform interest
rate and other common characteristics. To the extent that the portion of the
purchase price of a Pass-Through Security allocated to a Loan (other than to a
right to receive any accrued interest thereon and any undistributed principal
payments) is less than or greater than the portion of the principal balance of
the Loan allocable to the Security, the interest in the Loan allocable to the
Pass-Through Security will be deemed to have been acquired at a discount or
premium, respectively.
 
     The treatment of any discount will depend on whether the discount
represents OID or market discount. In the case of a Loan with OID in excess of a
prescribed de minimis amount or a Stripped Security, a Holder of a Security will
be required to report as interest income in each taxable year its share of the
amount of OID that accrues during that year in the manner described above. OID
with respect to a Loan could arise, for example, by virtue of the financing of
points by the originator of the Loan, or by virtue of the charging of points by
the originator of the Loan in an amount greater than a statutory de minimis
exception, in circumstances under which
 
                                       64
<PAGE>
the points are not currently deductible pursuant to applicable Code provisions.
Any market discount or premium on a Loan will be includible in income, generally
in the manner described above, except that in the case of Pass-Through
Securities, market discount is calculated with respect to the Loans underlying
the Security, rather than with respect to the Security. A Holder that acquires
an interest in a Loan originated after July 18, 1984 with more than a de minimis
amount of market discount (generally, the excess of the principal amount of the
Loan over the purchaser's allocable purchase price) will be required to include
accrued market discount in income in the manner set forth above. See '--Taxation
of Debt Securities; Market Discount' and '--Premium' above.
 
     In the case of market discount on a Pass-Through Security attributable to
Loans originated on or before July 18, 1984, the Holder generally will be
required to allocate the portion of such discount that is allocable to a Loan
among the principal payments on the Loan and to include the discount allocable
to each principal payment in ordinary income at the time such principal payment
is made. Such treatment would generally result in discount being included in
income at a slower rate than discount would be required to be included in income
using the method described in the preceding paragraph.
 
     Stripped Securities.  A Stripped Security may represent a right to receive
only a portion of the interest payments on the Loans, a right to receive only
principal payments on the Loans, or a right to receive certain payments of both
interest and principal. Certain Stripped Securities ('Ratio Strip Securities')
may represent a right to receive differing percentages of both the interest and
principal on each Loan. Pursuant to Section 1286 of the Code, the separation of
ownership of the right to receive some or all of the interest payments on an
obligation from ownership of the right to receive some or all of the principal
payments results in the creation of 'stripped bonds' with respect to principal
payments and 'stripped coupons' with respect to interest payments. Section 1286
of the Code applies the OID rules to stripped bonds and stripped coupons. For
purposes of computing original issue discount, a stripped bond or a stripped
coupon is treated as a debt instrument issued on the date that such stripped
interest is purchased with an issue price equal to its purchase price or, if
more than one stripped interest is purchased, the ratable share of the purchase
price allocable to such stripped interest.
 
     Servicing Fees in excess of reasonable servicing fees ('excess servicing')
will be treated under the stripped bond rules. If the excess servicing fee is
less than 100 basis points (i.e. 1% interest on the Loan principal balance) or
the Securities are initially sold with a de minimis discount (assuming no
prepayment assumption is required), any non-de minimis discount arising from a
subsequent transfer of the Securities should be treated as market discount. The
IRS appears to require that reasonable servicing fees be calculated on a Loan by
Loan basis, which could result in some Loans being treated as having more than
100 basis points of interest stripped off.
 
     The Code, OID Regulations and judicial decisions provide no direct guidance
as to how the interest and original issue discount rules are to apply to
Stripped Securities and other Pass-Through Securities. Under the method
described above for Pay-Through Securities (the 'Cash Flow Bond Method'), a
prepayment assumption is used and periodic recalculations are made which take
into account with respect to each accrual period the effect of prepayments
during such period. However, the 1986 Act does not, absent Treasury regulations,
appear specifically to cover instruments such as the Stripped Securities which
technically represent ownership interests in the underlying Loans, rather than
being debt instruments 'secured by' those Loans. Nevertheless, it is believed
that the Cash Flow Bond Method is a reasonable method of reporting income for
such Securities, and it is expected that OID will be reported on that basis
unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement. In applying the
calculation to Pass-Through Securities, the Trustee will treat all payments to
be received by a Holder with respect to the underlying Loans as payments on a
single installment obligation. The IRS could, however, assert that original
issue discount must be calculated separately for each Loan underlying a
Security.
 
     Under certain circumstances, if the Loans prepay at a rate faster than the
Prepayment Assumption, the use of the Cash Flow Bond Method may accelerate a
Holder's recognition of income. If, however, the Loans prepay at a rate slower
than the Prepayment Assumption, in some circumstances the use of this method may
decelerate a Holder's recognition of income.
 
     Possible Alternative Characterizations.  The characterizations of the
Stripped Securities described above are not the only possible interpretations of
the applicable Code provisions. Among other possibilities, the Internal Revenue
Service could contend that (i) in certain Series, each Security is composed of
an unstripped undivided ownership interest in Loans and an installment
obligation consisting of stripped principal payments; (ii) the
 
                                       65
<PAGE>
Securities are subject to the contingent payment provisions of the Proposed
Regulations; or (iii) each Stripped Security the payments on which consist
primarily or solely of a specified portion of the interest payments on Loans is
composed of an unstripped undivided ownership interest in Loans and an
installment obligation consisting of stripped interest payments.
 
     Given the variety of alternatives for treatment of the Stripped Securities
and the different federal income tax consequences that result from each
alternative, potential purchasers are urged to consult their own tax advisers
regarding the proper treatment of the Securities for federal income tax
purposes.
 
     Character as Qualifying Loans.  In the case of Stripped Securities there is
no specific legal authority existing regarding whether the character of the
Securities, for federal income tax purposes, will be the same as the Loans. The
IRS could take the position that the Loans' character is not carried over to the
Securities in such circumstances. To the extent the Trust Fund's assets are
qualifying assets, Pass-Through Securities will be, and, although the matter is
not free from doubt, Stripped Securities should be considered to represent
'qualifying real property loans' within the meaning of Section 593(d) of the
Code, 'real estate assets' within the meaning of Section 856(c)(6)(B) of the
Code, and 'loans secured by an interest in real property' within the meaning of
Section 7701(a)(19)(C)(v) of the Code; and interest income attributable to the
Securities should be considered to represent 'interest on obligations secured by
mortgages on real property or on interests in real property' with the meaning of
Section 856(c)(3)(B) of the Code. Reserves or funds underlying the Securities
may cause a proportionate reduction in the above-described qualifying status
categories of Securities.
 
SALE OR EXCHANGE
 
     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as to which a
partnership election is made, a Holder's tax basis in its Security is the price
such Holder pays for a Security, plus amounts of original issue or market
discount included in income and reduced by any payments received (other than
qualified stated interest payments) and any amortized premium. Gain or loss
recognized on a sale, exchange, or redemption of a Security, measured by the
difference between the amount realized and the Security's basis as so adjusted,
will generally be capital gain or loss, assuming that the Security is held as a
capital asset. In the case of a Security held by a bank, thrift, or similar
institution described in Section 582 of the Code, however, gain or loss realized
on the sale or exchange of a Regular Interest Security will be taxable as
ordinary income or loss. In addition, gain from the disposition of a Regular
Interest Security that might otherwise be capital gain will be treated as
ordinary income to the extent of the excess, if any, of (i) the amount that
would have been includible in the Holder's income if the yield on such Regular
Interest Security had equaled 110% of the applicable federal rate as of the
beginning of such Holder' s holding period, over the amount of ordinary income
actually recognized by the Holder with respect to such Regular Interest
Security. For taxable years beginning after December 31, 1993, the maximum tax
rate on ordinary income for individual taxpayers is 39.6% and the maximum tax
rate on long-term capital gains reported after December 31, 1990 for such
taxpayers is 28%. The maximum tax rate on both ordinary income and long-term
capital gains of corporate taxpayers is 35%.
 
MISCELLANEOUS TAX ASPECTS
 
     Backup Withholding.  Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust
Funds as to which a partnership election is made, a Holder, other than a Holder
of a Residual Interest Security, may, under certain circumstances, be subject to
'backup withholding' at a rate of 31% with respect to distributions or the
proceeds of a sale of certificates to or through brokers that represent interest
or original issue discount on the Securities. This withholding generally applies
if the Holder of a Security (i) fails to furnish the Trustee with its taxpayer
identification number ('TIN'); (ii) furnishes the Trustee an incorrect TIN;
(iii) fails to report properly interest, dividends or other 'reportable
payments' as defined in the Code; or (iv) under certain circumstances, fails to
provide the Trustee or such Holder's securities broker with a certified
statement, signed under penalty of perjury, that the TIN provided is its correct
number and that the Holder is not subject to backup withholding. Backup
withholding will not apply, however, with respect to certain payments made to
Holders, including payments to certain exempt recipients (such as exempt
organizations) and to certain Nonresidents (as defined below). Holders should
consult their tax advisers as to their qualification for exemption from backup
withholding and the procedure for obtaining the exemption.
 
                                       66
<PAGE>
     The Trustee will report to the Holders and to the Servicer for each
calendar year the amount of any 'reportable payments' during such year and the
amount of tax withheld, if any, with respect to payments on the Securities.
 
TAX TREATMENT OF FOREIGN INVESTORS
 
     Subject to the discussion below with respect to Trust Funds as to which a
partnership election is made, under the Code, unless interest (including OID)
paid on a Security (other than a Residual Interest Security) is considered to be
'effectively connected' with a trade or business conducted in the United States
by a nonresident alien individual, foreign partnership or foreign corporation
('Nonresidents'), such interest will normally qualify as portfolio interest
(except where (i) the recipient is a holder, directly or by attribution, of 10%
or more of the capital or profits interest in the issuer, or (ii) the recipient
is a controlled foreign corporation to which the issuer is a related person) and
will be exempt from federal income tax. Upon receipt of appropriate ownership
statements, the issuer normally will be relieved of obligations to withhold tax
from such interest payments. These provisions supersede the generally applicable
provisions of United States law that would otherwise require the issuer to
withhold at a 30% rate (unless such rate were reduced or eliminated by an
applicable tax treaty) on, among other things, interest and other fixed or
determinable, annual or periodic income paid to Nonresidents. Holders of
Pass-Through Securities and Stripped Securities, including Ratio Strip
Securities, however, may be subject to withholding to the extent that the Loans
were originated on or before July 18, 1984.
 
     Interest and OID of Holders who are foreign persons are not subject to
withholding if they are effectively connected with a United States business
conducted by the Holder. They will, however, generally be subject to the regular
United States income tax.
 
     Payments to Holders of Residual Interest Securities who are foreign persons
will generally be treated as interest for purposes of the 30% (or lower treaty
rate) United States withholding tax. Holders should assume that such income does
not qualify for exemption from United States withholding tax as 'portfolio
interest.' It is clear that, to the extent that a payment represents a portion
of REMIC taxable income that constitutes excess inclusion income, a Holder of a
Residual Interest Security will not be entitled to an exemption from or
reduction of the 30% (or lower treaty rate) withholding tax rule. If the
payments are subject to United States withholding tax, they generally will be
taken into account for withholding tax purposes only when paid or distributed
(or when the Residual Interest Security is disposed of). The Treasury has
statutory authority, however, to promulgate regulations which would require such
amounts to be taken into account at an earlier time in order to prevent the
avoidance of tax. Such regulations could, for example, require withholding prior
to the distribution of cash in the case of Residual Interest Securities that do
not have significant value. Under the REMIC Regulations, if a Residual Interest
Security has tax avoidance potential, a transfer of a Residual Interest Security
to a Nonresident will be disregarded for all federal tax purposes. A Residual
Interest Security has tax avoidance potential unless, at the time of the
transfer the transferor reasonably expects that the REMIC will distribute to the
transferee residual interest holder amounts that will equal at least 30% of each
excess inclusion, and that such amounts will be distributed at or after the time
at which the excess inclusions accrue and not later than the calendar year
following the calendar year of accrual. If a Nonresident transfers a Residual
Interest Security to a United States person, and if the transfer has the effect
of allowing the transferor to avoid tax on accrued excess inclusions, then the
transfer is disregarded and the transferor continues to be treated as the owner
of the Residual Interest Security for purposes of the withholding tax provisions
of the Code. See '--Excess Inclusions.'
 
TAX CHARACTERIZATION OF THE TRUST AS A PARTNERSHIP
 
     Federal Tax Counsel will deliver its opinion that a Trust Fund for which a
partnership election is made will not be an association (or publicly traded
partnership) taxable as a corporation for federal income tax purposes. This
opinion will be based on the assumption that the terms of the Trust Agreement
and related documents will be complied with, and on counsel's conclusions that
(1) the Trust Fund will not have certain characteristics necessary for a
business trust to be classified as an association taxable as a corporation and
(2) the nature of the income of the Trust Fund will exempt it from the rule that
certain publicly traded partnerships are taxable as corporations or the issuance
of the Certificates has been structured as a private placement under an IRS safe
harbor, so that the Trust Fund will not be characterized as a publicly traded
partnership taxable as a corporation.
 
                                       67
<PAGE>
     If the Trust Fund were taxable as a corporation for federal income tax
purposes, the Trust Fund would be subject to corporate income tax on its taxable
income. The Trust Fund's taxable income would include all its income, possibly
reduced by its interest expense on the Notes. Any such corporate income tax
could materially reduce cash available to make payments on the Notes and
distributions on the Certificates, and Certificateholders could be liable for
any such tax that is unpaid by the Trust Fund.
 
TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE NOTES
 
     Treatment of the Notes as Indebtedness.  The Trust Fund will agree, and the
Noteholders will agree by their purchase of Notes, to treat the Notes as debt
for federal income tax purposes. Except as otherwise provided in the related
Prospectus Supplement, Federal Tax Counsel will advise the Depositor that the
Notes will be classified as debt for federal income tax purposes. The discussion
below assumes this characterization of the Notes is correct.
 
     OID, Indexed Securities, etc.  The discussion below assumes that all
payments on the Notes are denominated in U.S. dollars, and that the Notes are
not Indexed Securities or Strip Notes. Moreover, the discussion assumes that the
interest formula for the Notes meets the requirements for 'qualified stated
interest' under the OID regulations, and that any OID on the Notes (i.e., any
excess of the principal amount of the Notes over their issue price) does not
exceed a de minimis amount (i.e., 0.25% of their principal amount multiplied by
the number of full years included in their term), all within the meaning of the
OID regulations. If these conditions are not satisfied with respect to any given
Series of Notes, additional tax considerations with respect to such Notes will
be disclosed in the applicable Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Interest Income on the Notes.  Based on the above assumptions, except as
discussed in the following paragraph, the Notes will not be considered issued
with OID. The stated interest thereon will be taxable to a Noteholder as
ordinary interest income when received or accrued in accordance with such
Noteholder's method of tax accounting. Under the OID regulations, a Holder of a
Note issued with a de minimis amount of OID must include such OID in income, on
a pro rata basis, as principal payments are made on the Note. It is believed
that any prepayment premium paid as a result of a mandatory redemption will be
taxable as contingent interest when it becomes fixed and unconditionally
payable. A purchaser who buys a Note for more or less than its principal amount
will generally be subject, respectively, to the premium amortization or market
discount rules of the Code.
 
     A holder of a Note that has a fixed maturity date of not more than one year
from the issue date of such Note (a 'Short-Term Note') may be subject to special
rules. An accrual basis Holder of a Short-Term Note (and certain cash method
Holders, including regulated investment companies, as set forth in Section 1281
of the Code) generally would be required to report interest income as interest
accrues on a straight-line basis over the term of each interest period. Other
cash basis Holders of a Short-Term Note would, in general, be required to report
interest income as interest is paid (or, if earlier, upon the taxable
disposition of the Short-Term Note). However, a cash basis Holder of a
Short-Term Note reporting interest income as it is paid may be required to defer
a portion of any interest expense otherwise deductible on indebtedness incurred
to purchase or carry the Short-Term Note until the taxable disposition of the
Short-Term Note. A cash basis taxpayer may elect under Section 1281 of the Code
to accrue interest income on all nongovernment debt obligations with a term of
one year or less, in which case the taxpayer would include interest on the
Short-Term Note in income as it accrues, but would not be subject to the
interest expense deferral rule referred to in the preceding sentence. Certain
special rules apply if a Short-Term Note is purchased for more or less than its
principal amount.
 
     Sale or Other Disposition.  If a Noteholder sells a Note, the Holder will
recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the amount
realized on the sale and the Holder's adjusted tax basis in the Note. The
adjusted tax basis of a Note to a particular Noteholder will equal the Holder's
cost for the Note, increased by any market discount, acquisition discount, OID
and gain previously included by such Noteholder in income with respect to the
Note and decreased by the amount of bond premium (if any) previously amortized
and by the amount of principal payments previously received by such Noteholder
with respect to such Note. Any such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss if
the Note was held as a capital asset, except for gain representing accrued
interest and accrued market discount not previously included in income. Capital
losses generally may be used only to offset capital gains.
 
     Foreign Holders.  Interest payments made (or accrued) to a Noteholder who
is a nonresident alien, foreign corporation or other non-United States person (a
'foreign person') generally will be considered 'portfolio
 
                                       68
<PAGE>
interest', and generally will not be subject to United States federal income tax
and withholding tax, if the interest is not effectively connected with the
conduct of a trade or business within the United States by the foreign person
and the foreign person (i) is not actually or constructively a '10 percent
shareholder' of the Trust or the Seller (including a Holder of 10% of the
outstanding Certificates) or a 'controlled foreign corporation' with respect to
which the Trust or the Seller is a 'related person' within the meaning of the
Code and (ii) provides the Owner Trustee or other person who is otherwise
required to withhold U.S. tax with respect to the Notes with an appropriate
statement (on Form W-8 or a similar form), signed under penalties of perjury,
certifying that the beneficial owner of the Note is a foreign person and
providing the foreign person's name and address. If a Note is held through a
securities clearing organization or certain other financial institutions, the
organization or institution may provide the relevant signed statement to the
withholding agent; in that case, however, the signed statement must be
accompanied by a Form W-8 or substitute form provided by the foreign person that
owns the Note. If such interest is not portfolio interest, then it will be
subject to United States federal income and withholding tax at a rate of 30
percent, unless reduced or eliminated pursuant to an applicable tax treaty.
 
     Any capital gain realized on the sale, redemption, retirement or other
taxable disposition of a Note by a foreign person will be exempt from United
States federal income and withholding tax, provided that (i) such gain is not
effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business in the United
States by the foreign person and (ii) in the case of an individual foreign
person, the foreign person is not present in the United States for 183 days or
more in the taxable year.
 
     Backup Withholding.  Each Holder of a Note (other than an exempt Holder
such as a corporation, tax-exempt organization, qualified pension and
profit-sharing trust, individual retirement account or nonresident alien who
provides certification as to status as a nonresident) will be required to
provide, under penalties of perjury, a certificate containing the Holder's name,
address, correct federal taxpayer identification number and a statement that the
holder is not subject to backup withholding. Should a nonexempt Noteholder fail
to provide the required certification, the Trust Fund will be required to
withhold 31 percent of the amount otherwise payable to the Holder, and remit the
withheld amount to the IRS as a credit against the Holder's federal income tax
liability.
 
     Possible Alternative Treatments of the Notes.  If, contrary to the opinion
of Federal Tax Counsel, the IRS successfully asserted that one or more of the
Notes did not represent debt for federal income tax purposes, the Notes might be
treated as equity interests in the Trust Fund. If so treated, the Trust Fund
might be taxable as a corporation with the adverse consequences described above
(and the taxable corporation would not be able to reduce its taxable income by
deductions for interest expense on Notes recharacterized as equity).
Alternatively, and most likely in the view of Federal Tax Counsel, the Trust
Fund might be treated as a publicly traded partnership that would not be taxable
as a corporation because it would meet certain qualifying income tests.
Nonetheless, treatment of the Notes as equity interests in such a publicly
traded partnership could have adverse tax consequences to certain Holders. For
example, income to certain tax-exempt entities (including pension funds) would
be 'unrelated business taxable income', income to foreign holders generally
would be subject to U.S. tax and U.S. tax return filing and withholding
requirements, and individual Holders might be subject to certain limitations on
their ability to deduct their share of the Trust Fund's expenses.
 
TAX CONSEQUENCES TO HOLDERS OF THE CERTIFICATES
 
     Treatment of the Trust Fund as a Partnership.  The Trust Fund and the
Depositor will agree, and the Certificateholders will agree by their purchase of
Certificates, to treat the Trust Fund as a partnership for purposes of federal
and state income tax, franchise tax and any other tax measured in whole or in
part by income, with the assets of the partnership being the assets held by the
Trust Fund, the partners of the partnership being the Certificateholders, and
the Notes being debt of the partnership. However, the proper characterization of
the arrangement involving the Trust Fund, the Certificates, the Notes, the Trust
Fund and the Servicer is not clear because there is no authority on transactions
closely comparable to that contemplated herein.
 
     A variety of alternative characterizations are possible. For example,
because the Certificates have certain features characteristic of debt, the
Certificates might be considered debt of the Trust Fund. Any such
characterization would not result in materially adverse tax consequences to
Certificateholders as compared to the consequences from treatment of the
Certificates as equity in a partnership, described below. The following
discussion assumes that the Certificates represent equity interests in a
partnership.
 
                                       69
<PAGE>
     Indexed Securities, etc.  The following discussion assumes that all
payments on the Certificates are denominated in U.S. dollars, none of the
Certificates are Indexed Securities or Strip Certificates, and that a Series of
Securities includes a single Class of Certificates. If these conditions are not
satisfied with respect to any given Series of Certificates, additional tax
considerations with respect to such Certificates will be disclosed in the
applicable Prospectus Supplement.
 
     Partnership Taxation.  As a partnership, the Trust Fund will not be subject
to federal income tax. Rather, each Certificateholder will be required to
separately take into account such Holder's allocated share of income, gains,
losses, deductions and credits of the Trust Fund. The Trust Fund's income will
consist primarily of interest and finance charges earned on the Loans (including
appropriate adjustments for market discount, OID and bond premium) and any gain
upon collection or disposition of Loans. The Trust Fund's deductions will
consist primarily of interest accruing with respect to the Notes, servicing and
other fees, and losses or deductions upon collection or disposition of Loans.
 
     The tax items of a partnership are allocable to the partners in accordance
with the Code, Treasury regulations and the partnership agreement (here, the
Trust Agreement and related documents). The Trust Agreement will provide, in
general, that the Certificateholders will be allocated taxable income of the
Trust Fund for each month equal to the sum of (i) the interest that accrues on
the Certificates in accordance with their terms for such month, including
interest accruing at the Pass-Through Rate for such month and interest on
amounts previously due on the Certificates but not yet distributed; (ii) any
Trust Fund income attributable to discount on the Loans that corresponds to any
excess of the principal amount of the Certificates over their initial issue
price; (iii) prepayment premium payable to the Certificateholders for such
month; and (iv) any other amounts of income payable to the Certificateholders
for such month. Such allocation will be reduced by any amortization by the Trust
Fund of premium on Loans that corresponds to any excess of the issue price of
Certificates over their principal amount. All remaining taxable income of the
Trust Fund will be allocated to the Depositor. Based on the economic arrangement
of the parties, this approach for allocating Trust Fund income should be
permissible under applicable Treasury regulations, although no assurance can be
given that the IRS would not require a greater amount of income to be allocated
to Certificateholders. Moreover, even under the foregoing method of allocation,
Certificateholders may be allocated income equal to the entire Pass-Through Rate
plus the other items described above even though the Trust Fund might not have
sufficient cash to make current cash distributions of such amount. Thus, cash
basis Holders will in effect be required to report income from the Certificates
on the accrual basis and Certificateholders may become liable for taxes on Trust
Fund income even if they have not received cash from the Trust Fund to pay such
taxes. In addition, because tax allocations and tax reporting will be done on a
uniform basis for all Certificateholders but Certificateholders may be
purchasing Certificates at different times and at different prices,
Certificateholders may be required to report on their tax returns taxable income
that is greater or less than the amount reported to them by the Trust Fund.
 
     All of the taxable income allocated to a Certificateholder that is a
pension, profit sharing or employee benefit plan or other tax-exempt entity
(including an individual retirement account) will constitute 'unrelated business
taxable income' generally taxable to such a Holder under the Code.
 
     An individual taxpayer's share of expenses of the Trust Fund (including
fees to the Servicer but not interest expense) would be miscellaneous itemized
deductions. Such deductions might be disallowed to the individual in whole or in
part and might result in such Holder being taxed on an amount of income that
exceeds the amount of cash actually distributed to such Holder over the life of
the Trust Fund.
 
     The Trust Fund intends to make all tax calculations relating to income and
allocations to Certificateholders on an aggregate basis. If the IRS were to
require that such calculations be made separately for each Loan, the Trust Fund
might be required to incur additional expense but it is believed that there
would not be a material adverse effect on Certificateholders.
 
     Discount and Premium.  It is believed that the Loans were not issued with
OID and, therefore, the Trust should not have OID income. However, the purchase
price paid by the Trust Fund for the Loans may be greater or less than the
remaining principal balance of the Loans at the time of purchase. If so, the
Loan will have been acquired at a premium or discount, as the case may be. (As
indicated above, the Trust Fund will make this calculation on an aggregate
basis, but might be required to recompute it on a Loan by Loan basis.)
 
                                       70
<PAGE>
     If the Trust Fund acquires the Loans at a market discount or premium, the
Trust Fund will elect to include any such discount in income currently as it
accrues over the life of the Loans or to offset any such premium against
interest income on the Loans. As indicated above, a portion of such market
discount income or premium deduction may be allocated to Certificateholders.
 
     Section 708 Termination.  Under Section 708 of the Code, the Trust Fund
will be deemed to terminate for federal income tax purposes if 50% or more of
the capital and profits interests in the Trust Fund are sold or exchanged within
a 12-month period. If such a termination occurs, the Trust Fund will be
considered to distribute its assets to the partners, who would then be treated
as recontributing those assets to the Trust Fund as a new partnership. The Trust
Fund will not comply with certain technical requirements that might apply when
such a constructive termination occurs. As a result, the Trust Fund may be
subject to certain tax penalties and may incur additional expenses if it is
required to comply with those requirements. Furthermore, the Trust Fund might
not be able to comply due to lack of data.
 
     Disposition of Certificates.  Generally, capital gain or loss will be
recognized on a sale of Certificates in an amount equal to the difference
between the amount realized and the seller's tax basis in the Certificates sold.
A Certificateholder's tax basis in a Certificate will generally equal the
Holder's cost increased by the Holder's share of Trust Fund income (includible
in income) and decreased by any distributions received with respect to such
Certificate. In addition, both the tax basis in the Certificates and the amount
realized on a sale of a Certificate would include the Holder's share of the
Notes and other liabilities of the Trust Fund. A Holder acquiring Certificates
at different prices may be required to maintain a single aggregate adjusted tax
basis in such Certificates, and, upon sale or other disposition of some of the
Certificates, allocate a portion of such aggregate tax basis to the Certificates
sold (rather than maintaining a separate tax basis in each Certificate for
purposes of computing gain or loss on a sale of that Certificate).
 
     Any gain on the sale of a Certificate attributable to the Holder's share of
unrecognized accrued market discount on the Loans would generally be treated as
ordinary income to the Holder and would give rise to special tax reporting
requirements. The Trust Fund does not expect to have any other assets that would
give rise to such special reporting requirements. Thus, to avoid those special
reporting requirements, the Trust Fund will elect to include market discount in
income as it accrues.
 
     If a Certificateholder is required to recognize an aggregate amount of
income (not including income attributable to disallowed itemized deductions
described above) over the life of the Certificates that exceeds the aggregate
cash distributions with respect thereto, such excess will generally give rise to
a capital loss upon the retirement of the Certificates.
 
     Allocations Between Transferors and Transferees.  In general, the Trust
Fund's taxable income and losses will be determined monthly and the tax items
for a particular calendar month will be apportioned among the Certificateholders
in proportion to the principal amount of Certificates owned by them as of the
close of the last day of such month. As a result, a Holder purchasing
Certificates may be allocated tax items (which will affect its tax liability and
tax basis) attributable to periods before the actual transaction.
 
     The use of such a monthly convention may not be permitted by existing
regulations. If a monthly convention is not allowed (or only applies to
transfers of less than all of the partner's interest), taxable income or losses
of the Trust Fund might be reallocated among the Certificateholders. The Trust
Fund's method of allocation between transferors and transferees may be revised
to conform to a method permitted by future regulations.
 
     Section 754 Election.  In the event that a Certificateholder sells its
Certificates at a profit (loss), the purchasing Certificateholder will have a
higher (lower) basis in the Certificates than the selling Certificateholder had.
The tax basis of the Trust Fund's assets will not be adjusted to reflect that
higher (or lower) basis unless the Trust Fund were to file an election under
Section 754 of the Code. In order to avoid the administrative complexities that
would be involved in keeping accurate accounting records, as well as potentially
onerous information reporting requirements, the Trust Fund will not make such
election. As a result, Certificateholders might be allocated a greater or lesser
amount of Trust Fund income than would be appropriate based on their own
purchase price for Certificates.
 
     Administrative Matters.  The Owner Trustee is required to keep or have kept
complete and accurate books of the Trust Fund. Such books will be maintained for
financial reporting and tax purposes on an accrual basis and
 
                                       71
<PAGE>
the fiscal year of the Trust Fund will be the calendar year. The Trustee will
file a partnership information return (IRS Form 1065) with the IRS for each
taxable year of the Trust Fund and will report each Certificateholder's
allocable share of items of Trust Fund income and expense to Holders and the IRS
on Schedule K-1. The Trust Fund will provide the Schedule K-1 information to
nominees that fail to provide the Trust Fund with the information statement
described below and such nominees will be required to forward such information
to the beneficial owners of the Certificates. Generally, Holders must file tax
returns that are consistent with the information return filed by the Trust Fund
or be subject to penalties unless the Holder notifies the IRS of all such
inconsistencies.
 
     Under Section 6031 of the Code, any person that holds Certificates as a
nominee at any time during a calendar year is required to furnish the Trust Fund
with a statement containing certain information on the nominee, the beneficial
owners and the Certificates so held. Such information includes (i) the name,
address and taxpayer identification number of the nominee and (ii) as to each
beneficial owner (x) the name, address and identification number of such person,
(y) whether such person is a United States person, a tax-exempt entity or a
foreign government, an international organization, or any wholly owned agency or
instrumentality of either of the foregoing, and (z) certain information on
Certificates that were held, bought or sold on behalf of such person throughout
the year. In addition, brokers and financial institutions that hold Certificates
through a nominee are required to furnish directly to the Trust Fund information
as to themselves and their ownership of Certificates. A clearing agency
registered under Section 17A of the Exchange Act is not required to furnish any
such information statement to the Trust Fund. The information referred to above
for any calendar year must be furnished to the Trust Fund on or before the
following January 31. Nominees, brokers and financial institutions that fail to
provide the Trust Fund with the information described above may be subject to
penalties.
 
     The Depositor will be designated as the tax matters partner in the related
Trust Agreement and, as such, will be responsible for representing the
Certificateholders in any dispute with the IRS. The Code provides for
administrative examination of a partnership as if the partnership were a
separate and distinct taxpayer. Generally, the statute of limitations for
partnership items does not expire before three years after the date on which the
partnership information return is filed. Any adverse determination following an
audit of the return of the Trust Fund by the appropriate taxing authorities
could result in an adjustment of the returns of the Certificateholders, and,
under certain circumstances, a Certificateholder may be precluded from
separately litigating a proposed adjustment to the items of the Trust Fund. An
adjustment could also result in an audit of a Certificateholder's returns and
adjustments of items not related to the income and losses of the Trust Fund.
 
     Tax Consequences to Foreign Certificateholders.  It is not clear whether
the Trust Fund would be considered to be engaged in a trade or business in the
United States for purposes of federal withholding taxes with respect to non-U.S.
persons because there is no clear authority dealing with that issue under facts
substantially similar to those described herein. Although it is not expected
that the Trust Fund would be engaged in a trade or business in the United States
for such purposes, the Trust Fund will withhold as if it were so engaged in
order to protect the Trust Fund from possible adverse consequences of a failure
to withhold. The Trust Fund expects to withhold on the portion of its taxable
income that is allocable to foreign Certificateholders pursuant to Section 1446
of the Code, as if such income were effectively connected to a U.S. trade or
business, at a rate of 35% for foreign Holders that are taxable as corporations
and 39.6% for all other foreign Holders. Subsequent adoption of Treasury
regulations or the issuance of other administrative pronouncements may require
the Trust Fund to change its withholding procedures. In determining a Holder's
withholding status, the Trust Fund may rely on IRS Form W-8, IRS Form W-9 or the
Holder's certification of nonforeign status signed under penalties of perjury.
 
     Each foreign Holder might be required to file a U.S. individual or
corporate income tax return (including, in the case of a corporation, the branch
profits tax) on its share of the Trust Fund's income. Each foreign Holder must
obtain a taxpayer identification number from the IRS and submit that number to
the Trust Fund on Form W-8 in order to assure appropriate crediting of the taxes
withheld. A foreign Holder generally would be entitled to file with the IRS a
claim for refund with respect to taxes withheld by the Trust Fund taking the
position that no taxes were due because the Trust Fund was not engaged in a U.S.
trade or business. However, interest payments made (or accrued) to a
Certificateholder who is a foreign person generally will be considered
guaranteed payments to the extent such payments are determined without regard to
the income of the Trust Fund. If these interest payments are properly
characterized as guaranteed payments, then the interest will not be considered
 
                                       72
<PAGE>
'portfolio interest.' As a result, Certificateholders will be subject to United
States federal income tax and withholding tax at a rate of 30%, unless reduced
or eliminated pursuant to an applicable treaty. In such case, a foreign Holder
would only be entitled to claim a refund for that portion of the taxes in excess
of the taxes that should be withheld with respect to the guaranteed payments.
 
     Backup Withholding.  Distributions made on the Certificates and proceeds
from the sale of the Certificates will be subject to a 'backup' withholding tax
of 31% if, in general, the Certificateholder fails to comply with certain
identification procedures, unless the Holder is an exempt recipient under
applicable provisions of the Code.
 
                            STATE TAX CONSIDERATIONS
 
     In addition to the federal income tax consequences described in 'Certain
Federal Income Tax Considerations,' potential investors should consider the
state and local income tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership, and
disposition of the Securities. State and local income tax law may differ
substantially from the corresponding federal law, and this discussion does not
purport to describe any aspect of the income tax laws of any state or locality.
Therefore, potential investors should consult their own tax advisors with
respect to the various state and local tax consequences of an investment in the
Securities.
 
                              ERISA CONSIDERATIONS
 
     The Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ('ERISA')
and the Code impose certain restrictions on employee benefit plans subject to
ERISA and on plans and other arrangements subject to Section 4975 of the Code
and on persons who are parties in interest or disqualified persons ('parties in
interest') with respect to such plans or arrangements. Certain employee benefit
plans, such as governmental plans and church plans (if no election has been made
under Section 410(d) of the Code), are not subject to the restrictions of ERISA,
and assets of such plans may be invested in the Securities without regard to the
ERISA considerations described below, subject to other applicable federal and
state law. However, any such governmental or church plan which is qualified
under Section 401(a) of the Code and exempt from taxation under Section 501(a)
of the Code is subject to the prohibited transaction rules set forth in Section
503 of the Code.
 
     A fiduciary of an employee benefit plan subject to Title I of ERISA should
consider the fiduciary standards under ERISA in the context of the plan's
particular circumstances before authorizing an investment of a portion of such
plan's assets in the Securities. Accordingly, among other factors, such
fiduciary should consider (i) whether the investment is for the exclusive
benefit of plan participants and their beneficiaries; (ii) whether the
investment satisfies the diversification requirements of Section 404 of ERISA;
(iii) whether the investment is in accordance with the documents and instruments
governing the plan and (iv) whether the investment is prudent, considering the
nature of the investment. Fiduciaries of such plans also should consider ERISA's
prohibition on improper delegation of control over, or responsibility for, plan
assets.
 
     In addition, fiduciaries of employee benefit plans subject to Title I of
ERISA, as well as certain plans or other retirement arrangements not subject to
ERISA but which are subject to Section 4975 of the Code (such as individual
retirement accounts and Keogh plans covering only a sole proprietor or partners)
or any entity, including an insurance company general account whose underlying
assets include plan assets by reason of a plan or account investing in such
entity, (collectively, 'Plans(s)'), should consult with their legal counsel to
determine whether an investment in the Securities will cause the assets of the
Trust Fund to be considered plan assets pursuant to the plan asset regulations
set forth at 29 CFR 2510.3-101 (the 'Regulation'), thereby subjecting the Plan
to the prohibited transaction rules with respect to the Trust Fund and the
Trustee, or any entities providing services with respect to the operation of the
Trust, to the fiduciary investment standards of ERISA, or cause the excise tax
provisions of Section 4975 of the Code to apply to the Trust Fund, unless a
statutory or regulatory exception or an administrative exemption granted by the
Department of Labor ('DOL') applies to the purchase, sale, transfer or holding
of the Securities.
 
     The Regulation contains rules for determining what constitutes the assets
of a Plan. The Regulation provides that, as a general rule, the underlying
assets and properties of corporations, partnerships, trusts and certain other
 
                                       73
<PAGE>
entities in which a Plan makes an investment in an 'equity interest' will be
deemed for purposes of ERISA to be assets of the Plan unless certain exceptions
apply.
 
     Under the terms of the Regulation, the Trust Fund may be deemed to hold
plan assets by reason of a Plan's investment in a Security; such plan assets
would include an undivided interest in the Primary Assets and any other assets
held by the Trust Fund. In such an event, persons providing services with
respect to the operation of the Trust Fund may be parties in interest, subject
to the fiduciary responsibility provisions of Title I of ERISA, including the
prohibited transaction provisions of Section 406 of ERISA and of Section 4975 of
the Code, with respect to transactions involving such assets unless such
transactions are subject to a statutory or regulatory exception or an
administrative exemption.
 
     One such exception applies if the interest described is treated as
indebtedness under applicable local law and which has no substantial equity
features. Generally, a profits interest in a partnership, an undivided ownership
interest in property and a beneficial ownership interest in a trust are deemed
to be 'equity interests' under the final regulation. If Notes of a particular
Series were deemed to be indebtedness under applicable local law without any
substantial equity features, an investing Plan's assets would include such
Notes, but not, by reason of such purchase, the underlying assets of the Trust
Fund. However, without regard to whether the Notes are treated as an equity
interest for such purposes, the purchase, holding or transfer of Notes by or on
behalf of a Plan could be considered a prohibited transaction if the Depositor
or the Trustee or any of their respective affiliates is, or becomes, a party in
interest or disqualified person with respect to such Plan.
 
     Another such exception applies if the class of equity interests in question
is: (i) 'widely held' (held by 100 or more investors who are independent of the
Depositor and each other); (ii) freely transferable; and (iii) sold as part of
an offering pursuant to (A) an effective registration statement under the
Securities Act of 1933, and then subsequently registered under the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 or (B) an effective registration statement under Section
12(b) or 12(g) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 ('Publicly Offered
Securities'). In addition, the regulation provides that if at all times more
than 75% of the value of all classes of equity interests in the Depositor or the
Trust Fund are held by investors other than benefit plan investors (which is
defined as including both Plans and government plans), the investing Plan's
assets will not include any of the underlying assets of the Depositor or the
Trust Fund.
 
     An additional exemption may also be available to the purchase, holding and
transfer of the Securities. The DOL granted to Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc., an
administrative exemption, Prohibited Transaction Exemption 90-30 (Application
No. D-8207, 55 Fed. Reg. 21461) (1990) (the 'Exemption'), from certain of the
prohibited transaction rules of ERISA with respect to the initial purchase, the
holding and the subsequent resale by Plans of securities representing interests
in asset-backed pass-through trusts that consist of certain receivables, loans
and other obligations that meet the conditions and requirements of the
Exemption, wherever Bear, Stearns & Co. Inc. or its affiliate is the sole
underwriter, manager or co-manager of an underwriting syndicate or is the
selling or placement agent. The obligations covered by the Exemption include
obligations such as the Primary Assets (other than Private Securities which are
not insured or guaranteed by the United States or an agency or instrumentality
thereof, or Home Improvement Contracts that are unsecured). The Exemption will
apply to the acquisition, holding and transfer of the Securities by a Plan,
provided that certain conditions (certain of which are described below) are met.
 
     Among the conditions which must be satisfied for the Exemption to apply are
the following:
 
          (i) The acquisition of the Securities by a Plan is on terms (including
     the price for the Securities) that are at least as favorable to the Plan as
     they would be in an arm's-length transaction with an unrelated party;
 
          (ii) The rights and interests evidenced by the Securities acquired by
     the Plan are not subordinated to the rights and interests evidenced by
     other securities of the trust;
 
          (iii) The Securities acquired by the Plan have received a rating at
     the time of such acquisition that is in one of the three highest generic
     rating categories from either Standard & Poor's Ratings Group ('Standard &
     Poor's'), Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ('Moody's'), Duff & Phelps Inc.
     ('D&P') or Fitch Investors Service, Inc. ('Fitch');
 
                                       74
<PAGE>
          (iv) The sum of all payments made to the underwriter in connection
     with the distribution of the Securities represents not more than reasonable
     compensation for underwriting the Securities. The sum of all payments made
     to and retained by the seller pursuant to the sale of the obligations to
     the trust represents not more than the fair market value of such
     obligations. The sum of all payments made to and retained by the servicer
     represents not more than reasonable compensation for the servicer's
     services under the related servicing agreement and reimbursement of the
     servicer's reasonable expenses in connection therewith;
 
          (v) The Trustee must not be an affiliate of any other member of the
     Restricted Group (as defined below); and
 
          (vi) The Plan investing in the Securities is an 'accredited investor'
     as defined in Rule 501(a)(1) of Regulation D of the Securities and Exchange
     Commission under the Securities Act of 1933. The Depositor assumes that
     only Plans which are accredited investors under the federal securities laws
     will be permitted to purchase the Securities.
 
     The trust also must meet the following requirements:
 
          (i) the corpus of the trust must consist solely of assets of the type
     which have been included in other investment pools;
 
          (ii) securities in such other investment pools must have been rated in
     one of the three highest generic rating categories of Standard & Poor's,
     Moody's, D&P or Fitch for at least one year prior to the Plan's acquisition
     of securities; and
 
          (iii) securities evidencing interests in such other investment pools
     must have been purchased by investors other than Plans for at least one
     year prior to any Plan's acquisition of Securities.
 
     Moreover, the Exemption provides relief from certain self dealing/conflict
of interest prohibited transactions that may occur when the Plan fiduciary
causes a Plan to acquire securities in a trust in which the fiduciary (or its
affiliate) is an obligor on the receivables held in the trust provided that,
among other requirements: (i) in the case of an acquisition in connection with
the initial issuance of Securities, at least fifty (50) percent of each Class of
Securities in which Plans have invested is acquired by persons independent of
the Restricted Group and at least fifty (50) percent of the aggregate interest
in the trust is acquired by persons independent of the Restricted Group; (ii)
such fiduciary (or its affiliate) is an obligor with respect to five (5) percent
or less of the fair market value of the obligations contained in the trust;
(iii) the Plan's investment in Securities does not exceed twenty-five (25)
percent of all of the Securities outstanding after the acquisition; and (iv) no
more than twenty-five (25) percent of the assets of the Plan are invested in
securities representing an interest in one or more trusts containing assets sold
or serviced by the same entity. The Exemption does not apply to Plans sponsored
by the Depositor, the underwriters of the Securities, the Trustee, the Servicer,
any obligor with respect to obligations included in a Trust Fund constituting
more than five (5) percent of the aggregate unamortized principal balance of the
assets in a Trust Fund, or any affiliate of such parties (the 'Restricted
Group').
 
     In the event that the Exemption is not applicable, some other prohibited
transaction class exemption issued by the DOL, including PTCE 95-60 (relating to
insurance company general accounts), PTCE 91-38 (relating to bank collective
funds), PTCE 90-1 (relating to insurance company pooled separate accounts) and
PTCE 84-14 (relating to investments by qualified plan asset managers) may apply,
depending on the circumstances.
 
     Prospective Plan investors should consult with their legal advisors
concerning the impact of ERISA and the Code, the potential application of the
Exemption to the purchase and holding of the Securities and the potential
consequences to their specific circumstances, prior to making an investment in
the Securities. Moreover, each Plan fiduciary should determine whether under the
general fiduciary standards of investment procedure and diversification an
investment in the Securities is appropriate for the Plan, taking into account
the overall investment policy of the Plan and the composition of the Plan's
investment portfolio.
 
                                       75
<PAGE>
                                LEGAL INVESTMENT
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, the
Securities will not constitute 'mortgage-related securities' within the meaning
of SMMEA. Accordingly, investors whose investment authority is subject to legal
restrictions should consult their own legal advisors to determine whether and to
what extent the Securities constitute legal investments for them.
 
                              PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION
 
     The Depositor may offer each Series of Securities through Bear, Stearns &
Co. Inc. ('Bear Stearns') or one or more other firms that may be designated at
the time of each offering of such Securities. The participation of Bear Stearns
in any offering will comply with Schedule E to the By-Laws of the National
Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. The Prospectus Supplement relating to
each Series of Securities will set forth the specific terms of the offering of
such Series of Securities and of each Class within such Series, the names of the
underwriters, the purchase price of the Securities, the proceeds to the
Depositor from such sale, any securities exchange on which the Securities may be
listed, and, if applicable, the initial public offering prices, the discounts
and commissions to the underwriters and any discounts and concessions allowed or
reallowed to certain dealers. The place and time of delivery of each Series of
Securities will also be set forth in the Prospectus Supplement relating to such
Series. Bear Stearns is an affiliate of the Depositor.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
     Unless otherwise specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, certain
legal matters in connection with the Securities will be passed upon for the
Depositor by Stroock & Stroock & Lavan, New York, New York.
 
                                       76
<PAGE>
                               GLOSSARY OF TERMS
 
     The following are abbreviated definitions of certain capitalized terms used
in this Prospectus. Unless otherwise provided in a 'Supplemental Glossary' in
the Prospectus Supplement for a Series, such definitions shall apply to
capitalized terms used in such Prospectus Supplement. The definitions may vary
from those in the related Agreement for a Series and the related Agreement for a
Series generally provides a more complete definition of certain of the terms.
Reference should be made to the related Agreement for a Series for a more
compete definition of such terms.
 
     'Accrual Termination Date' means, with respect to a Class of Compound
Interest Securities, the Distribution Date specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     'Advance' means cash advanced by the Servicer in respect of delinquent
payments of principal of and interest on a Loan, and for any other purposes
specified in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Agreement' means, with respect to a Series of Certificates, the Pooling
and Servicing Agreement or Trust Agreement, and, with respect to a Series of
Notes, the Indenture and the Servicing Agreement, as the context requires.
 
     'Appraised Value' means, with respect to property securing a Loan, the
lesser of the appraised value determined in an appraisal obtained at origination
of the Loan or sales price of such property at such time.
 
     'Asset Group' means, with respect to the Primary Assets and other assets
comprising the Trust Fund of a Series, a group of such Primary Assets and other
assets having the characteristics described in the related Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     'Assumed Reinvestment Rate' means, with respect to a Series, the per annum
rate or rates specified in the related Prospectus Supplement for a particular
period or periods as the 'Assumed Reinvestment Rate' for funds held in any fund
or account for the Series.
 
     'Available Distribution Amount' means the amount in the Distribution
Account (including amounts deposited therein from any reserve fund or other fund
or account) eligible for distribution to Holders on a Distribution Date.
 
     'Bankruptcy Code' means the federal bankruptcy code, 11 United States Code
101 et seq., and related rules and regulations promulgated thereunder.
 
     'Business Day' means a day that, in the City of New York or in the city or
cities in which the corporate trust office of the Trustee are located, is
neither a legal holiday nor a day on which banking institutions are authorized
or obligated by law, regulations or executive order to be closed.
 
     'Certificate' means the Asset-Backed Certificates.
 
     'Class' means a Class of Securities of a Series.
 
     'Closing Date' means, with respect to a Series, the date specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement as the date on which Securities of such Series are
first issued.
 
     'Code' means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and regulations
(including proposed regulations) or other pronouncements of the Internal Revenue
Service promulgated thereunder.
 
     'Collection Account' means, with respect to a Series, the account
established in the name of the Servicer for the deposit by the Servicer of
payments received from the Primary Assets.
 
     'Combined Loan-to-Value Ratio' means, with respect to a Loan, the ratio
determined as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement taking into account
the amounts of any related senior mortgage loans on the related Mortgaged
Property.
 
     'Commission' means the Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
     'Compound Interest Security' means any Security of a Series on which all or
a portion of the interest accrued thereon is added to the principal balance of
such Security on each Distribution Date, through the Accrual
 
                                       77
<PAGE>
Termination Date, and with respect to which no interest shall be payable until
such Accrual Termination Date, after which interest payments will be made on the
Compound Value thereof.
 
     'Compound Value' means, with respect to a Class of Compound Interest
Securities, the original principal balance of such Class, plus all accrued and
unpaid interest, if any, previously added to the principal balance thereof and
reduced by any payments of principal previously made on such Class of Compound
Interest Securities.
 
     'Condominium' means a form of ownership of real property wherein each owner
is entitled to the exclusive ownership and possession of his or her individual
Condominium Unit and also owns a proportionate undivided interest in all parts
of the Condominium Building (other than the individual Condominium Units) and
all areas or facilities, if any, for the common use of the Condominium Units.
 
     'Condominium Association' means the person(s) appointed or elected by the
Condominium Unit owners to govern the affairs of the Condominium.
 
     'Condominium Building' means a multi-unit building or buildings, or a group
of buildings whether or not attached to each other, located on property subject
to Condominium ownership.
 
     'Condominium Loan' means a Loan secured by a Mortgage on a Condominium Unit
(together with its appurtenant interest in the common elements).
 
     'Condominium Unit' means an individual housing unit in a Condominium
Building.
 
     'Cooperative' means a corporation owned by tenant-stockholders who, through
the ownership of stock, shares or membership securities in the corporation,
receive proprietary leases or occupancy agreements which confer exclusive rights
to occupy specific units and which is described in Section 216 of the Code.
 
     'Cooperative Dwelling' means an individual housing unit in a building owned
by a Cooperative.
 
     'Cooperative Loan' means a housing loan made with respect to a Cooperative
Dwelling and secured by an assignment by the borrower (tenant-stockholder) or
security interest in shares issued by the applicable Cooperative.
 
     'Cut-off Date' means the date designated as such in the related Prospectus
Supplement for a Series.
 
     'Debt Securities' means Securities characterized as indebtedness for
federal income tax purposes, and Regular Interest Securities.
 
     'Deferred Interest' means the excess of the interest accrued on the
outstanding principal balance of a Loan during a specified period over the
amount of interest required to be paid by an obligor on such Loan on the related
Due Date.
 
     'Deposit Agreement' means a guaranteed investment contract or reinvestment
agreement providing for the investment of funds held in a fund or account,
guaranteeing a minimum or a fixed rate of return on the investment of moneys
deposited therein.
 
     'Depositor' means Bear Stearns Asset Backed Securities, Inc.
 
     'Disqualified Organization' means the United States, any State or political
subdivision thereof, any possession of the United States, any foreign
government, any international organization, or any agency or instrumentality of
any of the foregoing, a rural electric or telephone cooperative described in
section 1381(a)(2)(C) of the Code, or any entity exempt from the tax imposed by
sections 1-1399 of the Code, if such entity is not subject to tax on its
unrelated business income.
 
     'Distribution Account' means, with respect to a Series, the account
established in the name of the Trustee for the deposit of remittances received
from the Servicer with respect to the Primary Assets.
 
     'Distribution Date' means, with respect to a Series or Class of Securities,
each date specified as a distribution date for such Series or Class in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                       78
<PAGE>
     'Due Date' means each date, as specified in the related Prospectus
Supplement for a Series, on which any payment of principal or interest is due
and payable by the obligor on any Primary Asset pursuant to the terms thereof.
 
     'Eligible Investments' means any one or more of the obligations or
securities described as such in the related Agreement.
 
     'Enhancement' means the enhancement for a Series, if any, specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Enhancer' means the provider of the Enhancement for a Series specified in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'ERISA' means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
amended.
 
     'Escrow Account' means an account, established and maintained by the
Servicer for a Loan, into which payments by borrowers to pay taxes, assessments,
mortgage and hazard insurance premiums and other comparable items required to be
paid to the mortgagee are deposited.
 
     'FHLMC' means the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation.
 
     'Final Scheduled Distribution Date' means, with respect to a Class of Notes
of a Series, the date no later than which principal thereof will be fully paid
and with respect to a Class of Certificates of a Series, the date after which no
Certificates of such Class will remain outstanding, in each case based on the
assumptions set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'FNMA' means the Federal National Mortgage Association.
 
     'Holder' means the person or entity in whose name a Security is registered.
 
     'Home Improvements' means the home improvements financed by a Home
Improvement Contract.
 
     'Home Improvement Contract' means any home improvement installment sales
contracts and installment loan agreement which may be unsecured or secured by
purchase money security interest in the Home Improvement financed thereby.
 
     'HUD' means the United States Department of Housing and Urban Development.
 
     'Indenture' means the indenture relating to a Series of Notes between the
Trust Fund and the Trustee.
 
     'Insurance Policies' means certain mortgage insurance, hazard insurance and
other insurance policies required to be maintained with respect to Loans.
 
     'Insurance Proceeds' means amount paid by the insurer under any of the
Insurance Policies covering any Loan or Mortgaged Property.
 
     'Interest Only Securities' means a Class of Securities entitled solely or
primarily to distributions of interest and which is identified as such in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'IRS' means the Internal Revenue Service.
 
     'Lifetime Rate Cap' means the lifetime limit if any, on the Loan Rate
during the life of each adjustable rate Loan.
 
     'Liquidation Proceeds' means amounts received by the Servicer in connection
with the liquidation of a Loan, net of liquidation expenses.
 
     'Loan Rate' means, unless otherwise indicated herein or in the Prospectus
Supplement, the interest rate borne by a Loan.
 
     'Loans' mean Mortgage Loans and/or Home Improvement Contracts,
collectively. A Loan refers to a specific Mortgage Loan or Home Improvement
Contract, as the context requires.
 
     'Loan-to-Value Ratio' means, with respect to a Loan, the ratio determined
as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
                                       79
<PAGE>
     'Minimum Rate' means the lifetime minimum Loan Rate during the life of each
adjustable rate Loan.
 
     'Minimum Principal Payment Agreement' means a minimum principal payment
agreement with an entity meeting the criteria of the Rating Agencies.
 
     'Modification' means a change in any term of a Loan.
 
     'Mortgage' means the mortgage, deed of trust or other similar security
instrument securing a Mortgage Note.
 
     'Mortgage Loan' means a closed-end home equity loan secured by a Mortgaged
Property.
 
     'Mortgage Note' means the note or other evidence of indebtedness of a
Mortgagor under the Loan.
 
     'Mortgagor' means the obligor on a Mortgage Note.
 
     '1986 Act' means the Tax Reform Act of 1986.
 
     'Notes' means the Asset-Backed Notes.
 
     'Notional Amount' means the amount set forth in the related Prospectus
Supplement for a Class of Interest Only Securities.
 
     'PAC' ('Planned Amortization Class Securities') means a Class of Securities
of a Series on which payments of principal are made in accordance with a
schedule specified in the related Prospectus Supplement, based on certain
assumptions stated therein.
 
     'Participating Securities' means Securities entitled to receive payments of
principal and interest and an additional return on investment as described in
the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Pass-Through Security' means a security representing an undivided
beneficial interest in a pool of assets, including the right to receive a
portion of all principal and interest payments relating to those assets.
 
     'Pay Through Security' means Regular Interest Securities and certain Debt
Securities that are subject to acceleration due to prepayment on the underlying
Primary Assets.
 
     'Person' means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture,
association, joint stock company, trust (including any beneficiary thereof),
unincorporated organization, or government or any agency or political
subdivision thereof.
 
     'Pooling and Servicing Agreement' means the pooling and servicing agreement
relating to a Series of Certificates among the Depositor, the Servicer (if such
Series relates to Loans) and the Trustee.
 
     'Primary Assets' means the Private Securities and/or Loans, as the case may
be, which are included in the Trust Fund for such Series. A Primary Asset refers
to a specific Private Security or Loan, as the case may be.
 
     'Principal Balance' means, with respect to a Primary Asset and as of a Due
Date, the original principal amount of the Primary Asset, plus the amount of any
Deferred Interest added to such principal amount, reduced by all payments, both
scheduled or otherwise, received on such Primary Asset prior to such Due Date
and applied to principal in accordance with the terms of the Primary Asset.
 
     'Principal Only Securities' means a Class of Securities entitled solely or
primarily to distributions of principal and identified as such in the Prospectus
Supplement.
 
     'Private Security' means a participation or pass-through certificate
representing a fractional, undivided interest in Underlying Loans or
collateralized obligations secured by Underlying Loans.
 
     'Property' means either a Home Improvement or a Mortgaged Property securing
a Loan, as the context requires.
 
     'PS Agreement' means the pooling and servicing agreement, indenture, trust
agreement or similar agreement pursuant to which a Private Security is issued.
 
     'PS Servicer' means the servicer of the Underlying Loans.
 
                                       80
<PAGE>
     'PS Sponsor' means, with respect to Private Securities, the sponsor or
depositor under a PS Agreement.
 
     'PS Trustee' means the trustee designated under a PS Agreement.
 
     'Qualified Insurer' means a mortgage guarantee or insurance company duly
qualified as such under the laws of the states in which the Mortgaged Properties
are located duly authorized and licensed in such states to transact the
applicable insurance business and to write the insurance provided.
 
     'Rating Agency' means the nationally recognized statistical rating
organization (or organizations) which was (or were) requested by the Depositor
to rate the Securities upon the original issuance thereof.
 
     'Regular Interest' means a regular interest in a REMIC.
 
     'REMIC' means a real estate mortgage investment conduit.
 
     'REMIC Administrator' means the Person, if any, specified in the related
Prospectus Supplement for a Series for which a REMIC election is made, to serve
as administrator of the Series.
 
     'REMIC Provisions' means the provisions of the federal income tax law
relating to real estate mortgage investment conduits, which appear at sections
860A through 860G of Subchapter M of Chapter 1 of the Code, and related
provisions, and regulations, including proposed regulations and rulings, and
administrative pronouncements promulgated thereunder, as the foregoing may be in
effect from time to time.
 
     'REO Property' means real property which secured a defaulted Loan,
beneficial ownership of which has been acquired upon foreclosure, deed in lieu
of foreclosure, repossession or otherwise.
 
     'Reserve Fund' means, with respect to a Series, any Reserve Fund
established pursuant to the related Agreement.
 
     'Residual Interest' means a residual interest in a REMIC.
 
     'Retained Interest' means, with respect to a Primary Asset, the amount or
percentaged specified in the related Prospectus Supplement which is not included
in the Trust Fund for the related Series.
 
     'Scheduled Payments' means the scheduled payments of principal and interest
to be made by the borrower on a Primary Asset.
 
     'Securities' means the Notes or the Certificates.
 
     'Seller' means the seller of the Primary Assets to the Depositor identified
in the related Prospectus Supplement for a Series.
 
     'Senior Securityholder' means a holder of a Senior Security.
 
     'Senior Securities' means a Class of Securities as to which the holders'
rights to receive distributions of principal and interest are senior to the
rights of holders of Subordinate Securities, to the extent specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Series' means a separate series of Securities sold pursuant to this
Prospectus and the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Servicer' means, with respect to a Series relating to Loans, the Person if
any, designated in the related Prospectus Supplement to service Loans for that
Series, or the successors or assigns of such Person.
 
     'Single Family Property' means property securing a Loan consisting of one-
to four-family attached or detached residential housing, including Cooperative
Dwellings.
 
     'Stripped Securities' means Pass-Through Securities representing interests
in Primary Assets with respect to which all or a portion of the principal
payments have been separated from all or a portion of the interest payments.
 
     'Subordinate Securityholder' means a Holder of a Subordinate Security.
 
     'Subordinated Securities' means a Class of Securities as to which the
rights of holders to receive distributions of principal, interest or both is
subordinated to the rights of holders of Senior Securities, and may be
 
                                       81
<PAGE>
allocated losses and shortfalls prior to the allocation thereof to other Classes
of Securities, to the extent and under the circumstances specified in the
related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Trustee' means the trustee under the applicable Agreement and its
successors.
 
     'Trust Fund' means, with respect to any Series of Securities, the trust
holding all money, instruments, securities and other property, including all
proceeds thereof, which are, with respect to a Series of Certificates, held for
the benefit of the Holders by the Trustee under the Pooling and Servicing
Agreement or Trust Agreement or, with respect to a Series of Notes, pledged to
the Trustee under the Indenture as a security for such Notes, including, without
limitation, the Primary Assets (except any Retained Interests), all amounts in
the Distribution Account Collection Account or Reserve Funds, distributions on
the Primary Assets (net of servicing fees), and reinvestment earnings on such
net distributions and any Enhancement and all other property and interest held
by or pledged to the Trustee pursuant to the related Agreement for such Series.
 
     'UCC' means the Uniform Commercial Code.
 
     'Underlying Loans' means loans of the type eligible to be Loans underlying
or securing Private Securities.
 
     'Variable Interest Security' means a Security on which interest accrues at
a rate that is adjusted, based upon a predetermined index, at fixed periodic
intervals, all as set forth in the related Prospectus Supplement.
 
     'Zero Coupon Security' means a Security entitled to receive payments of
principal only.
 
                                       82
<PAGE>
                      [This page intentionally left blank]

<PAGE>
                      [This page intentionally left blank]
<PAGE>
                      [This page intentionally left blank]
<PAGE>
- ------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------
 
     NO DEALER, SALESMAN OR OTHER PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY
INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS IN CONNECTION WITH THIS OFFERING
OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING
PROSPECTUS, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT
BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE SELLER OR THE UNDERWRITER. THIS
PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS DO NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER
TO SELL OR A SOLICITATION OF AN OFFER TO BUY ANY SECURITIES OTHER THAN THE
CERTIFICATES OFFERED HEREBY NOR AN OFFER OF SUCH CERTIFICATES TO ANY PERSON IN
ANY STATE OR OTHER JURISDICTION IN WHICH SUCH OFFER WOULD BE UNLAWFUL. THE
DELIVERY OF THIS PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT AND THE ACCOMPANYING PROSPECTUS AT ANY
TIME DOES NOT IMPLY THAT INFORMATION HEREIN CORRECT AS OF ANY TIME SUBSEQUENT TO
ITS DATE.
                            ------------------------
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  PAGE
                                                  ----
<S>                                               <C>
Summary of Terms...............................    S-3
Risk Factors...................................   S-15
Description of the Home Equity Loans...........   S-18
The Seller and the Servicer....................   S-20
Champion's Home Equity Loan Program............   S-20
Prepayment and Yield Considerations............   S-25
Description of the Certificates................   S-31
The Policy and the Certificate Insurer.........   S-46
Use of Proceeds................................   S-49
Plan of Distribution...........................   S-50
Experts........................................   S-50
Ratings........................................   S-50
Legal Matters..................................   S-50
Appendix A -- Certain Statistical
  Information..................................    A-1
                      PROSPECTUS
Prospectus Supplement..........................      3
Reports to Holders.............................      3
Available Information..........................      3
Incorporation of Certain Documents
  by Reference.................................      4
Summary of Terms...............................      5
Risk Factors...................................     15
Description of the Securities..................     19
The Trust Funds................................     22
Enhancement....................................     28
Servicing of Loans.............................     31
The Agreements.................................     37
Certain Legal Aspects of Loans.................     44
The Depositor..................................     52
Use of Proceeds................................     53
Certain Federal Income Tax Considerations......     53
State Tax Considerations.......................     73
ERISA Considerations...........................     73
Legal Investment...............................     76
Plan of Distribution...........................     76
Legal Matters..................................     76
Glossary of Terms..............................     77
</TABLE>

- ------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------
 
                                  $100,000,000
 
                              CHAMPION HOME EQUITY
                               LOAN TRUST 1996-2
 
                               CHAMPION MORTGAGE
                                SERVICING CORP.
 
                                    SERVICER
 
                               BEAR STEARNS ASSET
                            BACKED SECURITIES, INC.
                                   DEPOSITOR
                            ------------------------
                             PROSPECTUS SUPPLEMENT
                            ------------------------
                            BEAR, STEARNS & CO. INC.
                           KEY CAPITAL MARKETS, INC.
                                 JULY 21, 1998
 
- ------------------------------------------------------
- ------------------------------------------------------



© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission